McGraw Hill, Countdown to Spanish Learn to Communicate in 24 Hours (2004) LiB


http://videogames.gigcities.com
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page i
GAIL STEIN
ebook_copyright 6x9.qxd 10/7/03 3:23 PM Page 1
Copyright © 2004 by The McGraw-HIll Companies, Inc. All rights reserved. Manufactured in the
United States of America. Except as permitted under the United States Copyright Act of 1976, no part
of this publication may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means, or stored in a data-
base or retrieval system, without the prior written permission of the publisher.
0-07-142864-X
The material in this eBook also appears in the print version of this title: 0-07-141423-1
All trademarks are trademarks of their respective owners. Rather than put a trademark symbol after
every occurrence of a trademarked name, we use names in an editorial fashion only, and to the benefit
of the trademark owner, with no intention of infringement of the trademark. Where such designations
appear in this book, they have been printed with initial caps.
McGraw-Hill eBooks are available at special quantity discounts to use as premiums and sales pro-
motions, or for use in corporate training programs. For more information, please contact George
Hoare, Special Sales, at george_hoare@mcgraw-hill.com or (212) 904-4069.
TERMS OF USE
This is a copyrighted work and The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. ( McGraw-Hill ) and its licensors
reserve all rights in and to the work. Use of this work is subject to these terms. Except as permitted
under the Copyright Act of 1976 and the right to store and retrieve one copy of the work, you may not
decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, reproduce, modify, create derivative works based upon,
transmit, distribute, disseminate, sell, publish or sublicense the work or any part of it without
McGraw-Hill s prior consent. You may use the work for your own noncommercial and personal use;
any other use of the work is strictly prohibited. Your right to use the work may be terminated if you
fail to comply with these terms.
THE WORK IS PROVIDED  AS IS . McGRAW-HILL AND ITS LICENSORS MAKE NO GUAR-
ANTEES OR WARRANTIES AS TO THE ACCURACY, ADEQUACY OR COMPLETENESS OF
OR RESULTS TO BE OBTAINED FROM USING THE WORK, INCLUDING ANY INFORMA-
TION THAT CAN BE ACCESSED THROUGH THE WORK VIA HYPERLINK OR OTHERWISE,
AND EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT
NOT LIMITED TO IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. McGraw-Hill and its licensors do not warrant or guarantee that the func-
tions contained in the work will meet your requirements or that its operation will be uninterrupted or
error free. Neither McGraw-Hill nor its licensors shall be liable to you or anyone else for any inac-
curacy, error or omission, regardless of cause, in the work or for any damages resulting therefrom.
McGraw-Hill has no responsibility for the content of any information accessed through the work.
Under no circumstances shall McGraw-Hill and/or its licensors be liable for any indirect, incidental,
special, punitive, consequential or similar damages that result from the use of or inability to use the
work, even if any of them has been advised of the possibility of such damages. This limitation of lia-
bility shall apply to any claim or cause whatsoever whether such claim or cause arises in contract, tort
or otherwise.
DOI: 10.1036/007142864X
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page iii
This book is dedicated to:
My wonderfully patient and supportive husband, Douglas
My incredibly loving, understanding, and proud sons, Eric and Michael
My proud parents, Jack and Sara Bernstein
My creative sister and her family, Susan, Jay, and Zachary Opperman
My superior consultant and advisor, Roger H. Herz
My good friend and supporter, Christina Levy
This page intentionally left blank.
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page v
For more information about this title, click here.
Contents
Introduction xiii
24:00 Focusing on Pronunciation 1
Master These Skills 1
Perfecting Your Pronunciation 2
Stress 2
Accents 2
Vowels 3
Diphthongs 4
Consonants 5
Having the Right Tools 9
A Final Suggestion 9
Time s Up! 10
23:00 Recognizing and Using Nouns 11
Master These Skills 11
Gender 12
Noun Markers 12
Nouns 17
Cognates 22
Time s Up! 26
22:00 Working with Present-Tense Verbs 27
Master These Skills 27
Subject Nouns and Pronouns 28
Regular Verbs 29
Shoe Verbs 35
Irregular Verbs 39
Uses of the Present Tense 43
The Present Progressive 44
Time s Up! 45
v
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page vi
C O N T E N T S
21:00 The Past Tense (The Preterit) 47
Master These Skills 47
Forming the Preterit 48
The Present Perfect Tense 51
The Preterit Perfect 53
The Imperfect 53
The Pluperfect 54
The Preterit Versus the Imperfect 54
Time s Up! 57
20:00 Back to the Future:
Speaking Conditionally 59
Master These Skills 59
The Future 60
The Future Tense of Regular Verbs 60
The Future Tense of Irregular Verbs 61
The Future Perfect 62
The Conditional 63
The Perfect Conditional 64
Time s Up! 65
19:00 Adding Adjectives and Adverbs 67
Master These Skills 67
Making Adjectives Feminine 68
Making Adjectives Plural 70
Position of Adjectives 71
Using Ser and Estar with Adjectives 74
Adverbs 77
Adjectives Versus Adverbs 77
Position of Adverbs 80
Time s Up! 80
18:00 Making Acquaintances 81
Master These Skills 81
Greetings and Good-Byes 82
Reflexive Verbs 83
Origins 87
Nationalities 89
vi
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page vii
C O N T E N T S
The Family 90
Showing Possession 91
Time s Up! 94
17:00 Fielding Invitations and Other Questions 95
Master These Skills 95
Verbs for Invitations 96
Prepositions 97
Places 100
Prepositional Pronouns 101
Extending an Invitation 102
Accepting an Invitation 103
Refusing an Invitation 103
Expressing Indecision and Indifference 104
No 104
Time s Up! 106
16:00 Making Plans 107
Master These Skills 107
Cardinal Numbers 108
Ordinal Numbers 110
Days, Months, and Seasons 111
Dates 112
Telling Time 114
Time s Up! 118
15:00 Using Spanish Around the Home 119
Master These Skills 119
House and Home 120
Chores 121
Stores 121
Deber (to Have to) 122
Tener Que 123
Hay Que + Infinitive 124
Understanding and Forming the Present Subjunctive 124
The Imperfect Subjunctive 129
The Perfect and Pluperfect Subjunctive 130
Offering Encouragement 131
Time s Up! 132
vii
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page viii
C O N T E N T S
14:00 Offering Ideas and Issuing Commands 133
Master These Skills 133
Making Proposals 134
Commands 134
Getting There 139
Using Idioms 140
Positive Reinforcement 141
Complaints 142
Time s Up! 142
13:00 Asking Questions 143
Master These Skills 143
Asking Yes/No Questions 144
Information Questions 145
Hay 149
Asking for Directions 149
Asking for a Price 150
Questioning New Acquaintances 150
Lack of Communication 151
Time s Up! 152
12:00 Answering Questions 153
Master These Skills 153
Answering Yes 154
Answering No 154
Negative Expressions 157
Pero Versus Sino 158
Answering Information Questions 158
On the Phone 162
Time s Up! 164
11:00 Seeking Help 165
Master These Skills 165
Getting Help Anywhere 166
At the Post Office 166
At the Hair Salon 167
At the Dry Cleaner s 168
Repairs and More Repairs 168
viii
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page ix
C O N T E N T S
At the Optician s 169
At the Camera Shop 169
At the Jeweler s 170
Special Services and Needs 171
Time s Up! 172
10:00 Expressing Positive Opinions 173
Master These Skills 173
Making Suggestions 174
Leisure Activities 174
Demonstrative Pronouns 176
Object Pronouns 178
Using Accents 183
Positive Feelings 183
Using the Subjunctive to Express Emotions
and Feelings 184
Time s Up! 185
09:00 Planning Outdoor Activities 187
Master These Skills 187
Sports 188
The Weather 190
Expressing Negative Opinions 191
Expressing Indifference 191
Using the Subjunctive with Expressions of Doubt 192
Using the Subjunctive After Impersonal Expressions 192
Contrary-to-Fact Conditions 194
Sequence of Tenses of the Subjunctive 194
Time s Up! 195
08:00 Making Comparisons 197
Master These Skills 197
Animals 198
In the Classroom 198
Comparisons of Inequality 199
Comparisons of Equality 206
The Absolute Superlative 207
Comparative and Superlative Expressions 208
The Subjunctive After Superlative Expressions 208
Time s Up! 209
ix
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page x
C O N T E N T S
07:00 Meeting Your Needs on the Road
and Elsewhere 211
Master These Skills 211
Hotel Accommodations and Amenities 212
Exclamations 213
The Subjunctive in Third Person Commands 214
The Subjunctive After Conjunctions 214
The Subjunctive in Relative Clauses 217
Relative Pronouns 217
Time s Up! 220
06:00 Speaking of Food 221
Master These Skills 221
Quantities 222
Nouns of Quantity 223
Eating Establishments 224
Foods 224
Table Settings 230
Restaurant Etiquette 231
Dietary Restrictions 231
Problems 232
Time s Up! 233
05:00 Medical Needs 235
Master These Skills 235
At the Pharmacy 236
Prepositional Modifiers 237
Parts of the Body 238
Medical Problems 239
At the Doctor s 240
Time s Up! 242
04:00 Clothing Needs 243
Master These Skills 243
Clothing 244
Sizes 245
Alterations 246
x
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page xi
C O N T E N T S
Problems 247
Colors 248
Fabrics 250
The Neuter Lo 250
Patterns 250
Sales 251
Making a Purchase 251
Getting Measured 251
Time s Up! 252
03:00 Taking Care of Travel Needs 253
Master These Skills 253
At the Airport 254
At the Train Station 256
Travel by Car 256
The Passive Voice 260
Time s Up! 260
02:00 Managing Your Money 261
Master These Skills 261
At the Bank 262
The Stock Market 264
Present Participles 265
Perfect Participles 266
Time s Up! 267
01:00 The Language of Business 269
Master These Skills 269
Stationery Needs 270
Photocopies 270
Faxes 271
Computers 271
Conducting Business 273
Prepositions Before Infinitives 274
Time s Up! 276
xi
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page xii
C O N T E N T S
00:00 The Final Countdown 277
Answer Key 283
Appendix A: 24 Important Words
and Phrases 295
Appendix B: Verb Glossary 299
Index 307
xii
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page xiii
Introduction
The main premise of Countdown to Spanish is that you can learn this
extremely useful and beautiful language quickly and effectively. If you
are willing to spend just 24 hours of your time studying the grammar,
vocabulary, and phrases presented in the lessons, you will find that you
will be able to understand and communicate in Spanish in various types
of everyday situations. You can immediately feel confident that you will
meet this challenge and accomplish your goals effortlessly and rapidly.
To make the task of learning Spanish as time-efficient as possible,
Countdown to Spanish is divided into 24 one-hour lessons. Each lesson
is then subdivided into very logical and manageable parts, which will
enable you to learn the material with ease and self-assurance. Just divide
the lesson so that you allow an equal number of minutes for each major
heading. Do not worry about memorizing all the words in every table.
That would prove to be an impossible and frustrating task. Instead, use
the lists for reference, along with the key phrases you memorize. Those
words that are high-frequency in your vocabulary will quickly become a
part of your own personal word list.
Countdown to Spanish is completely different from other language
books. It is not a grammar text for students, yet it contains an in-depth
study of all the major grammar inherent to Spanish. It is not a phrase
book for travelers, yet it contains all the in-depth vocabulary you might
want or need in every conceivable situation. It is, therefore, a unique
combination of the two that gives you the essentials for an immediate
jump start in speaking and understanding Spanish.
Unlike any other foreign language book on the market, Countdown
to Spanish is organized into a series of tasks that speakers will find use-
ful and adaptable in a wide variety of situations: socializing, giving and
receiving information, persuasion, expressing feelings and emotions, and
expressing needs. These are the elements that are necessary for anyone
who wants to understand and be understood: that is, to communicate
as effectively as possible. Remember that dictionaries just give you
words without teaching you how to put them together to form logical,
comprehensive thoughts. Countdown to Spanish will allow you to reach
this goal.
Hours 24:00 to 19:00 present the grammar you will need to form
complete, simple, and correct sentences in the past, present, or future
xiii
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
00 (i-xiv) front matter 8/1/03 10:32 AM Page xiv
I N T R O D U C T I O N
tense. The differences between American and Spanish syntax and struc-
ture will be pinpointed to give you a greater understanding and com-
mand of the language. The rules you learn in these lessons can then be
applied to accomplish any of the tasks in the lessons that follow. So feel
free to skip around and use the knowledge you ve acquired in any of the
parts that follow, without being overly concerned about sequence.
Hours 18:00 to 16:00 give you the phrases and structures necessary
to strike up a conversation and make the acquaintance of a Spanish-
speaking person. You ll learn how to extend, accept, and graciously
refuse an invitation and offer apologies and excuses using the correct
Spanish vocabulary and structures.
Hours 15:00 and 14:00 enable you to get someone to follow a course
of action at a mutually convenient time and place. These lessons allow
you to make proposals, offer suggestions, and give commands that can
be used for a variety of different activities and events.
Hours 13:00 to 11:00 teach you the most effective ways to ask yes/no
and information questions. In the event of a lack of communication,
you ll be prepared. You ll also be able to properly furnish any necessary
information in a quick, efficient manner. There are sections teaching you
how to make a phone call and how to obtain help in securing personal
services at the post office, the hair salon, the dry cleaner s, the optician s,
the camera shop, and the jeweler s. There s even vocabulary for those
with special needs who require special services.
Hours 10:00 to 8:00 allow you to express your positive and negative
reactions and emotions, as well as your indifference and indecision
towards varying activities. You ll be using colloquial and idiomatic
Spanish and grammatically correct structures to accomplish these tasks,
as well as to make comparisons.
Hours 7:00 to 1:00 will help you with your hotel, food, medical,
clothing, transportation, banking, and business needs by means of easy
but clear-cut Spanish expressions.
The appendixes at the back of the book give essential words and
phrases in Spanish, and verb charts.
The rest is up to you. If you re really committed, you can do this!
Ä„Buena suerte! (boo-weh-nah soo-wehr-teh) Good luck!
xiv
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 1
Focusing on
Pronunciation
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Pronunciation
" Stress
" Accents
" Vowels
" Diphthongs
" Consonants
In this chapter you ll learn how to stress
Spanish syllables and how different accents
affect the sounds of the Spanish letters.
You ll also be given a key to help you
properly pronounce vowels, consonants,
and diphthongs.
1
1
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 2
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
PERFECTING YOUR PRONUNCIATION
Although your level of competence in pronouncing Spanish properly has
very little bearing on your ability to be understood, you can follow some
simple steps that should enable you to express yourself in a more accept-
able manner. Some suggestions and tips for better pronunciation include
the following:
" Relax and speak slowly. No one expects you to sound like a native.
" Slip and slide sounds together to get a more natural flow.
" Lose your inhibitions by reading aloud Spanish newspapers,
magazines, and literature.
" Set aside the necessary time to practice different sounds.
" Don t be afraid to  ham up your accent.
" Remember to pronounce letters with accents properly.
STRESS
The rules for stress in Spanish are straightforward, but they do require
your concentration at first. In general, Spanish words are pronounced
exactly as they are written. Follow these simple guidelines:
" If a word ends in a vowel, an n, or an s, place the stress on the next
to the last syllable, for example: escuela, inteligente, centro, joven,
insectos.
" If the word ends in any letter besides those mentioned above, the
stress is on the last syllable, for example: papel, comunicar, salud.
" All exceptions to the above two rules have an accent over the vowel
of the stressed syllable, for example: café, lámpara, inglés, segÅ›n.
The only exceptions to these rules are words of foreign origin,
usually words taken from English, which keep their original spelling and
pronounciation, for example: sandwich, Internet.
ACCENTS
Accent marks are small pronunciation guides that help you speak more
like a native. Spanish has three different accent marks that may change
the sound or stress of the letter.
The most common accent in Spanish is the acute accent (´), which is
used only on a vowel and indicates that you must put additional stress
on the syllable containing it:
mamá ma-MAH
café ka-FEH
egoísta eh-goh-EES-tah
2
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 3
"
2 4 : 0 0 F O C U S I N G O N P R O N U N C I A T I O N
opinión oh-peen-YOHN
mśsica MOO-see-kah
The tilde (Ü) is used only on the letter n (Å„), producing the sound ny as in
the nio of union:
cabańa kah-bah-NYAH
mańana mah-NYAH-nah
The least common accent is known as a diéresis (¨) and is placed on a u
when it is followed by another vowel. A diéresis indicates that each
vowel sound is pronounced separately:
nicaragüense nee-kah-rah-goo-WEHN-seh
lingüistico leen-goo-WEES-tee-koh
VOWELS
Each vowel in Spanish is represented by one phonetic sound, and accent
marks are used only to determine the amount of stress needed. After each
of the following vowel explanations you will have the opportunity to
practice repeating sentences that reinforce the sounds presented. Take
advantage and practice your accent until you feel comfortable that you
have mastered the material.
a
There is only one sound for a. Just open your mouth and say ahhh.
VOWEL SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
a, á ah a as in ma
Mariana is going home now with Susana s mother.
Mariana va a su casa ahora con la mamá de Susana.
mah-ree-yah-nah bah ah soo kah-sah ah-oh-rah kohn lah mah-MAH
deh soo-sah-nah.
e
There is one sound for the vowel e:
VOWEL SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
e, é eh e as in gate
3
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 4
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Enrique Estevez is the man from Chile.
Enrique Estevez es el hombre de Chile.
ehn-ree-keh ehs-teh-behs ehs ehl ohm-breh deh chee-leh
i
The i is pretty straightforward and easy to pronounce as an ee sound:
VOWEL SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
i, íee i as in magazine
Isidro is an Italian individual.
Isidro es un individuo italiano.
ee-see-droh ehs oon een-dee-bee-doo-woh ee-tahl-ee-yah-noh
o
Round your lips to get the o sound:
VOWEL SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
o, ó oh o as in go
I don t understand it.
Yo no lo comprendo.
yoh noh loh kohm-prehn-doh
u
Say the sound oo as in moo when pronouncing u:
VOWEL SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
u, Å› oo oo as in too
You use a pen in a university.
TÅ› usas una pluma en una universidad.
too oo-sahs oo-nah ploo-mah ehn oo-nah oo-nee-behr-see-dad.
DIPHTHONGS
A diphthong is the combination of a vowel sound and the consonant
sound of y or w into a single syllable. The sound of y is represented in
Spanish by i or y, and the sound of w is represented by u.
4
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 5
"
2 4 : 0 0 F O C U S I N G O N P R O N U N C I A T I O N
Diphthongs with Vowel Sounds First
DIPHTHONG SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
ai, ay ah-yee i as in light
ei, ey eh-yee e as in they
oi, oy oy o as in boy
au ow ow as in cow
eu eh-yoo eu as in reuse
I hear that there are six kings and an author in Europe.
Oigo que hay seis reyes y un autor en Europa.
oy-goh keh ah-yee seh-yees rreh-yehs ee oon ow-tohr ehn eh-yoo-roh-pah
Diphthongs with Consonant Sounds First
DIPHTHONG SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
ia, ya ee-yah ya as is yarn
ie, ye ee-yeh ye as in yet
ua oo-wah wa as in watch
ue oo-weh we as in wet
io, yo ee-yoh yo as in yoke
uo oo-woh (w)uo as in quote
iu, yu ee-yoo you as in you
ui, uy oo-wee wee as in week
I am serious and I study in the city when there is no noise.
Soy serio y estudio en la ciudad cuando no hay ruido.
soy seh-ree-yoh ee ehs-too-dee-yoh ehn lah see-yoo-dahd
kwahn-doh noh ah-yee rroo-wee-doh
CONSONANTS
The Spanish alphabet consists of twenty-eight letters, five of which are
vowels. Three of the remaining twenty-three letters, ch, ll, and Å„, do not
exist in the English alphabet. (Ch and ll are no longer commonly treated
as separate letters, but they do have unique pronunciations.) The letter
5
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 6
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
w is used only in words of foreign origin and is not considered part of
the Spanish alphabet. The following Spanish consonants should pose no
problem in pronunciation because they are the same in both Spanish and
English: b, d, f, k, l, m, n, p, s, t, y.
c
The letter c may have a soft or hard sound depending on the letter that
comes after it:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
c before a, o, u (hard sound) k c as in car
c before i, e, y (soft sound) s s as in sent
ch ch ch as in much
Carlos Cepeda drives his car downtown with the check.
Carlos Cepeda conduce su coche al centro con el cheque.
kahr-lohs seh-peh-dah kohn-doo-seh soo koh-cheh ahl sehn-troh
kohn ehl cheh-keh
g
The letter g may have a soft or hard sound depending on the vowel(s)
that comes after it:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
g before a, o, u, or consonant g g as in good
(hard sound)
g before e, i (soft sound) h h as in he
Geraldo and Gabriela Gómez win in the gym.
Geraldo y Gabriela Gómez ganan en el gimnasio.
heh-rahl-doh ee gah-bree-yeh-lah goh-mehs gah-nahn ehn ehl
heem-nah-see-yoh.
h
An h is always silent in Spanish:
Hector has a Hispanic ice cream.
Hector tiene un helado hispano.
ehk-tohr tee-yeh-neh oon eh-lah-doh ees-pah-noh
6
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 7
"
2 4 : 0 0 F O C U S I N G O N P R O N U N C I A T I O N
j
The letter j is pronounced like an English h:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
jh h as in he
The big young boy plays with Julio and Gerald in the garden.
El joven grande juega con Julio y Geraldo en el jardín.
ehl hoh-behn grahn-deh hoo-weh-gah kohn hoo-lee-yoh ee heh-rahl-doh
ehn ehl har-deen
ll
The Spanish ll has the sound of an English y:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
ll y y as in you
The llama cries slowly.
La llama llora lentamente.
lah yah-mah yoh-rah lehn-tah-mehn-teh
Å„
The Å„ has almost the equivalent sound of ni in union:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
Å„ny ni as in union
The young girl doesn t add anything.
La nińa no ańade nada.
lah nee-nyah noh ah-nyah-deh nah-dah
q
The Spanish q has the sound of an English k:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
qkk as in key
Perhaps you want fifteen cheeses.
Quizás quieras quince quesos.
kee-sahs kee-yeh-rahs keen-seh keh-sohs
7
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 8
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
r
The Spanish r is rolled or trilled. A single r receives a single tap of the
tongue whereas the double r (rr), an r at the beginning of a word, and an
r preceded by l, n, or s are strongly trilled (two or three tongue rolls).
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
rrr as in ray
rr rr r as in rrray
Mr. Robert wants the honor of seeing Ramón and Carlota Ruiz.
El seńor Roberto quiere la honra de ver a Ramón y Carlota Ruiz.
ehl seh-nyohr rroh-behr-toh kee-yeh-reh lah ohn-rrah deh behr ah
rrah-mohn ee kahr-loh-tah rroo-ees
v
The Spanish v sounds like the English b.
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
vbb as in boy
It is true that Violet had a glass of wine.
Es verdad que Violeta tuvo un vaso de vino.
ehs behr-dahd keh bee-yoh-leh-tah too-boh oon bah-soh deh bee-noh
x
The letter x is pronounced one way before a consonant and a different
way between two vowels. In some words, it has the sound of the
English s:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
x (before a consonant) s s as in see
x (between two vowels) gs gs as in eggs
Mrs. MÄ…xima explains the sixth test.
La seÅ„ora Máxima explica el sexto examen.
lah seh-nyoh-rah mag-see-mah ehs-plee-kah ehl sehs-toh ehg-sah-mehn
8
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 9
"
2 4 : 0 0 F O C U S I N G O N P R O N U N C I A T I O N
z
The Spanish z has a soft sound:
LETTER SYMBOL PRONUNCIATION
zss as in see
The blue fox is in the zoo.
El zorro azul está en el zoológico.
ehl soh-roh ah-sool ehs-tah ehn ehl soh-oh-loh-hee-koh
HAVING THE RIGHT TOOLS
A tape recorder can be an indispensable tool for language study, but also
make sure that you have on hand an up-to-date, modern, clear, easy-to-
use bilingual dictionary. Don t make a hasty purchase. Ensure that you
understand the abbreviations in the front of the book and that gram-
matical explanations are clear. Verify that modern, everyday technical
and business terms are included. Check the date of publication the
world is changing so rapidly that you want to have a book that has been
updated quite recently.
A FINAL SUGGESTION
Now that you are well on your way to excellent pronunciation habits,
try singing along to your favorite Latin tunes. Whether you prefer oldies
or something more contemporary, you will find that you can learn a lot
of vocabulary and easily become accustomed to the rhythms used by
native speakers.
9
01 (001-010) chapter 2400 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 10
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
Now that you ve had the opportunity to thoroughly acquaint yourself with
and practice the sounds of Spanish, try reading these potentially useful
phrases without the aid of any pronunciation clues. Try to avoid looking
back for help.
1. Buenos días. Me llamo José Silva. żCómo se llama?
Hello. My name is José Silva. What s your name?
2. Hablo espańol (un poco).
I speak (a little) Spanish.
3. Perdóneme. Yo no comprendo. Hable más despacio por favor.
Excuse me. I don t understand. Please speak more slowly.
4. żQué dijo? Repítalo por favor.
What did you say? Please repeat it.
5. Quisiera cambiar mis dólares en euros por favor.
I would like to change my American dollars to euros please.
6. Perdóneme. żDónde está la embajada americana?
Excuse me. Where s the American Embassy?
7. No me siento bien. żDónde está la oficina del médico más cercana?
I don t feel well. Where is the office of the nearest doctor?
8. żPodrías ayudarme, por favor? Perdí un documento importante.
Could you please help me? I ve lost an important document.
9. żCśanto cuestan estos pantalones negros y estas camisas rojas?
How much do these black pants and red shirts cost?
10. Necesito una cuchara, un tenedor y un cuchillo. Gracias.
I need a spoon, a fork, and a knife. Thank you.
10
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 11
Recognizing and
Using Nouns
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Recognizing and using noun markers
" Using nouns properly
" Making nouns plural
" Recognizing and using cognates
In this chapter you ll learn how to
differentiate between masculine and
feminine nouns and how to form the plural
of nouns. Cognates will be explained,
and a useful, working list will be presented
to allow for immediate communication.
11
11
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 12
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
GENDER
Like English, all Spanish nouns have a number: singular (one), as in la
familia, or plural (more than one), as in las familias. Unlike English,
however, all Spanish nouns also have a gender: masculine or feminine. In
some instances, the gender of the noun is blatantly obvious: un hombre
(a man) is masculine, whereas una mujer (a woman) is feminine. In other
cases, the gender of a noun is not in the least bit apparent and defies all
rules of common sense or logic: una corbata (a tie) is feminine, while un
vestido (a dress) is masculine.
Spanish syntax and grammar require that all words in a sentence
agree in number and gender with the noun or pronoun they modify. For
this reason, you must learn the gender of each noun you need or deem
important. Special noun endings and markers, either articles or adjec-
tives, indicate the gender and number of Spanish nouns.
NOUN MARKERS
Noun markers are articles or adjectives that tell you whether a noun is
singular (sing.) or plural (pl.), masculine (m.) or feminine (f.). Three of
the most common markers, as shown in the following table, are definite
articles expressing  the, indefinite articles expressing  a,  an,  one,
or  some, and demonstrative adjectives expressing  this,  that,
 these, and  those.
Singular Noun Markers
MEANING MASCULINE FEMININE
definite article the el la
indefinite article a, an un(o) una
demonstrative adjectives this este esta
that ese esa
that aquel aquella
Plural Noun Markers
MEANING MASCULINE FEMININE
definite article the los las
indefinite article some unos unas
demonstrative adjectives these estos estas
those esos esas
those aquellos aquellas
12
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 13
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
Definite Articles
The definite article the indicates a specific person or thing: the teacher,
the house. The definite article precedes the noun that it modifies and, in
Spanish, agrees with that noun in gender and number. The masculine or
feminine gender of the noun is usually, but not always, easily recogniza-
ble by the noun ending: -o for masculine and -a for feminine. Plural
nouns end in -s:
el muchacho the boy la muchacha the girl
los muchachos the boys las muchachas the girls
Use the definite article in the following instances:
" With nouns in a general or abstract sense: El chocolate es delicioso.
(Chocolate is delicious.)
" With time of day:
Es la una. It s one o clock.
Son las siete. It s seven o clock.
" With names of languages, except immediately after hablar, en,
and de:
El espaÅ„ol es fácil. Spanish is easy.
But:
Hablo espańol. I speak Spanish.
El libro está escrito en espaÅ„ol. The book is written in Spanish.
Es un libro de espańol. It s a Spanish book.
" With parts of the body when the possessor is clear: Cierra los ojos.
(Close your eyes.)
" With titles of rank or profession except when addressing the person:
El doctor Rueda llega. Dr. Rueda arrives.
But:
Buenos días, Doctor Rueda. Good morning, Dr. Rueda.
" With days of the week in a plural sense to express something that
takes place regularly, except after the verb ser (to be) when express-
ing dates:
Los domingos descanso. On Sundays I rest.
13
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 14
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
But:
Hoy es lunes. Today is Monday.
" With seasons, except that it may be omitted after en:
Me gusta la primavera I like spring (summer, fall, winter).
(el verano, el otońo,
el invierno).
But:
Voy a Espańa en (el) otońo. I am going to Spain in the fall.
" With most geographical names (rivers, mountains, oceans, countries,
states, and cities):
Vivo en los Estados Unidos. I live in the United States.
El Amazonas es un río. The Amazon is a river.
" Before verb infinitives used as nouns (although when the infinitive
is the subject of the sentence, the definite article may be omitted):
(El) llegar temprano es bueno. (Arriving early is good.)
" Before nouns of weight or measure: dos dólares la docena
(two dollars a dozen)
The definite article is omitted:
" Before nouns in apposition, except where there is a family or
business relationship:
Madrid, capital de Espańa, Madrid, the capital of Spain, is a
es una ciudad maravillosa. marvelous city.
But:
Susana, la hermana de Susan, Juan s sister, is very intelligent.
Juan,es muy inteligente.
" Before numerals expressing the numerical order of rulers: Carlos
Segundo (Charles the Second).
The neuter definite article lo is used as follows:
" The neuter lo (used for masculine or feminine, singular or plural)
precedes a masculine adjective used as a noun to express an abstract
idea or a quality:
14
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 15
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
Pienso lo mismo que ellos. I think the same as they do.
Lo caro no es siempre Expensive is not always better than
mejor que lo barato. inexpensive.
" Lo + adjective (or adverb) + que = how
Ya veo lo peligroso que es. I see how dangerous it is.
żEscuchas lo rápidamente Do you hear how fast he speaks?
que él habla?
Indefinite Articles
The indefinite article refers to persons and objects not specifically iden-
tified: a dog, some cats. The indefinite article also precedes the noun that
it modifies and must agree with that noun in gender and number:
un muchacho a boy una muchacha a girl
unos muchachos some boys unas muchachas some girls
Omit the indefinite article in these situations:
" Before nouns showing a class or group (occupation, nationality,
religion, etc.) unless the noun is modified:
Soy profesora. I m a teacher.
Es americana. She s (an) American.
But:
Soy una buena profesora. I m a good teacher.
Es una americana importante. She s an important American.
" Before or after certain words that generally have the article in
English:
otro día another day
cierto hombre a certain man
cien libros a hundred books
mil dólares a thousand dollars
tal mujer such a woman
Ä„Qué lástima! What a pity!
15
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 16
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Demonstrative Adjectives
Demonstrative adjectives indicate or point out the person, place, or thing
referred to: this girl, that country, these people, those pens. A demon-
strative adjective precedes the noun that it modifies and agrees with that
noun in gender and number.
In Spanish, the demonstrative adjective is selected according to how
near or directly concerned the noun is to the speaker and the person
addressed in the conversation.
Este/esta (this) and estos/estas (these) refer to nouns that are close to
and directly concern the speaker:
este muchacho this boy esta muchacha this girl
estos muchachos these boys estas muchachas these girls
Ese/esa (that) and esos/esas (those) refer to nouns that are not near or
directly concerned with the speaker or the person being addressed:
ese muchacho that boy esa muchacha that girl
esos muchachos those boys esas muchachas those girls
Aquel/aquella (that) and aquellos/aquellas (those) refer to things that are
quite far from or do not directly concern either the speaker or the person
being addressed:
aquel muchacho that boy aquella muchacha that girl
aquellos muchachos those boys aquellas muchachas those girls
Demonstrative adjectives may be reinforced by using corresponding
adverbs that show location:
DEMONSTRATIVE ADJECTIVE ADVERB MEANING
este, esta, estos, estas aquí here
ese, esa, esos, esas ahíthere (but not too far)
aquel, aquella, aquellos, aquellas allá over there (rather far)
este libro aquíthis book here
esa pluma ahíthat pen there
aquellos lápices allá those pencils over there
16
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 17
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
NOUNS
A noun is a word used to name a person, place, thing, idea, or quality.
All Spanish nouns are either masculine or feminine and the gender of
most of them can be determined by their meaning or ending. Most mas-
culine nouns end in -o, while most feminine nouns end in -a. A few nouns
must be learned on an individual basis.
Gender-Obvious Nouns
Nouns that refer to males are obviously masculine. Refer to this list for
common nouns you ll see:
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
abuelo ah-boo-weh-loh grandfather
hijo ee-hoh son
hombre ohm-breh man
muchacho moo-chah-choh boy
nińo nee-nyoh boy
padre pah-dreh father
sobrino soh-bree-noh nephew
tío tee-yoh uncle
Nouns that refer to females are obviously feminine. Refer to the table
below for the female counterparts of the males listed above:
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
abuela ah-boo-weh-lah grandmother
chica chee-kah girl
hija ee-hah daughter
madre mah-dreh mother
muchacha moo-chah-chah girl
mujer moo-hehr woman
sobrina soh-bree-nah niece
tía tee-yah aunt
Some nouns can be either masculine or feminine depending upon whom
you are speaking about. Make sure to use the gender marker that iden-
tifies the person correctly. The following list of words may be used to
refer to both males and females.
17
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 18
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
artista ahr-tees-tah artist
dentista dehn-tees-tah dentist
estudiante ehs-too-dee-yahn-teh student
joven hoh-behn youth
turista too-rees-tah tourist
El artista es talentoso. The (male) artist is gifted.
La artista es talentosa. The (female) artist is gifted.
Some high-frequency words are always masculine or feminine despite the
gender of the person referred to:
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
un bebé oon beh-beh an infant
una persona oo-nah pehr-soh-nah a person
una víctima oo-nah beek-tee-mah a victim
Gender-Changing Singular Nouns
Changing the gender of a noun can be as easy as removing the o ending
for the masculine form and substituting an a to get the feminine form as
shown here:
MASCULINE FEMININE MEANING
amigo (ah-mee-goh) amiga (ah-mee-gah) friend
maestro (mah-yehs-troh) maestra (mah-yehs-trah) teacher
nieto (nee-yeh-toh) nieta (nee-yeh-tah) grandchild
nińo (nee-nyoh) nińa (nee-nyah) child
primo (pree-moh) prima (pree-mah) cousin
vecino (beh-see-noh) vecina (beh-see-nah) neighbor
Some nouns may be masculine or feminine depending upon their mean-
ing as shown below:
MASCULINE FEMININE PRONUNCIATION
el capital (money) la capital (of a city) kah-pee-tahl
el cura (priest) la cura (cure) koo-rah
18
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 19
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
el guía (male guide) la guía (guidebook/ gee-yah
female guide)
el policía (policeman) la policía (police force/ poh-lee-see-yah
woman)
Gender Endings
Some nouns that end in -o are feminine:
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
la mano lah mah-noh hand
la radio lah rrah-dee-yo radio
Some nouns that end in -a are masculine:
NOUN PRONUNCIATION MEANING
el clima ehl klee-mah climate
el día ehl dee-yah day
el drama ehl drah-mah drama
el idioma ehl ee-dee-yoh-mah language
el mapa ehl mah-pah map
el planeta ehl plah-neh-tah planet
el problema ehl proh-bleh-mah problem
el programa ehl proh-grah-mah program
el tema ehl teh-mah theme
el telegrama ehl teh-leh-grah-mah telegram
Some noun endings are normally feminine:
" -dad: la ciudad, city
" -tad: la dificultad, difficulty
" -tud: la juventud, youth
" -umbre: la costumbre, custom
" -ie: la serie, series
" -ión: la canción, song
Two exceptions to -ión are avión (ah-bee-yohn) airplane, and camión
(kah-mee-yohn) truck.
For masculine nouns referring to people and ending in -or, -és, or -n,
add an a for the feminine equivalents:
19
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 20
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
MASCULINE FEMININE MEANING
el profesor la profesora teacher
(ehl proh-feh-sohr) (lah proh-feh-soh-rah)
el francés la francesa French person
(ehl frahn-sehs) (lah frahn-seh-sah)
el alemán la alemana German person
(ehl ah-leh-mahn) (lah ah-leh-mah-nah)
Note that if the masculine noun is accented on the last syllable, the
accent is dropped for the feminine form. Two exceptions to this rule are:
el emperador la emperatriz emperor, empress
(ehl ehm-peh-rah-dohr) (lah ehm-peh-rah-trees)
el actor (ehl ahk-tohr) la actriz (lah ahk-trees) actor, actress
Making Nouns Plural
Just as in English, when a Spanish noun refers to more than one person,
place, thing, idea, or quality, the noun must be made plural. Unlike
English, however, it is not enough to simply change the noun; the mark-
er must be made plural as well.
Spanish nouns ending in a vowel add a pronounced -s to form the
plural:
el muchacho (the boy) los muchachos lohs moo-chah-chos
(the boys)
una amiga (a friend) unas amigas oo-nahs ah-mee-gahs
(some friends)
este hombre (this man) estos hombres ehs-tohs ohm-brehs
(these men)
esa nińa (that girl) esas nińas (those girls) eh-sahs nee-nyahs
aquel libro (that book) aquellos libros ah-keh-yos lee-brohs
(those books)
Spanish nouns ending in a consonant (including y) add pronounced -es
(ehs) to form the plural:
el papel (paper) los papeles lohs pah-peh-lehs
el mes (month) los meses lohs meh-sehs
el actor (actor) los actores lohs ahk-toh-rehs
la ley (law) las leyes lahs leh-yehs
20
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 21
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
Spanish nouns undergo the following changes in the plural:
" Nouns ending in -z change -z to -ce before adding -es:
el lápiz (pencil) los lápices lohs lah-pee-sehs
la actriz (actress) las actrices lahs ahk-tree-sehs
el pez (fish) los peces lohs peh-sehs
" In order to preserve the original stress of the noun, you may need to
add or delete an accent mark:
el joven (youth) los jóvenes lohs hoh-beh-nehs
el examen (test) los exámenes lohs ehg-sah-meh-nehs
el francés (Frenchman) los franceses lohs frahn-seh-sehs
la canción (song) las canciones lahs kahn-see-yoh-nehs
" Nouns ending in -s, except for those ending in és, do not change in
the plural:
el (los) jueves ehl (lohs) hoo-weh-behs Thursday(s)
la (las) dosis lah (lahs) doh-sees dose(s)
" In cases where there is a group of nouns from both genders, the
masculine plural form of the noun is used:
el padre y la madre = los padres (the parents)
el nińo y la nińa = los nińos (the children)
el seńor y la seńora Ruiz = los seńores Ruiz (the Ruizes)
Some nouns in Spanish are always plural:
ENGLISH SPANISH PRONUNCIATION
eyeglasses las gafas lahs gah-fahs
los espejuelos lohs ehs-peh-hoo-
weh-lohs
mathematics las matemáticas lahs mah-teh-
mah-tee-kahs
vacation las vacaciones lahs bah-kah-
see-yoh-nehs
21
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 22
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Some nouns are singular but refer to a group of people. Make sure to use
a singular verb that agrees with these subjects:
SPANISH PRONUNCIATION ENGLISH
el equipo ehl eh-kee-poh team
la familia lah fah-meel-yah family
la gente lah hehn-teh people
el grupo ehl groo-poh group
la pareja lah pah-reh-hah couple
el pśblico ehl poo-blee-koh audience
todo el mundo toh-doh ehl moon-doh everybody
A note about regionalisms: Do not be surprised when traveling in certain
regions or countries that the final -s of a plural word is not pronounced.
You can still tell that the noun is plural by paying careful attention to the
marker that accompanies it. This marker will also tell you whether the
noun is masculine or feminine.
COGNATES
A cognate is a Spanish word that is spelled exactly the same, or almost
the same, as a word in English and that has the same meaning.
Sometimes the English word may have been appropriated from Spanish,
letter for letter, and have been incorporated into our own vocabulary.
The only real difference between the two words is in the pronunciation.
The meanings of the Spanish cognates should be quite obvious to anyone
who speaks English.
Perfect Cognates
Following is a list of some cognates that are the same in Spanish and
English. Take time to compare the different pronunciations.
Adjectives
ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION
artificial ahr-tee-fee-see-yahl sociable soh-see-yah-bleh
cruel kroo-ehl tropical troh-pee-kahl
popular poh-poo-lahr usual oo-soo-wahl
22
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 23
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
Masculine Nouns
NOUN PRONUNCIATION NOUN PRONUNCIATION
actor ahk-tohr chocolate choh-koh-lah-teh
animal ah-nee-mahl mosquito mohs-kee-toh
cereal seh-reh-yahl taxi tahk-see
Feminine Nouns
NOUN PRONUNCIATION NOUN PRONUNCIATION
alpaca ahl-pah-kah plaza plah-sah
banana bah-nah-nah radio rrah-dee-yoh
llama yah-mah soda soh-dah
Near Perfect Cognates
The following table lists the cognates that are nearly the same in both
Spanish and English.
Adjectives
ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION
americano ah-meh-ree-kah-noh imposible eem-poh-see-bleh
delicioso deh-lee-see-yoh-soh inteligente een-teh-lee-hehn-teh
diferente dee-feh-rehn-teh interesante een-teh-reh-sahn-teh
excelente eh-seh-lehn-teh moderno moh-der-noh
famoso fah-moh-soh necesario neh-seh-sah-ree-yoh
grande grahn-deh posible poh-see-bleh
importante eem-pohr-tahn-teh
Masculine Nouns
NOUN PRONUNCIATION NOUN PRONUNCIATION
apartamento ah-pahr-tah-mehn-toh diccionario deek-see-yoh-nah-
ree-yoh
automóvil ow-toh-moh-beel garaje gah-rah-heh
café kah-feh grupo groo-poh
calendario kah-lehn-dah-ree-yoh insecto een-sehk-toh
23
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 24
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
plato plah-toh restaurante rrehs-tow-rahn-teh
profesor proh-feh-sohr tigre tee-greh
Feminine Nouns
NOUN PRONUNCIATION NOUN PRONUNCIATION
aspirina ahs-pee-ree-nah gasolina gah-soh-lee-nah
bicicleta bee-see-kleh-tah hamburguesa ahm-boor-geh-sah
blusa bloo-sah medicina meh-dee-see-nah
computadora kohm-poo-tah-doh-rah mśsica moo-see-kah
dieta dee-yeh-tah persona pehr-soh-nah
familia fah-mee-lee-yah rosa rroh-sah
False Friends
False friends are words that are spelled exactly or almost the same in
both languages but have very different meanings in Spanish and English.
These words might even be different parts of speech. Do not allow your-
self to become overconfident and think that every Spanish word that
resembles an English one is automatically a cognate. The following table
will give you some common false friends.
SPANISH PRONUNCIATION MEANING
asistir ah-sees-teer to attend
caro kah-roh expensive, dear
comer koh-mehr to eat
fábrica fah-bree-kah factory
flor flohr flower
hay ah-yee there is, are
librería lee-breh-ree-yah bookstore
joya hoh-yah jewel
mano mah-noh hand
pan pahn bread
sopa soh-pah soup
vaso bah-soh glass
24
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 25
"
2 3 : 0 0 R E C O G N I Z I N G A N D U S I N G N O U N S
When in doubt about the meaning of a word, always verify by using
a bilingual dictionary. Make sure to look at the part of speech so that
you don t confuse a noun with a verb, adjective, or adverb. Cross-check
by looking up the word on both the Spanish and English sides of the
dictionary.
You can easily guess the meaning of many Spanish words that begin
with -e by simply dropping the initial e:
SPANISH PRONUNCIATION MEANING
escena eh-seh-nah scene
Espańa ehs-pah-nyah Spain
especial ehs-peh-see-yahl special
espectáculo ehs-pehk-tah-koo-loh spectacle, show
espía ehs-pee-yah spy
esquíehs-kee ski
estupendo ehs-too-pehn-doh stupendous
25
02 (011-026) chapter 2300 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 26
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
Here is a two-part exercise to find out how you have assimilated what
you ve learned about nouns during the last hour. Try your best not to look
back at the chapter to arrive at your answers.
Part I
Change the markers and plural nouns to their singular forms.
1. los bancos
2. esos platos
3. estas catedrales
4. las flores
5. aquellos hombres
Part II
Change the feminine markers and nouns to their masculine
counterparts.
6. una amiga
7. esa francesa
8. la actriz
9. esta policía
10. aquella profesora
26
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 27
Working with
Present-Tense
Verbs
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Subject nouns and pronouns
" Conjugating -ar verbs
" Conjugating -er and -ir verbs
" Using shoe verbs properly
" Conjugating spelling-change and
irregular yo verbs
" Conjugating other irregular verbs
" Speaking in the present
In this chapter you will learn how to
conjugate verbs in the present tense so
that they agree with their subject noun
or pronoun. By the end of the lesson you
will be able to speak, read, and write
entire sentences in Spanish.
27
27
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 28
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
SUBJECT NOUNS AND PRONOUNS
A pronoun is a word that is used to replace a noun (that is, a person,
place, thing, idea, or quality). A subject pronoun replaces a subject noun
(the noun performing the action of the verb). Pronouns are extremely
useful because they allow for fluidity by eliminating the need to con-
stantly repeat the noun when speaking or writing.
Just as in English, the Spanish subject pronouns in the following table
are given a person and a number (singular or plural).
PERSON SINGULAR PLURAL
first yo (yoh) I nosotros(as) (noh-soh-trohs[ahs]) we
second tÅ› (too) you vosotros(as) (boh-soh-trohs[ahs]) you
third él (ehl) he ellos (eh-yohs) they
ella (eh-yah) she ellas (eh-yahs) they
Ud. (oo-stehd) you Uds. (oo-steh-dehs) you
Note the following about Spanish subject pronouns:
" In Spanish, subject pronouns are used far less frequently than in
English because the verb ending usually indicates the speaker.
Spanish speakers, however, generally use the pronouns usted
(abbreviated as Ud.; formal you, singular) and ustedes (abbreviated
as Uds.; formal you, plural) to clarify that the subject is not él or
ella. All other subject pronouns in Spanish are used mainly for
clarity, emphasis, and politeness.
" Unlike the English pronoun I, the pronoun yo is capitalized only
when it begins a sentence. In all other instances, it remains in
lower case.
" The pronouns nosotras, vosotras, and ellas are used when the
subjects are all females. When the subject consists of a mixed group,
the masculine plural pronoun is always used.
Elena y Roberto salen. Elena and Roberto are going out.
Ellos salen. They are going out.
" The English pronoun it has no Spanish equivalent and is not
expressed as a subject: żDónde está? (Where is it?)
" The subject pronoun tÅ› is used to address one friend, relative, child,
or pet. For this reason, it is referred to as the familiar or informal
form of you. The subject pronoun vosotros(as) is used in Spain and
a few countries in Latin America. It is used in the plural to show
familiarity, and as such, is the plural of the tÅ›, singular familiar
(informal) form.
28
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 29
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
REGULAR VERBS
A verb expresses an action or state of being and is generally shown in its
infinitive, the basic  to form: to live, to laugh, to love. An infinitive is
the form of the verb before it has been conjugated. Conjugation refers to
changing the ending of the verb so that it agrees with the subject noun
or pronoun. Although we do this automatically in English, it will take
some thought and practice in Spanish until verb endings and patterns
become second nature.
Here is an example of a verb conjugated in English:
to speak
SINGULAR PLURAL
First Person I speak We speak
Second Person You speak You speak
Third Person He speaks They speak
She speaks They speak
Notice that the verb is rather simple and is written in only two ways. In
Spanish, you need to know more ways to write the verb and you need to
memorize more verb endings.
Keep in mind that, as in English, you cannot mix and match subjects
and verb forms; each subject has its own personalized matching verb
form that never changes.
Conjugating Regular Verbs
Spanish has regular verbs that are grouped into three main families: -ar,
-er, and -ir verbs. The families are so named because the verb infinitives
end in -ar, -er, or -ir. Each verb within its respective family follows the
same rules of conjugation. After you ve learned the pattern for one family,
you know all the verbs within that family. This rule applies regardless of
the tense being used.
Tense refers to the time period when the action is taking place. This
chapter concentrates on the present tense, that is, what happens here and
now.
Conjugating -ar Verbs. The -ar family is, by far, the largest and most
widely used of regular verb families. To form the present tense of -ar
verbs, drop the -ar from the infinitive and add the following endings,
indicated in bold, for the subject pronouns listed. The following table
gives the conjugation for the verb hablar (to speak).
29
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 30
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
yo hablo yoh ah-bloh I speak
tÅ› hablas too ah-blahs you speak
él habla ehl ah-blah he speaks
ella habla eh-yah ah-blah she speaks
Ud. habla oo-stehd ah-blah you speak
nosotros hablamos noh-soh-trohs ah-blah-mohs we speak
vosotros habláis boh-soh-trohs ah-blah-yees you speak
ellos hablan eh-yohs ah-blahn they speak
ellas hablan eh-yahs ah-blahn they speak
Uds. hablan oo-steh-dehs ah-blahn you speak
Another possible meaning for all present tense verbs uses a form of the
word do plus the verb: I do speak. She does speak.
You should now be able to conjugate the common -ar verbs given in
the list below. Take note of all the cognates, marked with an asterisk (*),
which will make communication in Spanish a much easier task.
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
*acompańar ah-kohm-pah-nyahr to accompany
*adorar ah-doh-rahr to adore
alimentar ah-lee-mehn-tahr to feed
alquilar ahl-kee-lahr to rent
*anunciar ah-noon-see-yahr to announce
apagar ah-pah-gahr to turn off
arreglar ah-rreh-glahr to fix, adjust
aterrizar ah-teh-rree-sahr to land
avisar ah-bee-sahr to warn
ayudar ah-yoo-dahr to help
bailar bah-yee-lahr to dance
bajar bah-hahr to go down, get off
buscar boos-kahr to look for
cambiar kahm-bee-yahr to change
30
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 31
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
caminar kah-mee-nahr to walk
cantar kahn-tahr to sing
cobrar koh-brahr to cash, charge
comprar kohm-prahr to buy
contestar kohn-tehs-tahr to answer
cortar kohr-tahr to cut
cruzar kroo-sahr to cross
dejar deh-hahr to let, allow, leave
desear deh-seh-yahr to desire
durar doo-rahr to last
enseńar ehn-seh-nyahr to teach, show
*entrar ehn-trahr to enter
escuchar ehs-koo-chahr to listen (to)
esperar ehs-peh-rahr to hope, wait for
*estudiar ehs-too-dee-yahr to study
evitar eh-bee-tahr to avoid
*explicar eh-splee-kahr to explain
*expresar eh-spreh-sahr to express
firmar feer-mahr to sign
ganar gah-nahr to win, earn
gastar gahs-tahr to spend
guardar gwahr-dahr to watch, keep
hablar ah-blahr to speak, talk
hallar ah-yahr to find
*invitar een-bee-tahr to invite
lavar lah-bahr to wash
llegar yeh-gahr to arrive
llenar yeh-nahr to fill
llevar yeh-bahr to wear, carry
31
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 32
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
mandar mahn-dahr to order
mirar mee-rahr to look at
montar mohn-tahr to go up, ride
nadar nah-dahr to swim
necesitar neh-seh-see-tahr to need
olvidar ohl-bee-dahr to forget
pagar pah-gahr to pay
pasar pah-sahr to spend (time)
*practicar prahk-tee-kahr to practice
preguntar preh-goon-tahr to ask
*preparar preh-pah-rahr to prepare
*presentar preh-sehn-tahr to introduce
prestar prehs-tahr to lend
regresar rreh-greh-sahr to return
*reparar rreh-pah-rahr to repair
*reservar rreh-sehr-bahr to reserve
saludar sah-loo-dahr to greet
*telefonear teh-leh-foh-neh-yahr to phone
*terminar tehr-mee-nahr to end
tirar tee-rahr to throw
tocar toh-kahr to touch, play
(an instrument)
tomar toh-mahr to drink, take
*usar oo-sahr to use, wear
viajar bee-yah-hahr to travel
*visitar bee-see-tahr to visit
Conjugating -er Verbs. The -er verb family is much smaller than the -ar
verb family. To form the present tense of -er verbs, drop the -er from the
infinitive and add the following endings, indicated in bold, for the sub-
ject pronouns listed. The following table shows you how the verb comer
(to eat) looks when it is conjugated.
32
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 33
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
yo como yoh koh-moh I eat
tÅ› comes too koh-mehs you eat
él come ehl koh-meh he eats
ella come eh-yah koh-meh she eats
Ud. come oo-stehd koh-meh you eat
nosotros comemos noh-soh-trohs koh-meh-mohs we eat
vosotros coméis boh-soh-trohs koh-meh-yees you eat
ellos comen eh-yohs koh-mehn they eat
ellas comen eh-yahs koh-mehn they eat
Uds. comen oo-steh-dehs koh-mehn you eat
The following is a list of common -er verbs that you should know. Notice
that this list is much smaller than the one for -ar verbs. The asterisk (*)
indicates easily recognizable cognates.
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
aprender ah-prehn-dehr to learn
beber beh-behr to drink
comer koh-mehr to eat
*comprender kohm-prehn-dehr to comprehend,
understand
correr koh-rrehr to run
creer kreh-yehr to believe
deber deh-behr to have to, owe
leer leh-yehr to read
*prometer proh-meh-tehr to promise
*responder rrehs-pohn-dehr to respond
*vender behn-dehr to sell
Conjugating -ir Verbs. The -ir verb family is also quite small. To form the
present tense of -ir verbs, drop the -ir from the infinitive and add the end-
ings, indicated in bold, for the subject pronouns listed. The following
table shows how the verb abrir (to open) looks when it is conjugated.
33
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 34
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
yo abro yoh ah-broh I open
tÅ› abres too ah-brehs you open
él abre ehl ah-breh he opens
ella abre eh-yah ah-breh she opens
Ud. abre oo-stehd ah-breh you open
nosotros abrimos noh-soh-trohs ah-bree-mohs we open
vosotros abrís boh-soh-trohs ah-brees you open
ellos abren eh-yohs ah-brehn they open
ellas abren eh-yahs ah-brehn they open
Uds. abren oo-steh-dehs ah-brehn you open
See the list below for common -ir verbs.
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
abrir ah-breer to open
asistir ah-sees-teer to attend
*aplaudir ah-plow-deer to applaud
cubrir koo-breer to cover
*decidir deh-see-deer to decide
*describir dehs-kree-beer to describe
escribir ehs-kree-beer to write
*omitir oh-mee-teer to omit
partir pahr-teer to divide, share
recibir rreh-see-beer to receive
subir soo-beer to go up, climb
sufrir soo-freer to suffer
vivir bee-beer to live
Notice that -er and -ir verbs have the same endings except for the nosotros
and vosotros forms, where -er verbs use an e and -ir verbs use an i.
34
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 35
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
SHOE VERBS
Verbs with certain spelling changes and irregularities are referred to as
shoe verbs because the subject pronouns that follow one set of rules can
be placed inside the shoe, and the other subject pronouns remain outside
the shoe. To make this clearer, look at the pronouns that go inside and
outside of the shoe:
yo nosotros
tÅ› vosotros
él, ella, Ud. ellos, ellas, Uds.
The infinitives of shoe verbs are often written with the type of change
necessary in parentheses, as in pensar (ie).
Verbs Ending in -ar and -er. The vowel within the stem of the verb changes
as follows:
e to ie in all forms except for nosotros and vosotros
o to ue in all forms except for nosotros and vosotros
pensar (pehn-sahr) to think
yo pienso nosotros pensamos
tÅ› piensas vosotros pensáis
él, ella, Ud. piensa ellos, ellas, Uds. piensan
Other verbs like pensar are atravesar (ah-trah-beh-sahr) to cross, cerrar
(seh-rrahr) to close, *comenzar (koh-mehn-sahr), *confesar (kohn-feh-
sahr), empezar (ehm-peh-sahr) to begin, and recordar (rreh-kohr-dahr)
to remember.
querer (keh-rehr) to wish, want
yo quiero nosotros queremos
tÅ› quieres vosotros queréis
él, ella, Ud. quiere ellos, ellas, Uds. quieren
35
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 36
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Other verbs like querer are *ascender (ah-sehn-dehr), *defender (deh-fehn-
dehr), *descender (deh-sehn-dehr), entender (ehn-tehn-dehr) to under-
stand, and perder (pehr-dehr) to lose.
encontrar (ehn-kohn-trahr) to meet, find
yo encuentro nosotros encontramos
tÅ› encuentras vosotros encontráis
él, ella, Ud. encuentra ellos, ellas, Uds. encuentran
Other verbs like encontrar are almorzar (ahl-mohr-sahr) to eat lunch,
contar (kohn-tahr) to tell or count, and mostrar (mohs-trahr) to show.
volver (bohl-behr) to return, go back
yo vuelvo nosotros volvemos
tÅ› vuelves vosotros volvéis
él, ella, Ud. vuelve ellos, ellas, Uds. vuelven
Other verbs like volver are devolver (deh-bohl-behr) to return or give
back, poder (poh-dehr) to be able to, and *resolver (rreh-sohl-behr).
While we have studied verbs where o changes to ue within the shoe,
there is one slightly irregular verb, the verb jugar (hoo-gahr) to play,
where u changes to ue in all forms except nosotros and vosotros:
jugar (hoo-gahr) to play
yo juego nosotros jugamos
tÅ› juegas vosotros jugáis
él, ella, Ud. juega ellos, ellas, Uds. juegan
Verbs Ending in -ir. The vowel within the stem of the verb changes as
follows in all forms except nosotros and vosotros:
e to ie
o to ue
e to i
preferir (preh-feh-reer) to prefer
yo prefiero nosotros preferimos
tÅ› prefieres vosotros preferís
él, ella, Ud. prefiere ellos, ellas, Uds. prefieren
36
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 37
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
Other verbs like preferir are advertir (ahd-behr-teer) to notify, *consentir
(kohn-sehn-teer), mentir (mehn-teer) to lie, *referir (rreh-feh-reer), and
sentir (sehn-teer) to feel, regret, or feel sorry.
dormir (dohr-meer) to sleep
yo duermo nosotros dormimos
tÅ› duermes vosotros dormís
él, ella, Ud. duerme ellos, ellas, Uds. duermen
Another verb like dormir is morir (moh-reer) to die.
servir (sehr-beer) to serve
yo sirvo nosotros servimos
tÅ› sirves vosotros servís
él, ella, Ud. sirve ellos, ellas, Uds. sirven
Other verbs like servir are gemir (heh-meer) to moan, *impedir (eem-
peh-deer), medir (meh-deer) to measure, pedir (peh-deer) to ask, and
*repetir (rreh-peh-teer).
Verbs Ending in -uir. For verbs ending in -uir, except those ending in -guir,
insert a y after the u in all forms except nosotros and vosotros.
contribuir (kohn-tree-boo-weer) to contribute
yo contribuyo nosotros contribuimos
tÅ› contribuyes vosotros contribuís
él, ella, Ud. contribuye ellos, ellas, Uds. contribuyen
Other verbs like contribuir include concluir (kohn-kloo-weer) to conclude,
construir (kohn-stroo-weer) to construct, destruir (deh-stroo-weer) to
destroy, incluir (een-kloo-weer) to include, and sustituir (soo-stee-too-
weer) to substitute.
Verbs Ending in -iar and -uar. Some verbs ending in -iar and -uar require
an accent on the i or u respectively, in all forms except nosotros and
vosotros.
37
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 38
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
enviar (ehn-bee-yahr) to send
yo envío nosotros enviamos
tÅ› envías vosotros enviáis
él, ella, Ud. envía ellos, ellas, Uds. envían
Other verbs like enviar are confiar en (kohn-fee-yahr ehn) to trust, espiar
(ehs-pee-yahr) to spy, guiar (gee-yahr) to guide, and *variar (bah-ree-yahr).
actuar (ahk-too-wahr) to act
yo actśo nosotros actuamos
tÅ› actÅ›as vosotros actuáis
él, ella, Ud. actÅ›a ellos, ellas, Uds. actÅ›an
Another verb like actuar is *continuar (kohn-tee-noo-wahr).
Conjugating Spelling-Change and Irregular Yo Verbs
Some verbs in Spanish require a spelling change in order to preserve
correct pronunciation according to the rules of the language. Note the
changes that occur in verbs with these endings:
" Verbs ending in consonant + -cer or -cir change c to z before o or a:
convencer (kohn-behn-sehr) to convince: yo convenzo
esparcir (eh-spahr-seer) to spread: yo esparzo
" Verbs ending in vowel + -cer or -cir change c to zc before o or a:
conocer (koh-noh-sehr) to know: yo conozco
conducir (kohn-doo-seer) to drive: yo conduzco
" Verbs ending in -ger or -gir change g to j before o or a:
coger (koh-hehr) to seize: yo cojo
dirigir (dee-ree-heer) to direct: yo dirijo
escoger (ehs-koh-hehr) to choose: yo escojo
exigir (ehg-see-heer) to demand: yo exijo
fingir (feen-heer) to pretend: yo finjo
proteger (proh-teh-heer) to protect: yo protejo
recoger (rreh-koh-hehr) to pick up: yo recojo
38
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 39
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
" Verbs ending in -guir change gu to g before o or a:
distinguir (dees-teen-geer) to distinguish: yo distingo
The verb seguir (seh-geer) to follow or continue, is a common verb that
has a stem change and a spelling change:
yo sigo nosotros seguimos
tÅ› sigues vosotros seguís
él, ella, Ud. sigue ellos, ellas, Uds. siguen
Other verbs like seguir are conseguir (kohn-seh-geer) to obtain, perseguir
(pehr-seh-geer) to pursue, and proseguir (proh-seh-geer) to continue.
IRREGULAR VERBS
A good number of high-frequency Spanish verbs are irregular. Irregular
means that they follow no specific rules of conjugation, and you must
memorize them. Some of these verbs are used in idiomatic expressions
that can help you speak the language more colloquially.
An idiom is a particular word or expression whose meaning cannot be
readily understood by either its grammar or the words used. Idiomatic
expressions cannot be translated word for word without causing confu-
sion. Imagine trying to grammatically explain to a non-native English
speaker the meaning of:
It s raining cats and dogs.
They fell for it hook, line, and sinker.
Verbs Only Irregular for Yo
The following high-frequency verbs have irregular yo forms only in the
present tense. You should commit them to memory because you will use
them often:
" conocer (koh-noh-sehr) to know: yo conozco. Other verbs like cono-
cer are agradecer (ah-grah-deh-sehr) to thank, crecer (kreh-sehr) to
grow, merecer (meh-reh-sehr) to deserve, ofrecer (oh-freh-sehr) to
offer, reconocer (rreh-koh-noh-sehr) to recognize.
" caer (kah-yehr) to fall: yo caigo
" dar (dahr) to give: yo doy. The following list gives the most common
idiomatic expressions that use the verb dar.
EXPRESSION MEANING EXAMPLE
dar a to face Mi casa da al mar.
(My house faces the sea.)
39
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 40
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
dar las gracias (a) to thank Me dan las gracias.
(They thank me.)
dar un paseo to take a walk żQuieres dar un paseo?
(Do you want to take a walk?)
dar una vuelta to take a stroll Vamos a dar una vuelta.
(We are going to take a stroll.)
darse cuenta de to realize Me doy cuenta de mi error.
(I realize my mistake.)
darse prisa to hurry Tengo que darme prisa.
(I have to hurry.)
" hacer (ah-sehr) to make, do: yo hago. Below is a list of common
idiomatic expressions that use the verb hacer.
EXPRESSION MEANING EXAMPLE
hacer buen (mal) to be nice (bad) Hace buen tiempo.
tiempo weather (It s nice weather.)
hacer frío (calor) to be cold (hot) Hace calor. (It s hot.)
weather
hacer una pregunta to ask a question Hágame una pregunta.
(Ask me a question.)
hacer un viaje to take a trip Hago un viaje a Roma.
(I m taking a trip to Rome.)
hacerse + noun to become Nos hacemos amigos.
(We re becoming friends.)
" poner (poh-nehr) to put: yo pongo
" saber (sah-behr) to know a fact, to know how to: yo sé
" salir (sah-leer) to go out: yo salgo
" traducir (trah-doo-seer) to translate: yo traduzco. Other verbs like
traducir are conducir (kohn-doo-seer) to drive, conduct, or lead,
*producir (proh-doo-seer), *reducir (rreh-doo-seer).
" traer (trah-yehr) to bring: yo traigo
" ver (behr) to see: yo veo
Other Irregular Verbs
The following verbs are irregular in all forms, and you should memorize
them:
40
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 41
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
decir (deh-seer) to say, tell
yo digo (dee-goh) nosotros decimos (deh-see-mohs)
tÅ› dices (dee-sehs) vosotros decís (deh-sees)
él, ella, Ud. dice (dee-seh) ellos, ellas, Uds. dicen (dee-sehn)
estar (eh-stahr) to be
yo estoy (eh-stoy) nosotros estamos (eh-stah-mohs)
tÅ› estás (eh-stahs) vosotros estáis (eh-stah-yees)
él, ella, Ud. está (eh-stah) ellos, ellas, Uds. están (eh-stahn)
The following are the very common idiomatic expressions that use the
verb estar:
EXPRESSION MEANING EXAMPLE
estar a punto de to be just about to Estoy a punto de salir.
(+ infinitive) (I m just about to leave.)
estar por to be inclined to Estoy por cocinar.
(+ infinitive) (I m inclined to cook.)
estar de acuerdo to be in agreement Estoy de acuerdo con Ud.
(I agree with you.)
ir (eer) to go
yo voy (boy) nosotros vamos (bah-mohs)
tÅ› vas (bahs) vosotros vais (bah-yees)
él, ella, Ud. va (bah) ellos, ellas, Uds. van (bahn)
oír (oh-eer) to hear
yo oigo (oy-goh) nosotros oímos (oh-ee-mohs)
tÅ› oyes (oy-ehs) vosotros oís (oh-ees)
él, ella, Ud. oye (oy-eh) ellos, ellas, Uds. oyen (oy-ehn)
ser (sehr) to be
yo soy (soy) nosotros somos (soh-mohs)
tÅ› eres (eh-rehs) vosotros sois (soh-yees)
él, ella, Ud. es (ehs) ellos, ellas, Uds. son (sohn)
41
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 42
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
tener (tehn-ehr) to have
yo tengo (tehn-goh) nosotros tenemos (teh-neh-mohs)
tÅ› tienes (tee-yeh-nehs) vosotros tenéis (teh-neh-yees)
él, ella, Ud. tiene ellos, ellas, Uds. tienen (tee-yeh-nehn)
(tee-yeh-neh)
In most instances, if a larger verb form contains an irregular verb you rec-
ognize, the chances are great that you may use the conjugation endings
of the smaller verb. Tener is contained in contener (cohn-teh-nehr) to
contain, detener (deh-teh-nehr) to detain, entretener (ehn-treh-teh-nehr)
to entertain, mantener (mahn-teh-nehr) to maintain, obtener (ohb-teh-
nehr) to obtain and sostener (soh-steh-nehr) to sustain. You conjugate
these verbs as you would tener.
Although English speakers use the verb  to be when speaking about
certain physical conditions, Spanish speakers use the verb  to have
(tener) plus a noun to express the same thought.
The following list gives the very common idiomatic expressions that
use the verb tener:
EXPRESSION MEANING EXAMPLE
tener . . . ańos to be . . . years old Yo tengo veinte ańos.
(I m twenty years old.)
tener calor (frío) to be hot (cold) Yo tengo calor. (I m hot.)
tener cuidado to be careful Tenga cuidado. (Be careful.)
tener ganas de to feel like Tengo ganas de salir.
(I feel like going out.)
tener hambre to be hungry Tenemos hambre.
(We re hungry.)
tener sed to be thirsty Tienen sed. (They are thirsty.)
tener miedo de to be afraid of Tengo miedo de eso.
(I m afraid of that.)
tener prisa to be in a hurry Ella tiene prisa.
(She s in a hurry.)
tener que to have to Tengo que estudiar.
(I have to study.)
tener razón to be right Ud. tiene razón. (You re right.)
tener suerte to be lucky Tengo suerte. (I m lucky.)
42
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 43
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
venir (beh-neer) to come
yo vengo (behn-goh) nosotros venimos (beh-nee-mohs)
tÅ› vienes (bee-yeh-nehs) vosotros venís (beh-nees)
él, ella, Ud. viene ellos, ellas, Uds. vienen (bee-yeh-nehn)
(bee-yeh-neh)
USES OF THE PRESENT TENSE
The present tense is customarily used instead of the future tense to ask
for instructions or to discuss an action that will take place in the imme-
diate future:
Yo preparo la cena? Shall I prepare dinner?
Yo te veo pronto. I ll see you soon.
To express an event that began in the past and is continuing in the present,
use the following formulas for questions and answers. Questions con-
taining hace + que must be answered with hace + que. Those questions
containing desde must be answered with desde.
żCuánto tiempo hace + que + present tense?
żCuánto tiempo hace que vives aquí?
How long have you been living here?
hace + an expression of time + que + present tense
Hace un aÅ„o que vivo aquí.
I ve been living here for a year.
żDesde cuándo + present tense?
żDesde cuándo vives aquí?
How long have you been living here?
present tense + desde
Vivo aquí desde hace un aÅ„o.
I ve been living here a year.
43
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 44
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
NOTE
When it is necessary to use two verbs in succession, the first verb is
conjugated and the second verb remains in the infinitive:
Yo quiero salir. I want to go out.
Ellos pueden bailar. They can dance.
THE PRESENT PROGRESSIVE
Whereas the present tense expresses what the subject generally does
at any given time, the present progressive expresses what the subject is
doing now. The present progressive is formed as follows: estar (conjugated)
+ present participle (gerund the -ing form).
Gerunds are formed as follows:
" From -ar verb infinitives, drop -ar and add -ando: Yo estoy
cantando. (I m singing.)
" From -er and -ir verb infinitives, drop -er or -ir and add -iendo:
Él no está comiendo. He s not eating.
Estamos escribiendo We re writing a poem.
un poema.
For -er and -ir verbs whose stems end in a vowel, add -yendo:
creer (to believe) creyendo
leer (to read) leyendo
oír (to hear) oyendo
traer (to bring) trayendo
" Stem-changing -ir verbs change the stem vowel from e to i and from
o to u:
decir (to say, tell) diciendo
dormir (to sleep) durmiendo
morir (to die) muriendo
pedir (to ask) pidiendo
sentir (to feel) sintiendo
venir (to come) viniendo
44
03 (027-046) chapter 2200 8/1/03 10:33 AM Page 45
"
2 2 : 0 0 W O R K I N G W I T H P R E S E N T - T E N S E V E R B S
" Note the following irregular gerunds:
ir (to go) yendo
poder (to be able to) pudiendo
TIME S UP!
Without looking back, try to correctly complete this short story about a boy
and his friend. Conjugate the verbs carefully.
Yo (1. estar) en casa. Yo (2. ser) un muchacho muy
aplicado. Yo (3. tener) hambre. Yo (4. querer) comer.
Yo (5. poder) preparar una comida deliciosa. Yo
(6. buscar) los ingredientes. Yo (7. medir) todo con cuidado.
Yo no (8. sustituir) nada. Mi madre (9. venir) a la
cocina. Nosotros (10. ir) a comer mi excelente arroz con pollo.
45
This page intentionally left blank.
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 47
The Past Tense
(The Preterit)
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using the preterit
" Using -ir stem-changing verbs and
irregular verbs in the preterit
" Using the present and preterit perfect
tenses
" Forming the imperfect and the pluperfect
" The preterit versus the imperfect
In this chapter you ll learn when to use
the preterit and when to use the imperfect.
You ll also learn how to recognize the
present perfect tense (implying the past)
and the past perfect tenses, and when to
use each.
47
47
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 48
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
FORMING THE PRETERIT
The preterit, which expresses an action or event completed at a specific
time in the past, is referred to in Spanish as el pretérito.
The preterit of regular verbs is formed by dropping the -ar, -er, or -ir
infinitive endings and adding the following preterit endings as shown
here.
PRONOUN -AR VERBS -ER AND -IR VERBS
yo -é (eh) -í (ee)
tÅ› -aste (ahs-teh) -iste (ees-teh)
él, ella, Ud. -ó (oh) -ió (ee-yoh)
nosotros -amos (ah-mohs) -imos (ee-mohs)
vosotros -asteis (ahs-teh-yees) -isteis (ees-teh-yees)
ellos, ellas, Uds. -aron (ah-rohn) -ieron (ee-yeh-rohn)
Verbs That Change i to y
Except for the verb traer (to bring) and verbs ending in -guir, which are
regular in the preterit, all -er and -ir verbs that end in a vowel when the
infinitive ending is dropped, change i to y in the third person singular
(él, ella, Ud.) and plural (ellos, ellas, Uds.) forms. The first and second
person forms all have an accented i: í.
STEM YO TÚ ÉL NOSOTROS VOSOTROS ELLOS
ca ca
er
(to fall)
cre cre
er
(to believe)
le le -í -íste -yó -ímos -ísteis -yeron
er
(to read)
oír o

(to hear)
pose pose
er
(to possess)
Verbs ending in -uir (construir, distribuir, incluir, and so on) follow the
i to y change but do not accent the i in the tÅ›, nosotros, or vosotros
forms: incluí, incluiste, incluyó, incluimos, incluisteis, incluyeron.
48
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 49
"
2 1 : 0 0 T H E P A S T T E N S E ( T H E P R E T E R I T )
Verbs Ending in -car, -gar, and -zar
Verbs ending in -car, -gar, and -zar have the following changes only in
the yo form of the preterit:
c changes to qu aplicar (to apply) yo apliqué
g changes to gu castigar (to punish) yo castigué
z changes to c avanzar (to advance) yo avancé
Some common verbs ending in -car are listed here:
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
buscar boos-kahr to look for
comunicar koh-moo-nee-kahr to communicate
explicar eh-splee-kahr to explain
significar seeg-nee-fee-kahr to mean
tocar toh-kahr to touch, to play
(music)
Common -gar verbs are:
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
apagar ah-pah-gahr to turn off
colgar (ue) kohl-gahr to hang
entregar ehn-treh-gahr to deliver
jugar (ue) hoo-gahr to play
llegar yeh-gahr to arrive
Common -zar verbs are:
VERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
almorzar (ue) ahl-mohr-sahr to eat lunch
comenzar(ie) koh-mehn-sahr to begin
empezar (ie) ehm-peh-sahr to begin
gozar goh-sahr to enjoy
49
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 50
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
-ir Stem-Changing Verbs in the Preterit
Present-tense stem-changing (shoe) verbs ending in -ir also have a stem
change in the preterit. In the third person forms, e changes to i, and o
changes to u, as in the following examples:
preferir: preferí, preferiste, prefirió, preferimos, preferisteis, prefirieron
servir: serví, serviste, sirvió, servimos, servisteis, sirvieron
dormir: dormí, dormiste, durmió, dormimos, dormisteis, durmieron
Irregular Verbs in the Preterit
Most irregular verbs in the preterit have the following endings:
yo -e nosotros -imos
tÅ› -iste vosotros -isteis
él, ella, Ud. -o ellos, ellas, Uds. -ieron
The stems of high-frequency irregular verbs are listed below.
VERB STEM MEANING
estar estuv- to be
hacer hic- to do
poder pud- to be able to
poner pus- to put
querer quis- to want
saber sup- to know
tener tuv- to have
venir vin- to come
decir dij- to say, tell
traer traj- to bring
Other irregularities to which you must pay careful attention include:
" If the stem ends in a j, add only -eron in the third person plural:
Ellos dijeron la verdad. (They told the truth.)
" The third person singular (él, ella, Ud.) form of hacer in the
preterit is hizo (ee-soh). This change preserves the soft sound of
the consonant: Ella hizo el trabajo. (She did the work.)
" Dar (to give) is conjugated as follows in the preterit: di, diste,
dio, dimos, disteis, dieron.
50
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 51
"
2 1 : 0 0 T H E P A S T T E N S E ( T H E P R E T E R I T )
" The verbs ser (to be) and ir (to go) have the same preterit forms:
fui, fuiste, fue, fuimos, fuisteis, fueron.
Él fue abogado. He was a lawyer.
Él fue al centro. He went downtown.
" The accent mark is omitted in the preterit forms of dar, ser, ver,
and ir:
dar: di, diste, dio, dimos, disteis, dieron
ir and ser: fui, fuiste, fue, fuimos, fuisteis, fueron
ver: vi, viste, vio, vimos, visteis, vieron
" All verbs ending in -ducir are conjugated in the preterite like
producir: produje, produjiste, produjo, produjimos, produjisteis,
produjeron. Other common verbs ending in -ducir are conducir
(to drive, to conduct); deducir (to deduce); and reducir (to reduce).
" All compounds of verbs (tener, detener, etc.) are conjugated in the
preterit in the same manner as the basic verb.
THE PRESENT PERFECT TENSE
The present perfect tense describes an action that started in the past and
continues to the present, or an action that happened in the past but is in
some way connected to the present.
The present perfect tense is a compound tense. Compound is the key
word because it implies that this tense is made up of more than one part.
In fact, the present perfect, as well as other compound tenses, is made up
of two elements. Observe how this works.
Formation of the Present Perfect
The present perfect of most Spanish verbs is formed by combining the
present tense of haber and the past participle of the verb expressing the
action.
The formula for the formation of the present perfect is: subject (noun
or pronoun) + helping verb + past participle.
The Helping Verb Haber
Because haber means  to have, it serves well as the helping verb. First,
it must be conjugated in the present tense:
yo he (eh) nosotros hemos (eh-mohs)
tÅ› has (ahs) vosotros habéis (ah-beh-yees)
él, ella, Ud. ha (ah) ellos, ellas, Uds. han (ahn)
51
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 52
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
After you have conjugated haber in the appropriate person, you must
add a past participle.
Past Participles of Regular Verbs
The past participle of regular verbs is formed by dropping the -ar, -er, or
-ir infinitive ending and adding -ado for -ar verbs and -ido for -er and
-ir verbs:
habl hablado spoken
ar
comer
 comido eaten
recib recibido received
ir
When an -er or -ir stem ends in a vowel, add an accent mark on the i as
follows:
caer caído fallen
creer creído believed
leer leído read
oír oído heard
English usage often omits the use of the helping verb, although it is
implied. For example,  I prepared the dinner is acceptable for  I have
prepared the dinner. In Spanish, the helping verb is used: He preparado
la cena.
The past participle remains the same for every subject. Only the help-
ing verb changes:
Yo he comido. Nosotros hemos comido.
TÅ› has comido. Vosotros habéis comido.
Él, ella, Ud. ha comido. Ellos, ellas, Uds. han comido.
Past Participles of Irregular Verbs
The verbs shown here, and their compounds (for example, volver,
devolver, etc.), have irregular past participles.
PAST
INFINITIVE PARTICIPLE PRONUNCIATION MEANING
abrir (to open) abierto ah-bee-yehr-toh opened
decir (to say) dicho dee-choh said
escribir (to write) escrito ehs-kree-toh written
hacer (to do) hecho eh-choh done
52
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 53
"
2 1 : 0 0 T H E P A S T T E N S E ( T H E P R E T E R I T )
morir (to die) muerto moo-wehr-toh died
poner (to put) puesto poo-wehs-toh put
romper (to break) roto rroh-toh broken
ver (to see) visto bees-toh seen
volver (to return) vuelto boo-wehl-toh returned
THE PRETERIT PERFECT
The preterit perfect has limited use because it is employed primarily in
formal, literary, and historical writings to express that an action or event
had just ended. The preterit or the pluperfect is preferred in conversation
and informal writing. Therefore, learn the preterit perfect only for recog-
nition, as you will be seeing it primarily in literary works.
The preterit perfect is formed by using the preterit of the helping verb
haber and the past participle. The preterit of haber is:
yo hube (oo-beh) nosotros hubimos (oo-bee-mohs)
tÅ› hubiste (oo-bees-teh) vosotros hubistéis (oo-bee-steh-yees)
él hubo (oo-boh) ellos hubieron (oo-bee-yeh-rohn)
Apenas hube llegado a casa Scarcely had I arrived home when
cuando él me telefoneó. he called me.
En cuanto hubimos entrado, As soon as we had entered,
todo el mundo aplaudió. everybody applauded.
THE IMPERFECT
The imperfect expresses a continuing state or an incomplete action in the
past:
The door was open.
He was watching television.
Regular Verbs
The imperfect of regular verbs is formed by dropping the -ar, -er, or -ir
infinitive ending and adding the imperfect endings:
PRONOUN -AR VERBS -ER AND -IR VERBS
yo -aba (ah-bah) -ía (ee-yah)
tÅ› -abas (ah-bahs) -ías (ee-yahs)
él, ella, Ud. -aba (ah-bah) -ía (ee-yah)
53
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 54
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
nosotros -ábamos (ah-bah-mohs) -íamos (ee-yah-mohs)
vosotros -abais (ah-bah-yees) -íais (ee-yah-yees)
ellos, ellas, Uds. -aban (ah-bahn) -ían (ee-yahn)
Irregular Verbs
There are only three Spanish verbs that are irregular in the imperfect:
YO TÚ ÉL NOSOTROS VOSOTROS ELLOS
ir (to go) iba ibas iba íbamos ibais iban
ser (to be) era eras era éramos érais eran
ver (to see) veía veías veía veíamos veíais veían
THE PLUPERFECT
The pluperfect is used to describe an action that had been completed in
the past before another past action took place:
I had lived there before.
They had eaten in that restaurant in the past.
The pluperfect is actually the compound form of the imperfect. The
pluperfect is composed of two parts: the imperfect of the helping verb
haber (which expresses  had ) and the past participle of the verb indi-
cating the action that took place. The imperfect of haber is:
yo había (ah-bee-yah) nosotros habíamos (ah-bee-yah-mohs)
tÅ› habías (ah-bee-yahs) vosotros habíais (ah-bee-yah-ees)
él había (ah-bee-yah) ellos habían (ah-bee-yahn)
Ella tenía hambre porque ella no había comido nada.
She was hungry because she hadn t eaten anything.
THE PRETERIT VERSUS THE IMPERFECT
The preterit expresses an action that was completed at a specific time in
the past. Think of the action as one moment in time. Think, too, of a
camera. The preterit represents an action that could be captured by an
instamatic the action happened and was completed.
The imperfect, on the other hand, expresses an action that continued
in the past over an indefinite period of time. Think again of a camera.
The imperfect represents an action that could be captured by a video
camera the action continued over a period of time, it was happening,
used to happen, or would (meaning  used to ) happen.
54
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 55
"
2 1 : 0 0 T H E P A S T T E N S E ( T H E P R E T E R I T )
The basic uses of the preterit and the imperfect are summarized in the
following table:
PRETERIT IMPERFECT
1. Expresses specific actions or 1. Describes ongoing or
events that were started and continuous actions or events
completed at a definite time (what was happening) in the
in the past (even if the time past (which may or may not
isn t mentioned). have been completed).
Él preparó la cena. Ella hablaba con su amiga.
He prepared dinner. She was speaking to her friend.
2. Expresses a specific action or 2. Describes habitual or repeated
event that occurred at a actions in the past.
specific point in past time.
Él salió ayer. Generalmente salía a menudo.
He went out yesterday. He usually went out often.
3. Expresses a specific action or 3. Describes a person, place,
event that was repeated a stated thing, or state of mind with
number of times. the verbs creer (to believe),
pensar (to think), querer (to
want), and saber (to know).
Juan telefoneó dos veces. Ella estaba triste.
John called two times. She was unhappy.
Queríamos salir.
We wanted to go out.
4. Expresses time of day.
Era la una.
It was one o clock.
The imperfect is used to describe a situation that was going on in the past
when another action or event took place. The action or event that took
place is in the preterit: Yo salía cuando el teléfono sonó. (I was going out
when the telephone rang.)
When would means  used to, use the imperfect: I would go to the
beach every weekend with my friends.
When would states what the subject would do under specific condi-
tions (I would go to the beach if the weather were nice), use the
conditional, which is discussed in further detail in Chapter 20:00.
55
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 56
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Clues to the Preterit and the Imperfect
The following words and expressions often require the use of the preterit
because they specify a time period:
SPANISH PRONUNCIATION MEANING
ayer ah-yehr yesterday
ayer por la noche ah-yehr pohr lah noh-cheh last night
de repente deh rreh-pehn-teh suddenly
el ańo pasado ehl ah-nyoh pah-sah-doh last year
el otro día ehl oh-troh dee-yah the other day
la semana pasada lah seh-mah-nah pah-sah-dah last week
por fin pohr feen finally
primero pree-meh-roh at first
un día oon dee-yah one day
una vez oo-nah behs one time
The imperfect is used with the following expressions that generally imply
repetition:
SPANISH PRONUNCIATION MEANING
a menudo ah meh-noo-doh often
a veces ah beh-sehs sometimes
cada día kah-dah dee-yah each/every day
de vez en cuando deh behs ehn kwahn-doh from time to time
en general ehn heh-neh-rahl generally
siempre see-yehm-preh always
todo el tiempo toh-doh ehl tee-yehm-poh all the time
todos los días toh-dohs lohs dee-yahs every day
usualmente oo-soo-wahl-mehn-teh usually
Sometimes you may be confused about which form of past tense to use.
Do not be overly concerned about this. In many instances, either the
preterit or the imperfect is acceptable depending upon the meaning the
speaker is trying to convey:
56
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 57
"
2 1 : 0 0 T H E P A S T T E N S E ( T H E P R E T E R I T )
Yo hablé con mis amigas.
I spoke with my friends.
(The action is completed.)
Yo hablaba con mis amigas.
I was speaking to my friends.
(The action was ongoing or continuous in the past.)
TIME S UP!
Read this young girl s story about her past and fill in the correct form of
the verb in the appropriate tense, the preterit or the imperfect:
Cuando yo (1. tener) 14 ańos, yo (2. ir) a la escuela
todos los días para ver a un muchacho en mi clase de espaÅ„ol, Ramón.
Él (3. ser) muy guapo. Desafortunadamente él no
(4. prestar) atención a las muchachas porque siempre
(5. jugar) a los deportes con sus amigos. Pero un día, después de las
clases, él me (6. pedir) mi nÅ›mero de teléfono. Él
(7. querer) salir conmigo. Yo (8. estar) muy contenta.
Nosotros (9. ir) al cine para ver una historia de amor ridícula.
De esta manera yo (10. conocer) a mi futuro marido.
57
04 (047-058) chapter 2100 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 58
This page intentionally left blank.
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 59
Back to the
Future
Speaking Conditionally
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Forming and using the future
" Forming and using the conditional
In this chapter you ll learn how to form,
use, and differentiate between the future
tense and the conditional. You will need to
pay careful attention to the verb endings
and to what you are trying to express.
59
59
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 60
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
THE FUTURE
In Spanish, the future may be expressed in three possible ways: by
using the present, by using ir + a + infinitive, and by using the future
tense. You can expect to encounter any of these forms regularly in daily
conversations.
Using the Present to Express the Future
The present tense may be used to imply the future when asking for
instructions or referring to an action that will take place in the immedi-
ate future. You will instinctively know when the future is implied by the
present through the context of the conversation.
żPongo el libro aquí? Shall I put the book here?
Ella telefonea más tarde. She will call later.
Ir + a + Infinitive
In Spanish, as in English, the near future may be expressed with a form
of the present tense of the verb ir (to go) + a + the infinitive referring to
the action that the speaker will perform. The near future is generally
used for an action that is imminent, that is going to happen soon.
The irregular present tense of ir is conjugated as follows:
ir to go
yo voy (boy) nosotros vamos (bah-mohs)
tÅ› vas (bahs) vosotros vais (bah-yees)
él, ella, Ud. va (bah) ellos, ellas, Uds. van (bahn)
Add a + an infinitive to get the near future:
Voy a ir a Espańa. I m going to go to Spain.
Vamos a viajar en avión. We re going to travel by plane.
THE FUTURE TENSE OF REGULAR VERBS
The future tense tells what the subject will do or what action will take
place in future time. The future tense of all regular verbs is formed by
adding the endings indicated in bold to the infinitive of the verb, as
shown here.
-ar Verbs
hablar to speak
yo hablaré (ah-blah-reh) nosotros hablaremos (ah-blah-reh-mohs)
60
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 61
"
2 0 : 0 0 B A C K T O T H E F U T U R E : S P E A K I N G C O N D I T I O N A L L Y
tÅ› hablarás (ah-blah-rahs) vosotros hablaréis (ah-blah-reh-yees)
él hablará (ah-blah-rah) ellos hablarán (ah-blah-rahn)
-er Verbs
leer to read
yo leeré (leh-yeh-reh) nosotros leeremos (leh-yeh-reh-mohs)
tÅ› leerás (leh-yeh-rahs) vosotros leeréis (leh-yeh-reh-yees)
él leerá (leh-yeh-rah) ellos leerán (leh-yeh-rahn)
-ir Verbs
abrir to open
yo abriré (ah-bree-reh) nosotros abriremos (ah-bree-reh-mohs)
tÅ› abrirás (ah-bree-rahs) vosotros abriréis (ah-bree-reh-yees)
él abrirá (ah-bree-rah) ellos abrirán (ah-bree-rahn)
It is important that you note the following idiosyncrasies about the for-
mation of the future of regular verbs:
" All future endings except -emos have accent marks.
" Verbs that have an accent mark in the infinitive (such as oír)
drop that accent in the future: yo oiré.
THE FUTURE TENSE OF IRREGULAR VERBS
The following verbs have irregular future stems, which always end in -r
or -rr. Just add the future endings to these stems to get the correct future
form:
" Verbs like poder drop the e from the infinitive ending before
adding the future endings:
INFINITIVE STEM
haber (to have) habr-
poder (to be able to) podr-
querer (to want) querr-
saber (to know) sabr-
" Verbs like poner substitute a d for the e or i in the infinitive ending
before adding the future endings:
61
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 62
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
INFINITIVE STEM
poner (to put) pondr-
salir (to go out) saldr-
tener (to have) tendr-
venir (to come) vendr-
" The verbs decir and hacer have irregular future stems:
INFINITIVE STEM
decir (to say, tell) dir-
hacer (to make, do) har-
" Compounds of irregular verbs (such as contener, a compound
of tener) are also irregular.
Uses of the Future
The future is used as follows:
" The future tense, as in English, is used to express what will happen:
Él llegará maÅ„ana. He will arrive tomorrow.
Iremos a Espańa. We will go to Spain.
The future is used to express wonder and probability in the present:
żCuántos aÅ„os tendrá? I wonder how old he is.
Será la medianoche. It s probably midnight.
Estarán viejos. They must be old.
THE FUTURE PERFECT
You use the future perfect to describe an action or event that will hap-
pen in the future before another future action. Because you are express-
ing what will have happened, you need the future of the helping verb
haber + the past participle of the verb that shows the action or event to
have been completed. The future perfect of haber is:
haber to have
yo habré (ah-breh) nosotros habremos (ah-breh-mohs)
tÅ› habrás (ah-brahs) vosotros habréis (ah-breh-yees)
él habrá (ah-brah) ellos habrán (ah-brahn)
62
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 63
"
2 0 : 0 0 B A C K T O T H E F U T U R E : S P E A K I N G C O N D I T I O N A L L Y
Él habrá terminado el trabajo antes de que el día termine.
He will have finished the work before the end of the day.
You may also use the future perfect to express probability in the recent
past:
żLo habrán hecho? I wonder if they did it.
Ella habrá perdido su dinero. She has probably lost her money.
Habré ganado. I must have won.
THE CONDITIONAL
The conditional is not a tense, because it does not indicate a time period.
It is, instead, a mood that expresses what the speaker would do or what
would happen under certain circumstances or conditions.
You form the conditional with the same stem that you use to form the
future, and by adding the endings indicated in bold. Note these are the
same endings used to form the imperfect.
-ar Verbs
hablar to speak
yo hablaría (ah-blah-ree-yah) nosotros hablaríamos (ah-blah-ree-yah-mohs)
tÅ› hablarías (ah-blah-ree-yahs) vosotros hablaríais (ah-blah-ree-yah-ees)
él hablaría (ah-blah-ree-yah) ellos hablarían (ah-blah-ree-yahn)
-er Verbs
leer to read
yo leería (leh-yeh-ree-yah) nosotros leeríamos (leh-yeh-ree-yah-mohs)
tÅ› leerías (leh-yeh-ree-yahs) vosotros leeríais (leh-yeh-ree-yah-ees)
él leería (leh-yeh-ree-yah) ellos leerían (leh-yeh-ree-yahn)
-ir Verbs
abrir to open
yo abriría (ah-bree-ree-yah) nosotros abriríamos (ah-bree-ree-yah-mohs)
tÅ› abrirías (ah-bree-ree-yahs) vosotros abriríais (ah-bree-ree-yah-ees)
él abriría (ah-bree-ree-yah) ellos abrirían (ah-bree-ree-yahn)
63
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 64
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Uses of the Conditional
Use the conditional as follows:
" The conditional is used to express what would happen under certain
conditions: Si hiciera buen tiempo, yo no iría al cine. Yo montaría en
bicicleta. (If the weather were nice, I wouldn t go to the movies. I d
go bike riding.)
When would has the sense of  used to, the imperfect is used:
Viajaba en Europa a menudo. (I would (used to) travel to Europe
often.)
When would has the sense of  to be willing, to want, the preterit
of querer is used: Quise viajar a Europa. (I wanted [was willing]
to travel to Europe.)
" The conditional is used to express wonder and probability in
the past:
żCuántos aÅ„os tendría? I wonder how old you were.
Sería la medianoche. It was probably midnight.
Estarían viejos. They must have been old.
THE PERFECT CONDITIONAL
Use the perfect conditional to describe an action or event that would
have taken place in the past had something else happened.
Because you are expressing what would have happened, you need the
conditional of the helping verb haber + the past participle of the verb
that shows the action or event that would have been completed. The
conditional of haber is:
haber to have
yo habría (ah-bree-yah) nosotros habríamos (ah-bree-yah-mohs)
tÅ› habrías (ah-bree-yahs) vosotros habríais (ah-bree-yah-ees)
él habría (ah-bree-yah) ellos habrían (ah-bree-yan)
Con más tiempo, yo habría With more time, I would have finished
terminado el trabajo. the work.
64
05 (059-066) chapter 2000 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 65
"
2 0 : 0 0 B A C K T O T H E F U T U R E : S P E A K I N G C O N D I T I O N A L L Y
TIME S UP!
Part I
Complete the sentence with the correct form of the future:
En el ańo 2010 yo
1. (ser) más inteligente.
2. (querer) viajar.
3. (tener) mucho dinero.
4. (vivir) en una casa grande.
5. (conducir) un automóvil deportivo.
Part II
Complete the sentence with the correct form of the conditional:
Con un millón de dólares yo
6. (poner) mi dinero en el banco.
7. (dar) mucho dinero a los pobres.
8. (hacer) un viaje a través del mundo.
9. (comprar) un castillo para mi familia.
10. (decir) la verdad a todo el mundo.
65
This page intentionally left blank.
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 67
Adding
Adjectives
and Adverbs
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Making adjectives feminine and/or plural
" Positioning adjectives properly
" Using ser and estar with adjectives
" Forming and using adverbs properly
In this lesson you ll learn how to use
adjectives, how to make them agree with
the nouns they describe, and where to
position them with respect to the noun.
67
67
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 68
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
MAKING ADJECTIVES FEMININE
Most Spanish adjectives form the feminine singular by changing the o of
the masculine adjective to a, as shown in the table below. This table
and the ones that follow will help you build a good, working adjective
vocabulary.
MASCULINE FEMININE MEANING
aburrido (ah-boo-rree-doh) aburrida boring
alto (ahl-toh) alta tall
bajo (bah-hoh) baja short
bonito (boh-nee-toh) bonita pretty
bueno (boo-weh-noh) buena good
delgado (dehl-gah-doh) delgada thin
divertido (dee-behr-tee-doh) divertida fun
enfermo (ehn-fehr-moh) enferma sick
enojado (eh-noh-hah-doh) enojada angry
famoso (fah-moh-soh) famosa famous
feo (feh-yoh) fea ugly
flaco (flah-koh) flaca thin
generoso (heh-neh-roh-soh) generosa generous
gordo (gohr-doh) gorda fat
guapo (goo-wah-poh) guapa pretty
listo (lees-toh) lista smart, ready
malo (mah-loh) mala bad
necesario (neh-seh-sah-ree-yoh) necesaria necessary
nuevo (noo-weh-boh) nueva new
pequeńo (peh-keh-nyoh) pequeńa small
perezoso (peh-reh-soh-soh) perezosa lazy
perfecto (pehr-fehk-toh) perfecta perfect
rico (rree-koh) rica rich
romántico (rroh-mahn-tee-koh) romántica romantic
rubio (rroo-bee-yoh) rubia blond
68
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 69
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
serio (seh-ree-yoh) seria serious
simpático (seem-pah-tee-koh) simpática nice
tímido (tee-mee-doh) tímida shy
tonto (tohn-toh) tonta foolish
viejo (bee-yeh-hoh) vieja old
Past participles of verbs may be used as adjectives. In such cases, the past
participle must agree in gender and number with the noun it describes:
La puerta está cerrada. The door is closed.
Los libros están abiertos. The books are open.
Masculine Adjectives Ending in Letters Other than O
If a masculine adjective ends in -a, -e, or a consonant, you don t have to
make any changes to get the feminine form. Note that most adjectives
ending in -a are feminine, but those on the list below can be both. The
following table demonstrates that these adjectives are spelled and
pronounced in the same manner.
ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION MEANING
alegre ah-leh-greh happy
amable ah-mah-bleh nice
cortés kohr-tehs courteous
difícil dee-fee-seel difficult
eficiente eh-fee-syehn-teh efficient
egoísta eh-goh-ees-tah selfish
excelente ehg-seh-lehn-teh excellent
fácil fah-seel easy
grande grahn-deh big
horrible oh-rree-bleh horrible
importante eem-pohr-tahn-teh important
inteligente een-teh-lee-hen-teh intelligent
interesante een-teh-reh-sahn-teh interesting
joven hoh-behn young
optimista ohp-tee-mees-tah optimistic
69
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 70
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
pesimista peh-see-mees-tah pessimistic
pobre poh-breh poor
popular poh-poo-lahr popular
realista rreh-yah-lees-tah realistic
triste trees-teh sad
Note the following irregularities to these rules:
" Some adjectives of nationality whose masculine form ends in a
consonant add -a to form the feminine:
MASCULINE FEMININE MEANING
espańol espańola Spanish
francés francesa French
alemán alemana German
" Some adjectives whose masculine form ends in -or add -a to form
the feminine:
MASCULINE FEMININE MEANING
hablador habladora talkative
encantador encantadora enchanting
trabajador trabajadora hard-working
MAKING ADJECTIVES PLURAL
The plural of adjectives ending in a vowel is formed by adding s:
SINGULAR PLURAL MEANING
pequeńo pequeńos small
alta altas tall
grande grandes big
The plural of adjectives ending in a consonant is formed by adding -es:
SINGULAR PLURAL MEANING
fácil fáciles easy
popular populares popular
Note the following exceptions to these rules:
70
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 71
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
" Singular adjectives ending in -z change -z to -c in the plural:
SINGULAR PLURAL MEANING
feliz felices happy
feroz feroces ferocious
sagaz sagaces shrewd, astute
" In order to maintain original stress, some adjectives add or drop an
accent mark:
SINGULAR PLURAL
joven (HOH-behn) jóvenes (HOH-beh-nehs)
francés (frahn-SEHS) franceses (frahn-SEH-sehs)
inglés (een-GLEHS) ingleses (een-GLEH-sehs)
POSITION OF ADJECTIVES
The position of adjectives in Spanish follows different rules from those
with which you may be accustomed in English:
" Unlike English, most descriptive adjectives in Spanish follow the
noun they modify:
mis pantalones negros my black pants
una casa nueva a new house
" When an adjective is used to emphasize quality or inherent charac-
teristics, it may be placed before the noun:
Admiro los árboles con sus I admire the trees with
verdes hojas. their green leaves.
Me trae buenos recuerdos. It brings me good memories.
" Adjectives that impose limits (numbers, possessive adjectives,
demonstrative adjectives, and adjectives of quantity) usually
precede the noun:
dos vestidos blancos two white dresses
mis hijos my children
este hombre this man
algÅ›n día someday
tal cosa such a thing
71
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 72
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
otro hombre another man
el śltimo viaje the last trip
Common adjectives of quantity are:
ADJECTIVE PRONUNCIATION MEANING
algunos(-as) ahl-goo-nohs some
cada kah-dah each
cuanto(-a,-os,-as) kwahn-toh as much
más mahs more
menos meh-nohs less
ningunos(-as) neen-goo-nohs no, not any
poco(-a,-os, -as) poh-koh few, little
tanto(-a,-os,-as) tahn-toh so much, many
todo(-a,-os, -as) toh-doh all, very
unos(-as) oo-nohs some
varios(-as) bah-ree-yohs several
" When more than one adjective is used in a description, put each
adjective in its proper place, either before or after the noun, accord-
ing to the previously mentioned rules. Two adjectives in the same
position are joined by y (and):
dos casas rojas two red houses
un nińo grande y flaco a tall, thin boy
mis malos recuerdos my bad memories
" The masculine plural form of the adjective is used when it modifies
two or more nouns of different gender: El muchacho y la muchacha
son ambiciosos. (The boy and the girl are ambitious.)
Shortened Forms of Adjectives
Spanish adjectives may take on shortened forms. Follow these rules for
shortening adjectives in certain situations.
Some adjectives drop the final -o before a masculine singular noun:
ADJECTIVE EXAMPLE MEANING
uno un hombre a man
bueno un buen libro a good book
72
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 73
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
malo un mal ańo a bad year
primero el primer piso the first floor
tercero el tercer día the third day
alguno algśn muchacho some boy
ninguno ningśn amigo no friend
NOTE
An accent is added to the u of alguno and ninguno when the -o is dropped.
If the adjective is separated from the noun by a preposition, then the
original adjective is used:
uno de mis amigos one of my friends
When grande is placed before a singular masculine or feminine noun it
becomes gran and means  important, famous. When it is placed after
the noun it is not shortened and means  large :
un gran actor a great actor
una gran actriz a great actress
But:
un apartamento grande a large apartment
una casa grande a large house
(See page 74 for more adjectives that change meaning depending on
placement.)
Ciento becomes cien before a masculine or feminine noun and before the
numbers mil and millones:
cien muchachos one hundred boys
cien muchachas one hundred girls
cien mil personas one hundred thousand people
cien millones de personas one hundred million people
But:
doscientas personas two hundred people
ciento cincuenta libros one hundred fifty books
73
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 74
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
The masculine Santo becomes San before the name of a saint whose
name does not begin with To- or Do-:
San Juan Saint John
But:
Santo Domingo Saint Dominick
Adjectives with Different Meanings
Some adjectives have different meanings depending on whether they are
positioned before or after the noun they modify. Adjectives before the
noun tend to have a more literal meaning. When these adjectives follow
the noun, the meaning changes:
una costumbre antigua an old (ancient) custom
una antigua costumbre an old (former) custom
una cosa cierta a sure thing
una cierta cosa a certain thing
un hombre grande a tall (large, big) man
un gran hombre a great man (quality, not size)
el cuarto mismo the room itself
el mismo cuarto the same room
la gente pobre the poor people (without money)
la pobre gente the unfortunate people
una razón simple a silly reason
una simple rázon a simple reason
una mujer triste a sad (unhappy) woman
una triste mujer a sad (sorry, wretched) woman
USING SER AND ESTAR WITH ADJECTIVES
Because two verbs in Spanish express to be, it is important that you
understand the differences in their usage, especially when you use them
with adjectives.
74
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 75
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
Both ser and estar are irregular verbs and require that you memorize
them.
SER ESTAR
yo soy estoy
tÅ› eres estás
él, ella, Ud. es está
nosotros somos estamos
vosotros sois estáis
ellos, ellas, Uds. son están
Carefully study the uses of ser to ensure that you use it correctly. Then
compare the uses of ser with those of estar. Naturally it is best to use
each verb properly, but keep in mind that if you make a mistake, you will
still be understood.
SER ESTAR
1. Expresses a natural quality 1. Expresses a temporary
or inherent characteristic that state, condition, or phase
will not change. or the result of an action
that may change.
Marta es colombiana. Marta está enferma.
Martha is Colombian. Martha is sick.
La puerta es de madera. La puerta está abierta.
The door is made of wood. The door is open.
2. Expresses traits that will 2. Expresses a location or
probably not change soon. position of the subject.
Mi hermana es abogada. Ella está en su oficina.
My sister is a lawyer. She is in her office.
Juan es rubio. żDónde está Juan?
Juan is blond. Where is Juan?
3. Expresses time and dates. 3. Is used to form the
progressive tenses with
the gerund.
Es la una. Está nevando.
It is one o clock. It is snowing.
Es el once de julio. Estamos jugando.
It is July 11th. We are playing.
75
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 76
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
4. Expresses possession.
Es mi coche.
It s my car.
5. Is used with impersonal
expressions.
Es necesario estudiar.
It is necessary to study.
6. Expresses a passive action
with the past participle and an
adjective.
La puerta fue abierta por Juan.
The door was opened by Juan.
Some adjectives may be used with either verb, but will have different
meanings according to the verb that is used:
SER (CHARACTERISTICS) ESTAR (CONDITIONS)
Él no es aburrido. Él no está aburrido.
He isn t boring. He isn t bored.
Él es bueno (malo). La comida está buena (mala).
He is good (bad). The meal is good (bad).
Soy listo. Estoy listo.
I m clever (smart). I m ready.
Es pálida. Está pálida.
She has a pale complexion. She is pale.
Es seguro. Está seguro.
It is safe (reliable). He is sure.
Ella es viva. Ella está viva.
She is quick (sharp). She is alive.
Ud. es joven (viejo). Ud. está joven (viejo).
You are young (old). You look young (old).
76
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 77
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
ADVERBS
An adverb is often a word that describes how the subject performs an
action. In English, many adverbs end in -ly. The Spanish equivalent end-
ing is -mente. Because adverbs modify verbs, you don t need to worry
about the agreement of adverbs.
Forming Adverbs
Adverbs are formed by adding -mente (mehn-teh) to the feminine singu-
lar form of the adjective as shown here.
MASCULINE FEMININE
ADJECTIVE ADJECTIVE ADVERB MEANING
claro clara claramente clearly
completo completa completamente completely
diligente diligente diligentemente diligently
especial especial especialmente especially
fácil fácil fácilmente easily
final final finalmente finally
frecuente frecuente frecuentemente frequently
lento lenta lentamente slowly
rápido rápida rápidamente quickly
Adverbial Phrases
The preposition con (with) + noun may be used to form an adverbial
phrase. You can modify a verb by saying with + a noun: con claridad
(with clarity), or by using the corresponding adverb: claramente (clearly).
Él habla con claridad. He speaks (with clarity) clearly.
Él habla claramente. He speaks clearly.
CON + NOUN ADVERB MEANING
con claridad claramente clearly
con cuidado cuidadosamente carefully
con habilidad hábilmente skillfully
con paciencia pacientemente patiently
ADJECTIVES VERSUS ADVERBS
Pay attention to the Spanish words that have distinct forms for adjectives
and adverbs:
77
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 78
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
ADJECTIVE EXAMPLE MEANING
bueno (good) buenos días good day(s)
malo (bad) malos sueńos bad dreams
bien (well) Baila bien. He dances well.
mal (badly) Canta mal. She sings poorly.
Some Spanish words may be used as adjectives or adverbs:
ADJECTIVE ADVERB
más Tengo más joyas. Corro más rápidamente.
more I have more jewels. I run more rapidly.
menos Tengo menos joyas. Corro menos rápidamente.
less, fewer I have fewer jewels. I run less quickly.
poco Tengo pocas joyas. Corro poco.
few, little I have few jewels. I run little.
mucho Tengo muchas joyas. Corro mucho.
much, many I have many jewels. I run a lot.
mejor Tengo mejores joyas. Corro mejor.
better I have better jewels. I run better.
peor Tengo peores joyas. Corro peor.
worse I have worse jewels. I run worse.
demasiado Tengo demasiadas joyas. Corro demasiado.
too much, many I have too many jewels. I run too much.
When used as adjectives, mucho, poco, and demasiado agree in number
and gender with the nouns they modify; mejor and peor only agree in
number, forming the plural by adding -es; más and menos do not change.
As adverbs, all of these words remain invariable.
Some adverbs and adverbial expressions are not formed from adjec-
tives and, therefore, do not end in -mente. Here are the most common
adverbs in this category.
78
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 79
"
1 9 : 0 0 A D D I N G A D J E C T I V E S A N D A D V E R B S
ADVERB PRONUNCIATION MEANING
ahora ah-oh-rah now
al fin ahl feen finally
allá ah-yah there
a menudo ah meh-noo-doh often
aquíah-kee here
bastante bahs-tahn-teh quite, rather
casi kah-see almost
cerca sehr-kah near
demasiado deh-mah-see-yah-doh too
de nuevo deh noo-weh-boh again
de repente deh rreh-pehn-teh suddenly
después dehs-poo-wehs afterward
lejos leh-hohs far
más mahs more
menos meh-nohs less
mejor meh-hohr better
mientras mee-yehn-trahs meanwhile
muy moo-wee very
peor peh-yohr worse
poco poh-koh little
por supuesto pohr soo-poo-wehs-toh of course
pronto prohn-toh soon
pues poo-wehs then
siempre see-yehm-preh always
tal vez tahl behs perhaps
también tahm-bee-yehn also, too
tan tahn so
tarde tahr-deh late
temprano tehm-prah-noh soon, early
79
06 (067-080) chapter 1900 8/1/03 10:34 AM Page 80
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
todavía toh-dah-bee-yah still, yet
ya yah already
POSITION OF ADVERBS
In simple tenses (no helping verb), adverbs are generally placed directly
after the verb they modify. Sometimes, however, the position of the
adverb is variable and can be placed where you would logically put an
English adverb:
Generalmente, habla fluidamente. Generally, he speaks fluently.
Frecuentemente escuché atentamente. I frequently listened attentively.
Bien and mal may precede the past participle:
Está mal escrito. It s poorly written.
Hemos bien trabajado. We worked well.
TIME S UP!
Rewrite each sentence by putting the correct adjectival form in
parentheses in its proper place. Be careful, sometimes you will simply
need to make the adjective agree and sometimes you will have to
change it to an adverb:
Example: (fluida) Él habla. Él habla fluidamente.
(lindo) Ana es una nińa. Ana es una nińa linda.
1. (profundo) Él piensa.
2. (alegre) La seńora López es una mujer.
3. (bueno) Es un hombre.
4. (frecuente) Hablan.
5. (demasiado) Ella compra vestidos.
6. (más) Necesito dinero.
7. (primero) Es la vez.
8. (fácil) Ellos trabajan.
9. (ciento) Necesito dólares.
10. (rápido) Ellos escriben.
80
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 81
Making
Acquaintances
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using reflexive verbs to present yourself
" Choosing the correct reflexive verb
" Discussing your origins
" Using possessives to speak about family
and friends
In this chapter you ll learn how to carry
on a basic, introductory conversation in
Spanish in which you can offer greetings,
discuss your health, and speak about your
origins and family members, using reflexive
verbs properly as needed.
81
81
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 82
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
GREETINGS AND GOOD-BYES
When traveling in a foreign country, if you want to converse with a
person whom you don t know at all, a formal approach is mandatory. It
is considered quite a mistake to address someone informally if a strong
friendship or relationship has not been established. Be sure to start and
end your conversations correctly by using the appropriate greetings and
good-byes listed below.
Formal Greetings and Good-Byes
SPANISH GREETING/GOOD-BYE
Buenos días. Hello.
Buenas tardes. Good afternoon.
Seńor Mr.
Seńora Mrs.
Seńorita Miss (Ms.)
żCómo se llama Ud.? What s your name?
Me llamo . . . My name is . . .
Mucho gusto en conocerle. I m happy to meet you.
Le presento a . . . I d like you to meet . . .
żCómo está Ud.? How are you?
Muy bien. Very well.
Bien. All right.
Así así. So-so.
Adiós. Good-bye.
Buenas noches. Good night.
Informal Greetings and Good-Byes
SPANISH GREETING/GOOD-BYE
Ä„Hola! Hi.
żCómo te llamas? What s your name?
Me llamo . . . My name is . . .
Encantado(a). Pleased to meet you.
Te presento a . . . I d like you to meet . . .
82
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 83
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
Adiós. Bye.
żCómo estás? How are you?
Bien. Fine.
żCómo te va? How s it going?
żQué hay de nuevo? What s new?
Nada en particular. Nothing (much).
Hasta muy pronto. See you very soon.
Hasta luego. See you later.
Luego te veo. I ll be seeing you.
Hasta mańana. See you tomorrow.
NOTE
The greeting encantado is an adjective and must agree in gender with the
speaker. Use encantado if you are a man and encantada if you are a woman.
As a sign of respect, older Spanish women are generally referred to and
addressed as Seńora, regardless of their marital status. When in doubt,
use Seńora. Seńorita is reserved for younger, unmarried women.
REFLEXIVE VERBS
A reflexive verb indicates that the action is performed by the subject
upon itself: He bathes himself. The reflexive verb (in this example, to
bathe) has a reflexive pronoun as its object (in this example, himself).
Thus, the subject (which may be omitted in Spanish but which should be
kept in mind) and the pronoun object refer to the same person or thing:
El muchacho se llama Juan. The boy s name is Juan. (The boy is called Juan.)
(Él) se llama. His name is Juan. (He calls himself Juan.)
You can identify a reflexive verb by the addition of se at then end of the
infinitive: for example, llamarse (to call oneself).
In many instances, you can use the same verb without the reflexive
pronoun to perform the action upon or for someone else. The verb is
then no longer reflexive.
Me llamo María. My name is Maria. (I call myself Maria.)
Llamo a María. I call Maria.
83
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 84
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Some verbs that are generally not reflexive may be made reflexive by
adding the reflexive pronoun:
Yo hablo con Julio. I speak to Julio.
Me hablo. I speak to myself.
Note the reflexive pronouns that are used with each subject and their
placement immediately before the conjugated verb. All reflexive verbs
must be preceded by these pronouns, which are directly tied to their sub-
jects. The verb sentirse (ie) (to feel) will prove very useful when dis-
cussing your health. Sentirse is a stem-changing e to ie shoe verb, so
expect to see that change in all forms except nosotros and vosotros.
Below is the conjugation of the reflexive verb sentirse.
sentirse to feel
(yo) me siento (I feel) (nosotros) nos sentimos (we feel)
(tÅ›) te sientes (you feel) (vosotros) os sentís (you feel)
(él) se siente (he feels) (ellos) se sienten (they feel)
To answer the question  How are you? (żCómo está Ud.? [formal] or
żCómo estás? [familiar]), respond:
Me siento bien. I feel well.
Me siento mal. I feel bad.
Me siento mejor. I feel better.
Me siento peor. I feel worse.
Some verbs are usually or always used reflexively in English and Spanish.
The following list provides the most common reflexive verbs. Verbs with
an asterisk (*) have spelling changes in the present tense and must be
conjugated accordingly. Refer to Chapter 22:00 for the rules for these
shoe verbs.
VERB MEANING
*acostarse (ue) to go to bed, to lay down
afeitarse to shave
alegrarse to be glad
bańarse to bathe oneself
*despertarse (ie) to wake up
*divertirse (ie) to have fun
84
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 85
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
enojarse to become angry
equivocarse to be mistaken
lavarse to wash oneself
levantarse to get up
llamarse to be called, named
peinarse to comb one s hair
quedarse to remain, to stay
*sentirse (ie) to feel
Choosing the Correct Reflexive Verb
Some verbs in Spanish have special meanings when used reflexively, so
be careful to choose the verb you want to use.
INFINITIVE BASIC MEANING REFLEXIVE MEANING
aburrir(se) to bore to become bored
acostar(se) (ue) to put to bed to go to bed
bańar(se) to bathe (someone) to bathe oneself
cansar(se) to tire to become tired
engańar(se) to deceive to be mistaken
levantar(se) to raise (something) to get up
poner(se) to put (something) to put (something on),
to become, to place oneself
sentar(se) (ie) to seat to sit down
Some reflexive verbs are used idiomatically; that is, no logical grammat-
ical explanation exists for the construction of these phrases. These verbs
appear below.
EXPRESSION MEANING
cepillarse (los dientes) to brush one s (teeth)
romperse (la pierna) to break one s (leg)
irse to go away
hacerse amigos to become friends
enfadarse con to get angry with
darse cuenta de to realize
85
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 86
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
The following verbs are always used reflexively in Spanish, but not nec-
essarily in English. An asterisk (*) denotes a verb with a spelling or stem
change.
VERB MEANING
*acordarse (ue) (de) to remember
empeńarse (en) to insist (on)
fijarse (en) to notice
irse to go away
*negarse (ie) (de) to refuse (to)
olvidarse (de) to forget
parecerse (a) to resemble
quejarse (de) to complain
*reírse (i) (de) to laugh at
Reflexive verbs in the plural may express reciprocal action correspon-
ding to each other and one another in English: Nos escribimos. (We write
to each other.)
Note the use of uno a otro (una a otra) or el uno al otro (la una a la
otra), which mean  each other :
Ellos se miran. They look at each other.
Ellos se miran uno al otro. They look at each other.
Paco y Ana se escriben They write to each other.
el uno al otro.
Reflexive verbs in Spanish may be used to express the passive voice when
the subject is a thing (not a person):
Aquí se habla espaÅ„ol. Spanish is spoken here.
Se vende carne hoy. Meat is being sold today.
Reflexive Verbs in Compound Tenses
In compound tenses, the reflexive pronoun remains before the conjugated
helping verb form of haber:
Ella se ha lavado. She has washed herself.
Ella se había lavado. She had washed herself.
86
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 87
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
Ella se habrá lavado. She will have washed herself.
Ella se habría lavado. She would have washed herself.
Reflexive Verbs with Infinitives and Gerunds
When a subject is followed by a conjugated verb and an infinitive, or
with estar + gerund, the reflexive pronoun may be placed either before
the conjugated verb or after it and attached to the infinitive to which its
meaning is linked:
I m going to feel better. Me voy a sentir mejor.
Voy a sentirme mejor.
I m combing my hair. Me estoy peinando.
Estoy peinándome.
When using the gerund that has one pronoun attached, a general rule of
thumb is to count back three vowels and add an accent to get the correct
stress. When two pronouns are attached, count back four vowels: Está
lavándosela. (He is washing it for himself.)
ORIGINS
It is only natural when you meet someone new to inquire about that
person s origins or to speak about your own. In order to speak correctly
about coming from, living in, or traveling to a country, city, state, or
province, you need to learn these prepositions:
PREPOSITION MEANING
en in
ato
de from
Vivo en Nueva York. I live in New York.
Soy de California. I m from California.
Voy a San Juan. I m going to San Juan.
To formally ask a person where he or she is from, say: żDe dónde es Ud.?
(Where are you from?) To be informal, ask: żDe dónde eres? (Where are
you from?)
In Spanish most countries are not preceded by a definite article (el, la,
los, or las), though a few are. Common everyday usage, however, tends
87
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 88
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
to omit the definite article even before those countries whose names
show them. The only exceptions are El Salvador and La Républica
Dominicana, because El and La are part of the country s official name.
There is no contraction of a + el when speaking about El Salvador.
Use the definite article with geographical names that are modified:
América es grande.
But:
La América del Sur es grande.
Voy a Guatemala.
Voy a El Salvador.
Refer to the following lists for the names of countries and continents.
Countries
Argentina la Argentina
Brazil el Brasil
Canada el Canadá
China la China
Dominican Republic la Repśblica Dominicana
Ecuador el Ecuador
El Salvador El Salvador
England Inglaterra
France Francia
Germany Alemania
Greece Grecia
Haiti Haïti
India la India
Italy Italia
Japan el Japón
Mexico México
Panama Panamá
Paraguay el Paraguay
88
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 89
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
Peru el PerÅ›
Portugal Portugal
Russia Rusia
Spain Espańa
Sweden Suecia
Switzerland Suiza
United States los Estados Unidos
Uruguay el Uruguay
Continents
Africa África
Antarctica Antártica
Asia Asia
Australia Australia
Europe Europa
North America Norte América, América del Norte
South America Sud América, América del Sur
Now you can answer these questions:
żDe dónde es Ud.? Soy de (los) Estados Unidos.
(Where are you from?) (I m from the United States.)
żAdónde va Ud.? Voy a Espańa.
(Where are you going?) (I m going to Spain.)
żDónde vive Ud.? Vivo en Grecia.
(Where do you live?) (I live in Greece.)
NATIONALITIES
When answering a question about your origin, remember to use an
adjective that agrees in number and gender with the person or persons
you are describing, as explained in Chapter 19:00.
żCuál es su nacionalidad? What s your nationality?
Soy alemana. I m German.
Somos americanos. We are Americans.
89
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 90
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Nationalities ending in -és drop the accent from the e in the feminine sin-
gular and all plural forms. The adjectives of nationality are:
inglés English
escocés Scottish
francés French
irlandés Irish
japonés Japanese
portugés Portuguese
NOTE
Unlike in English, adjectives of nationality are not capitalized in Spanish.
THE FAMILY
When meeting new people, after you ve introduced yourself, it often
becomes necessary to present or refer to other members of your family.
The following tables give you the names of family members you may
need to know.
Family Members: Males
Relative Spanish Relative Spanish
boyfriend novio husband esposo
brother hermano nephew sobrino
brother-in-law cuńado son hijo
child nińo son-in-law yerno
cousin primo stepbrother hermanastro
father padre stepson hijastro
father-in-law suegro uncle tío
grandfather abuelo
Family Members: Females
Relative Spanish Relative Spanish
aunt tía cousin prima
child nińa daughter hija
90
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 91
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
daughter-in-law nuera sister hermana
girlfriend novia sister-in-law cuńada
grandmother abuela stepdaughter hijastra
mother madre stepsister hermanastra
mother-in-law suegra wife esposa
niece sobrina
SHOWING POSSESSION
To show possession, you may use the preposition de (of) or a possessive
adjective.
Using De
English speakers use apostrophe s ( s) or s apostrophe (s ) after a noun to
show possession. Because Spanish does not use apostrophes, a reverse
construction is used: el padre de Marta (the father of Marta or Marta s
father). Note that in this construction the preposition de (of) is used to
express relationship and possession.
If the possessor is referred to by a common noun, such as  the boy 
for example,  She is the boy s mother  then de contracts with the def-
inite article el to express  of the : Es la madre del muchacho.
Using Possessive Adjectives
Possessive adjectives, like other Spanish adjectives, agree with the nouns
they modify (the person or thing that is possessed) and not with the sub-
ject (the person possessing them) and, therefore, serve as noun markers.
The first table below summarizes the use of short possessive adjectives
that precede the noun, and the second table summarizes the use of longer
possessive adjectives that are used less frequently and follow the noun.
Short Forms
BEFORE BEFORE
MASCULINE NOUNS FEMININE NOUNS MEANING
Singular Plural Singular Plural
mi mis mi mis my
tu tus tu tus your
su sus su sus his, her, your, its
91
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 92
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
nuestro nuestros nuestra nuestras our
vuestro vuestros vuestra vuestras your
su sus su sus their, your
Long Forms
AFTER AFTER
MASCULINE NOUNS FEMININE NOUNS MEANING
Singular Plural Singular Plural
mío míos mía mías my
tuyo tuyos tuya tuyas your
suyo suyos suya suyas his, her, your, its
nuestro nuestros nuestra nuestras our
vuestro vuestros vuestra vuestras your
suyo suyos suya suyas their, your
When you use a short possessive adjective, make note of the following:
" Su can mean  his,  her, or  their, because the possessive
adjective agrees with the noun it modifies, and not with the subject.
Therefore, his mother = su madre because su agrees with the word
mother, which is singular. Su madre can also mean her mother or
their mother. You will know whether su means  his,  her, or
 their by the context of the conversation.
" Short possessive adjectives are used before each noun:
su hermana y su hermano her sister and brother
mi hermano y tus primos my brother and your cousins
" With parts of the body or clothing, the possessive adjective is usually
replaced with the definite article if the possessor is clear:
Ella se cepilla los dientes. She brushes her teeth.
Él se pone el sombrero. He puts on his hat.
The longer adjectives are used as follows:
el hermano mío my brother
el padre y la madre suyos his (her, their) father and mother
unas amigas tuyas some of your friends
92
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 93
"
1 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G A C Q U A I N T A N C E S
To avoid ambiguity, su (sus) and suyo (suya, suyos, suyas), may be
replaced by the article and de él (ella), de Ud. (Uds.), or de ellos (ellas):
el padre de ella her father
una amiga de Uds. one of your friends
You can now introduce someone using possessive adjectives:
Le (te) presento a mi hijo y a I d like you to meet my
su esposa. son and his wife.
Le (te) presento a un hijo
mío y a su esposa.
Using Possessive Pronouns
A possessive pronoun replaces a possessive adjective + noun. The fol-
lowing pronouns agree in number and gender with the nouns they
replace.
SINGULAR PLURAL
Masculine Feminine Masculine Feminine English
el mío la mía los míos las mías mine
el tuyo la tuya los tuyos las tuyas yours (familiar)
el suyo la suya los suyos las suyas his/her/yours (formal)
el nuestro la nuestra los nuestros las nuestras ours
el vuestro la vuestra los vuestros las vuestras yours (familiar)
el suyo la suya los suyos las suyas theirs/yours (formal)
Este periódico es el suyo. This newspaper is his/hers.
Because the possessive pronoun agrees with the item possessed and not
the possessor, the only way to distinguish between his and hers is to
follow the conversation carefully.
Aquí está mi maleta. Here is my suitcase.
żDónde está la suya? Where is yours?
Spanish expressions of relationship are:
" a friend of mine, one of my friends, un amigo mío
" a nephew of his, one of his nephews, un sobrino suyo
" neighbors (f.) of theirs, some of their neighbors, unas vecinas suyas
93
07 (081-094) chapter 1800 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 94
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
By using the phrases presented at the beginning of this chapter with
the correct possessive adjective, and by following them with the noun
expressing the person being introduced, you can now have a very
simple introductory conversation in Spanish. Do the following without
looking back:
1. Greet someone.
2. State that you are pleased to meet them.
3. Give your name.
4. State your health.
5. Tell where you are from.
6. Tell where you live.
7. Give your nationality.
8. Name a country you are going to visit.
9. Introduce a family member.
10. Say good-bye.
94
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 95
Fielding
Invitations
and Other
Questions
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using verbs to extend invitations
" Using prepositions to join your thoughts
" Using prepositional pronouns to extend
invitations
" Accepting, refusing, and showing
indifference and indecision
In this chapter you ll learn how to extend,
accept, and tactfully refuse invitations to
a variety of interesting and popular tourist
attractions and sights.
95
95
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 96
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
VERBS FOR INVITATIONS
By far the easiest verb to use is desear (to want). It is a regular -ar verb
and, therefore, quite easy to conjugate:
desear to want
yo deseo (I want) nosotros deseamos (we want)
tÅ› deseas (you want) vosotros deseáis (you want)
él desea (he wants) ellos desean (they want)
You may also use the verb querer (to wish or to want) to extend an invi-
tation. Remember, though, that querer requires an e to ie change within
the shoe, while the nosotros and vosotros forms use the infinitive stem.
querer to want
yo quiero (I want) nosotros queremos (we want)
tÅ› quieres (you want) vosotros queréis (you want)
él quiere (he wants) ellos quieren (they want)
You may also use the verb poder (to be able to, can) to ask whether
someone is available. Keep in mind that poder also has a stem change
within the shoe from o to ue and that the nosotros and vosotros forms
follow the infinitive.
poder to be able to, can
yo puedo (I can) nosotros podemos (we can)
tÅ› puedes (you can) vosotros podéis (you can)
él puede (he can) ellos pueden (they can)
You may use the idiomatic expression tener ganas de (to feel like) to ask
what someone is in the mood to do. Remember that tener also has an
irregular yo form: tengo and a stem change from e to ie for the tÅ›, él,
ella, Ud., ellos, ellas, and Uds. forms. The nosotros and vosotros forms
follow the infinitive.
tener to have
yo tengo (I have) nosotros tenemos (we have)
tÅ› tienes (you have) vosotros tenéis (you have)
él tiene (he has) ellos tienen (they have)
96
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 97
"
1 7 : 0 0 F I E L D I N G I N V I T A T I O N S A N D O T H E R Q U E S T I O N S
To extend an invitation, use the verbs discussed in this section, plus an
infinitive, to form the invitation.
FORMAL
żUd. desea ir . . . ? Do you want to go . . . ?
żUd. pueden salir . . . ? Can you go out . . . ?
INFORMAL
żTś quieres ir . . . ? Do you want to go . . . ?
żTś puedes salir . . . ? Can you go out . . . ?
PLURAL
żUds. pueden ir . . . ? Can you go . . . ?
PREPOSITIONS
You can use prepositions to show the relationship of a noun to another
word in a sentence. Prepositions come in handy when extending an invi-
tation, as well as in common everyday situations.
The prepositions listed here can not only help you to offer a suggestion
for something to do, but can also help you give or receive any necessary
directions.
PREPOSITION SPANISH PREPOSITION SPANISH
about acerca de by en
above, on top of encima de during durante
according to segśn far lejos de
after después (de) for por, para
against contra from de
around alrededor de in en
at a, en in front of delante de
at the house of en casa de inside, within dentro de
before antes (de) instead of en lugar de
behind detrás de instead of en vez de
beneath, under debajo de of de
besides además de on en
between entre opposite enfrente de
97
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 98
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
outside of fuera de toward hacia
over, above sobre until hasta
near cerca de with con
to a without sin
Prepositions That Require Special Attention
En and A. The selection of the correct word for at when referring to a
place may present some difficulty. The following explanations should
help eliminate some of the confusion:
" En means inside, or within an enclosed or specific place. Estamos
en el aeropuerto. (We are at [inside] the airport.)
" A refers to a general location where specific boundaries are not
suggested or implied: Vamos al aeropuerto. (We are going to
the airport.)
A and De. As seen above, the prepositions a (to) and de (from) are used
when referring to places. It is important to contract a and de with the
definite article el (the) as shown below before a masculine singular noun.
A and de do not contract with la, los, or las:
a + el = al Van al cine. They are going to the movies.
de + el = del Salen del cine. They leave the movies.
Por and Para. Because por and para have the same meaning in English,
you will need to determine which to use by their Spanish context as
shown in the following examples.
Por is used in the following ways:
" To show motion:
Pasé por la tienda. I passed by the store.
Entraron por la puerta. They came in through the door.
Pasean por esa calle. They stroll along that street.
" To state means or manner:
Lo necesito por escrito. I need it in writing.
Lo envió por avión. He sent it by plane.
" To mean  in exchange for : Pagaré un dólar por eso.
(I ll pay a dollar for that.)
98
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 99
"
1 7 : 0 0 F I E L D I N G I N V I T A T I O N S A N D O T H E R Q U E S T I O N S
" To show the duration of an action: Estuvo enfermo por un mes.
(He was sick for a month.)
" To indicate an indefinite period of time: Me voy por la tarde.
(I m leaving in the afternoon.)
" To express  for the sake of or  on behalf of :
Lo haré por Ud. I ll do it for your sake.
Lo haré por la familia. I ll do it on behalf of the family.
" To give a reason or motive: Trabajo por necesidad.
(I work out of necessity.)
" To express  per or  by the :
Va al cine una vez por He goes to the movies once a week.
semana.
Son más baratos por docena. They are cheaper by the dozen.
" To state an opinion or estimation, equivalent to  for or  as :
Me toman por profesora. They took me for a teacher.
Se le conocía por Pedro. He was known as Pedro.
" To place the agent (doer) in a passive construction: Fue escrito
por Juan. (It was written by Juan.)
" To mean  for after the verbs enviar (to send), ir (to go), mandar
(to order, send), preguntar (to ask), regresar (to return), venir
(to come), and volver (to return):
Fui (Envié, Pregunté) por I went for (sent for, asked for)
el médico. the doctor.
Vine (Regresé, Volví) I came (returned, came back)
por mis libros. for my books.
Por is used in the following adverbial expressions:
EXPRESSION MEANING
por eso therefore, so
por lo comśn generally
por lo general generally
por lo visto apparently
por supuesto of course
99
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 100
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Para is used in the following ways:
" With a destination of a place or a direction: Salimos para México.
(We are going to Mexico.)
" With the destination of a recipient: Este regalo es para Ud.
(This gift is for you.)
" To express a time limit in the future: Lo necesito para mańana.
(I need it for tomorrow.)
" To state a purpose or goal: Trabajo para vivir. (I work [in order]
to live.)
" To show the use of an object: Es una caja para vestidos.
(It s a box for clothing.)
" To make comparisons by expressing  for or  considering that :
Para ser americano habla bien el espańol. (For being an American
he speaks Spanish well.)
Note the following exceptions to these rules:
" When speaking about a means of transportation for a passenger,
use en instead of por to express  by :
Voy a viajar en avión. I m going to travel by plane.
Envío la carta por avión. I m sending the letter by plane.
" When using the verbs buscar (to look for), esperar (to wait for),
and pedir (to ask for), do not use por or para, because the word
for is already included in the meaning of the verb.
PLACES
If you are a traveler, student, or businessperson in the Spanish-speaking
world, or if you happen to meet a Spanish speaker who needs assistance
in your own hometown, you will find this list of place names quite useful.
amusement park el parque de atracciones
beach la playa
cathedral la catedral
church la iglesia
circus el circo
department store los grandes almacenes
fair la feria
fountain la fuente
garden el jardín
100
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 101
"
1 7 : 0 0 F I E L D I N G I N V I T A T I O N S A N D O T H E R Q U E S T I O N S
library la biblioteca
mall el centro comercial
movies el cine
museum el museo
nightclub el club
park el parque
restaurant el restaurante
theater el teatro
zoo el zoológico
PREPOSTITIONAL PRONOUNS
Prepositional pronouns are so named because they are pronouns that
you use after prepositions. In many cases, prepositional pronouns are
useful when you need to extend an invitation. The following table shows
subject pronouns with their corresponding stress pronouns.
PREPOSITIONAL
SUBJECT PRONOUN MEANING
yo míI, me
tÅ› ti you (familiar)
él él he, him
ella ella she
Ud. Ud. you
nosotros nosotros we, us (polite)
vosotros vosotros you (familiar)
ellos ellos they, them
ellas ellas they, them
Uds. Uds. you (polite)
The prepositional pronoun sí is used reflexively both in the singular and
in the plural to express  yourself,  himself,  herself,  itself,  them-
selves, or  yourselves : Piensa para sí mismo. (He thinks for himself.)
You can use prepositional pronouns in situations where you would
like to extend an invitation, or in other everyday conversations as
follows:
101
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 102
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
" The prepositional pronoun is used as the object of a preposition
and always follows the preposition: No es para ti; es para mí.
(It s not for you; it s for me.)
" The prepositional pronouns mí, ti, and sí combine with the
preposition con as follows:
conmigo with me
contigo with you
consigo with him/her/your(self), them/your(selves)
EXTENDING AN INVITATION
By combining all the elements presented so far in this chapter, you can
now try to extend your own invitation.
1. Start with a verb in either its polite or familiar form:
żUd. quiere . . . ? żTś quieres . . . ? Do you want . . . ?
żUd. puede . . . ? żTś puedes . . . ? Can you . . . ?
żUd. desea . . . ? żTś deseas . . . ? Do you wish . . . ?
żUd. tiene ganas żTś tienes ganas Do you feel like . . . ?
de . . . ? de . . . ?
2. Add an infinitive:
ir to go
salir to go out
venir to come
3. Use the correct form of a + definite article followed by the name
of a place:
al cine to the movies
a la playa to the beach
a los parques to the parks
a las iglesias to the churches
4. Add a preposition + a prepositional pronoun:
conmigo with me
con nosotros with us
102
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 103
"
1 7 : 0 0 F I E L D I N G I N V I T A T I O N S A N D O T H E R Q U E S T I O N S
Your final product should look and sound something like these examples:
żTś quieres ir a la playa conmigo? Do you want to go to the beach
with me?
żUds. quieren ir al cine con Do you want to go to the movies
nosotros? with us?
ACCEPTING AN INVITATION
Perhaps you receive an invitation that intrigues you. Saying yes is easy.
Just nod your head and say,  Sí to show your eager acceptance. You
may also use any of the phrases listed here.
PHRASE SPANISH
You bet! Ä„Ya lo creo!
Gladly. Ä„Con mucho gusto!
Great! !Fantástico!
If you want to. Si tu quieres./Si Ud. quiere.
OK./I agree. De acuerdo.
Of course. Ä„Por supuesto!/Ä„Claro!
Thank you. Gracias.
Thank you. Le (te) agradezco.
Thank you very much. Muchas gracias.
That s a good idea. Es una buena idea.
With pleasure. Con placer.
NOTE
To express the phrase  You re welcome, you can use De nada or No hay de
qué.
REFUSING AN INVITATION
Saying no is more difficult because you must remain tactful. An invita-
tion can be cordially and politely refused by expressing regrets and giv-
ing a valid excuse. You may need to use the following phrases in both
formal and informal situations.
103
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 104
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
PHRASE SPANISH
Unfortunately . . . Desgraciadamente . . .
I can t. No puedo.
I don t feel like it. No tengo ganas.
I don t have the money. No tengo dinero.
I don t have time. No tengo tiempo.
I don t want to. No quiero.
I m busy. Estoy ocupado(a).
I m sorry. Lo siento.
I m tired. Estoy cansado(a).
Perhaps some other time. Tal vez en otra ocasión.
In any of the expressions listed above that begin with I, you can change
the subject to whatever is appropriate for the situation (they, we, etc.).
Make sure, however, that when you do so, you also conjugate the verb
and make the adjective agree with the new subject. (Refer to Chapter
22:00 for a refresher on the present tense of verbs.)
EXPRESSING INDECISION AND INDIFFERENCE
If you receive an invitation and are at a loss as to what to do, express
your indecision or indifference by using the phrases listed here.
PHRASE SPANISH
I don t know. No sé.
It depends. Depende.
It doesn t matter. No importa.
Perhaps./Maybe. Quizás.
Whatever you want. Lo que prefiera(s).
NO
You will sometimes need to use the simplest of all the Spanish negatives,
no, which expresses  not. In simple and compound sentences, no pre-
cedes the conjugated verb; in compound tenses, no precedes the helping
verb:
104
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 105
"
1 7 : 0 0 F I E L D I N G I N V I T A T I O N S A N D O T H E R Q U E S T I O N S
SIMPLE COMPOUND
No estoy libre. No he estado libre.
I m not free. I wasn t free./I haven t been free.
(at a particular, specific moment in time)
No estaba libre. No había estado libre.
I wasn t free. I hadn t been free.
(in general at no specific moment)
No estaré libre. No habré estado libre.
I will not be free. I will not have been free.
No estaría libre. No habría estado libre.
I wouldn t be free. I wouldn t have been free.
When a sentence has two verbs, remember that no must precede the
conjugated verb:
No quiero ir al parque. I don t want to go to the park.
No podemos salir. We can t go out.
No van a viajar. They aren t going to travel.
No with Reflexive Verbs
In simple and compound tenses, no precedes the reflexive pronoun:
SIMPLE COMPOUND
No me divierto. No nos hemos divertido.
I m not having a good time. We have not had a good time.
No te divertías. No se había divertido.
You weren t having a good time. You hadn t had a good time.
No se divertirá. No se habrán divertido.
He will not have a good time. They will not have had a good time.
No se divertiría. No se habrían divertido.
She wouldn t have a good time. They wouldn t have had a good time.
105
08 (095-106) chapter 1700 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 106
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
When an infinitive is negated, no precedes the infinitive:
Yo decidí no venir. I decided not to come.
Yo he decidido no levantarme I decided not to get up early.
temprano.
TIME S UP!
1. Extend an invitation to a new acquaintance to go to
a restaurant with you.
2. Extend an invitation to a friend to go to the circus with
you and your family.
3. Accept an invitation to a nightclub.
4. Accept an invitation to visit a cathedral.
5. Refuse an invitation to a fair.
6. Refuse an invitation to the mall.
7. Give an excuse why you can t go to the zoo.
8. Give an excuse why you can t go the gardens.
9. Show indifference about going to the movies.
10. Show indecision about going to see the fountains.
106
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 107
Making Plans
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using cardinal numbers
" Using ordinal numbers
" Expressing days, months, seasons,
and dates
" Telling time
In this lesson you ll learn the essentials
for making plans: numbers, and how they
are used to express the date and tell time;
and how to combine these elements to
plan an outing.
107
107
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 108
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
CARDINAL NUMBERS
The Spanish write two numbers differently than we do. The number one
has a little hook on top: 1. In order to distinguish a one from the number

seven, Spanish speakers put a line through the seven when they write it: 7.
In numerals and decimals, where English speakers use commas the
Spanish use periods, and vice versa:
ENGLISH SPANISH ENGLISH SPANISH
3,000 3.000 $16.95 $16,95
0.75 0,75
Carefully study the Spanish numbers presented here:
CARDINAL SPANISH CARDINAL SPANISH
0 cero 21 veintiuno, veinte y uno
1 uno 25 veinte y cinco
2 dos 30 treinta
3 tres 40 cuarenta
4 cuatro 50 cincuenta
5 cinco 60 sesenta
6 seis 70 setenta
7 siete 80 ochenta
8 ocho 90 noventa
9 nueve 100 ciento (cien)
10 diez 101 ciento uno
11 once 200 doscientos
12 doce 500 quinientos
13 trece 1000 mil
14 catorce 2000 dos mil
15 quince 100.000 cien mil
16 dieciséis, diez y seis 1.000.000 un millón
17 diecisiete, diez y siete 2.000.000 dos millones
18 dieciocho, diez y ocho 1.000.000.000 mil millones
19 diecinueve, diez y nueve 2.000.000.000 dos mil millones
20 veinte
108
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 109
"
1 6 : 0 0 M A K I N G P L A N S
Note the following about Spanish numbers:
" The conjunction y (and) is used only for numbers between
16 and 99:
52 cincuenta y dos
152 ciento cincuenta y dos
" The numbers 16 19 and 21 29 are most frequently written as one
word. When this is done, the numbers 16, 22, 23, and 26 have
accents on the last syllable:
16 dieciséis 23 veintitrés
22 veintidós 26 veintiséis
" In compounds of ciento (doscientos, trescientos), there must be
agreement with a feminine noun:
doscientos muchachos two hundred boys
trescientas muchachas three hundred girls
" Ciento becomes cien before nouns and before the numbers mil and
millones. Before all other numbers, ciento is used:
cien personas one hundred people
cien mil habitantes one hundred thousand inhabitants
cien millones de dólares one billion dollars
ciento cincuenta libros one hundred and twenty books
" Uno is used only when counting and becomes un before a masculine
noun and una before a feminine noun:
uno, dos, tres . . . one, two, three . . .
un nińo y una nińa a boy and a girl
treinta y un hombres thirty-one men
veintiuna casas twenty-one houses
" Un is not used before cien(to) or mil, but it is used before millón.
When millón is followed by a noun, put de between millón and
the noun.
cien ańos one hundred years
ciento veinte alumnos one hundred twenty students
109
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 110
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
mil ańos one thousand years
un millón de dólares a million dollars
NOTE
To express your age, use the idiomatic expression tengo . . . ańos, given in
Chapter 22:00: Tengo veintiséis aÅ„os. (I m twenty-six years old.)
ORDINAL NUMBERS
Understanding ordinal numbers is very important when you are in an
elevated building, such as an apartment house or a department store.
Note that el sótano is the basement, la planta baja is the ground or main
floor, and la primera planta or el primer piso is the first floor above
ground level.
Carefully study these ordinal numbers:
ORDINAL SPANISH ORDINAL SPANISH
1st primero 6th sexto
2nd segundo 7th séptimo
3rd tercero 8th octavo
4th cuarto 9th noveno
5th quinto 10th décimo
Note the following about ordinal numbers:
" Spanish speakers use ordinal numbers only through the tenth.
After that, cardinal numbers are used:
el sexto día the sixth day
la segunda semana the second week
Carlos Cuarto Charles IV
la página doce page 12
el siglo veinte the twentieth century
" Ordinal numbers must agree in gender with the nouns they modify.
Ordinal numbers are made feminine by changing the final o of the
masculine form to a:
el cuarto día the fourth day
la cuarta semana the fourth week
110
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 111
"
1 6 : 0 0 M A K I N G P L A N S
" Primero and tercero drop their final o before a masculine singular
noun:
el primer acto the first act
el tercer baile the third dance
But:
el siglo tercero the third century
" The Spanish ordinal numbers are abbreviated as follows:
primero(a): 1o(a) tercero(a): 3o(a)
primer: 1er tercer: 3er
segundo(a): 2o(a) cuarto(a): 4o(a)
NOTE
1. A cardinal number that replaces an ordinal number is always
masculine, as nśmero, a masculine word, is understood: la avenida
once (Eleventh Avenue [avenue number eleven]).
2. In Spanish, cardinal numbers precede ordinal numbers: las cuatro
primeras personas (the first four people).
DAYS, MONTHS, AND SEASONS
To express the date, you will need the names of the days of the week and
months of the year. It will also be helpful to know the seasons. The days,
months, and seasons are listed below. In Spanish all are masculine and
are not capitalized unless they are used at the beginning of a sentence.
An important fact to remember if you have a lot of appointments in a
Spanish-speaking country is that Spanish calendars start with Monday as
the first day of the week.
DAY SPANISH
Monday lunes
Tuesday martes
Wednesday miércoles
Thursday jueves
Friday viernes
Saturday sábado
Sunday domingo
111
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 112
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
MONTH SPANISH
January enero
February febrero
March marzo
April abril
May mayo
June junio
July julio
August agosto
September septiembre
October octubre
November noviembre
December diciembre
SEASON SPANISH
winter el invierno
spring la primavera
summer el verano
autumn, fall el otońo
To express  on a certain day , the Spanish language uses the definite arti-
cle los: Los domingos me levanto tarde. (On Sundays, I wake up late.)
Use the preposition en to express  in with months, and en + definite
article for seasons: en julio (in July), en el verano (in the summer).
DATES
The following list gives you a few date-related words you will need when
making plans.
WORD/EXPRESSION SPANISH
a day un día
a week una semana
a month un mes
a year un ańo
in en
112
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 113
"
1 6 : 0 0 M A K I N G P L A N S
ago hace
per por
during durante
next próximo(a)
last pasado(a)
last (in a series) śltimo(a)
yesterday ayer
today hoy
tomorrow mańana
tomorrow morning mańana por la mańana
tomorrow afternoon mańana por la tarde
tomorrow night mańana por la noche
day after tomorrow pasado mańana
from desde
a week from today de hoy en una semana
Dates in Spanish are expressed as follows; the definite article el is optional:
day + (el) + cardinal number (except for primero) + de + month + de +
year: lunes (el) once de julio de dos mil (Monday, July 11, 2000).
Note the following when expressing a date:
" The first of each month is expressed by primero. Cardinal numbers
are used for all other days:
el primero de abril April 1st
el dos de mayo May 2nd
" Years are expressed in thousands and hundreds, not in hundreds as
they are in English:
1999 mil novecientos noventa y nueve
one thousand nine hundred and ninety-nine
" When writing the date in numbers, Spanish follows the sequence:
day + month + year:
el 12 de enero de 2003 = 12/1/03
January 12, 2003 = 1/12/03
113
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 114
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
" The English word on is expressed by el in Spanish dates:
Llego el dos de abril. I m arriving on April 2nd.
Te veré el viernes. I ll see you on Friday.
To get information about the date or the date of an event, you need the
following questions and answers:
What day is today? żQué día es hoy?
 Today is . . .  Hoy es . . .
What s today s date? żCuál es la fecha de hoy?
 Today is . . .  Hoy es . . .
What s today s date? żA cuánto estamos hoy?
 It is . . .  Estamos a . . .
What is the date of the . . . ? żCuál es la fecha del (de la, de los,
de las) . . .
When do (does) the . . . begin? żCuándo empieza(n) . . . ?
When do (does) the . . . end? żCuándo termina(n) . . . ?
What day(s) is (are) the . . . open? żQué día(s) está(n) abierto(a)(s) . . . ?
What day(s) is (are) the . . . closed? żQué día(s) está(n) cerrado(a)(s) . . . ?
NOTE
The adjectives abierto and cerrado must agree in number and gender with
the nouns they modify:
żQué día está cerrado el museo? What day is the museum closed?
żQué días están abiertas What days are the libraries open?
las bibliotecas?
TELLING TIME
When making plans, you need to know at what time you will meet and
when an event is going to take place. The following will help you ask and
answer the appropriate questions.
QUESTION ANSWER
żQué hora es? Es (Son) . . .
What time is it? It is . . .
114
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 115
"
1 6 : 0 0 M A K I N G P L A N S
żA qué hora empieza(n) . . . ? A . . .
At what time does . . . start? At . . .
żA qué hora termina(n) . . . ? A . . .
At what times does . . . end? At . . .
żA qué hora nos reunimos? A . . .
At what time shall we meet? At . . .
TIME SPANISH
1:00 la una
2:05 las dos y cinco
3:10 las tres y diez
4:15 las cuatro y cuarto
5:20 las cinco y veinte
6:25 las seis y veinticinco
7:30 las siete y media
7:35 las ocho menos veinticinco
8:40 (20 minutes to 9:00) las nueve menos veinte
9:45 un cuarto para las diez
10:50 (10 minutes to 11) las once menos diez
11:55 (5 minutes to 12) las doce menos cinco
noon el mediodía
midnight la medianoche
To express time properly, remember the following:
" Use es for  it is when it is one o clock. Because they are plural, for
the other numbers, use son:
Es la una. It s one o clock.
Son las dos y media. It s half past two./It s 2:30.
" Use a la for one o clock and a las for every other hour to express
 at (at the specific time):
115
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 116
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Me voy a la una. I m leaving at one o clock.
Va a llegar a las cinco He s going to arrive at a quarter after five.
y cuarto.
" Use y and the number of minutes to express the time after the hour
(before half past): Es la una y veinte. (It s one twenty./It s 1:20.)
" To express time before the next hour (after half past), use menos +
the number of the following hour: Son las cinco menos veinte.
(It s twenty minutes to five./It s 4:40.)
Time before the hour may also be expressed by faltar + minutes + para
+ the following hour: Faltan veinte minutos para las cinco. (It s twenty
minutes to five./It s 4:40.)
You will commonly hear the time expressed numerically, as follows: Son
las dos y cuarenta y cinco. (It s two forty-five./It s 2:45.)
Because media (half) is used as an adjective, it agrees with hora (hour).
Cuarto (quarter) is used as a noun and shows no agreement:
Es la una y media. It s half past one.
Es la una y cuarto. It s quarter after one.
When making plans, keep the following questions in mind. You may mix
and match the elements in the list to get a correct sentence. Use the forms
below when you know the person well. To be polite, use the Ud. form,
as shown in Chapter 17:00.
żA qué hora . . . ? At what time . . . ?
żCuándo . . . ? When . . . ?
Debes . . . You have to . . .
Puedes . . . You can . . .
Quieres . . . You want . . .
żDeseas . . . ? Do you want . . . ?
żTienes ganas de . . . ? Do you feel like . . . ?
regresar (to) return (come back)
ir (to) go
salir (to) go out
volver (to) return
116
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 117
"
1 6 : 0 0 M A K I N G P L A N S
żCuándo quieres salir? When do you want to go out?
żA qué hora puedes salir? At what time can you leave?
Studying the expressions presented here will help you better understand
expressions with time.
EXPRESSION SPANISH
a second un segundo
a minute un minuto
an hour una hora
in the morning (A.M.) por la mańana
in the afternoon (P.M.) por la tarde
in the evening (P.M.) por la noche
at what time? ża qué hora?
at exactly 2:00 a las dos en punto
a quarter of an hour un cuarto de hora
a half hour una media hora
in an hour en una hora
in a while dentro de un rato
until 3:00 hasta las tres
before 4:00 antes de las cuatro
after 5:00 después de las cinco
since what time? żdesde qué hora?
since 6:00 desde las seis
an hour ago hace una hora
early temprano
late tarde
late (in arriving) de retraso
NOTE
In public announcements, such as timetables, the official 24-hour system
is commonly used, with midnight as the zero hour:
0 h 40 = 12:40 A.M. 16 horas = 4:00 P.M. 21 h 45 = 9:45 P.M.
117
09 (107-118) chapter 1600 8/1/03 10:35 AM Page 118
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
1. Tell how old you are.
2. Ask for today s date.
3. Express your birth date.
4. Ask what days the museum is closed.
5. Express the season we are in.
6. Give today s date.
7. Ask your friend when he/she wants to go out?
8. Say what time it is.
9. Ask at what time we ll be getting together.
10. Say when the movie (la película) begins.
118
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 119
Using Spanish
Around the
Home
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using deber
" Getting help around the house and
in a store
" Understanding and forming the
present subjunctive
" Using the subjunctive
" Using the imperfect, the perfect,
and the pluperfect subjunctive and
offering encouragement
In this chapter you ll learn how to express
school and household obligations by using
the verb deber (to have to), the idiomatic
expression tener que, or the subjunctive
mood. You ll also learn how to encourage
someone to pursue a course of action.
119
119
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 120
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
HOUSE AND HOME
In order to refer to the different rooms and parts of a house that might
need attention, you ll need the vocabulary in the following table.
ROOM/PLACE SPANISH ROOM/PLACE SPANISH
apartment el edificio floor el suelo
building de pisos
floor (story) el piso
apartment el apartamento
garage el garaje
attic el entretecho
ground floor la planta baja
backyard el jardín
house la casa
balcony el balcón
kitchen la cocina
basement el sótano
laundry room la lavandería
bathroom el cuarto de bańo
lawn el césped
bedroom el dormitorio
living room la sala
closet el armario
shower la ducha
door la puerta
stairs la escalera
elevator el ascensor
window la ventana
fireplace la chimenea
Naturally, within each room of a home there are pieces of furniture and
appliances that may also need your attention. The following list gives
you the names of the necessary equipment.
FURNITURE SPANISH FURNITURE SPANISH
bed la cama microwave oven el microondas
chair la silla mirror el espejo
clock el reloj oven el horno
clothes dryer la secadora refrigerator el refrigerador
computer la computadora sofa el sofá
dresser la cómoda stereo el estéreo
freezer el congelador stove la estufa
furniture los muebles table la mesa
lamp la lámpara television el televisor
120
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 121
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
CHORES
Among the most common household chores are those listed below.
CHORE SPANISH
clean the house limpiar la casa
cook cocinar
do the dishes lavar los platos
do the laundry lavar la ropa
go shopping ir de compras
iron planchar la ropa
make the beds hacer (tender) las camas
mow the lawn cortar el cesped
set the table poner la mesa
throw out the garbage sacar la basura
vacuum pasar la aspiradora
wash the car lavar el coche
STORES
Learn the names of the food stores, as well as the other establishments
listed in the following table. You might like to visit them while in a
Spanish-speaking country.
STORE/PRODUCT SPANISH PRODUCT
bakery/bread la panadería el pan
bookstore/books la librería los libros
butcher shop/meat la carnicería la carne
dairy store/milk la lechería la leche
fish store/fish la pescadería el pescado
florist/flowers la florería las flores
fruit store/fruits la frutería las frutas
grocery/vegetables la abastecería (el abasto) los vegetales
newsstand/newspapers el puesto de periódicos los periódicos
pharmacy/medicine la farmacia los medicamentos
121
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 122
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Remember that if you want to say that you are going to a store or that
you ll be at a store, you must use a + definite article. Note that a + el =
al. The other possibilities are a la, a los, or a las: al estanco, a la
panadería.
To express that you are going to a store, use the form of ir that agrees
with the subject and a with the appropriate definite article and noun:
Voy a la lechería. I m going to the dairy.
Vamos al puesto de periódicos. We re going to the newsstand.
Getting Help in a Store
An employee in any type of store may ask you one of these questions to
find out if you need assistance:
May I help you? żPuedo ayudarle a Ud.?
How can I help you? żEn que puedo servirle?
What can I offer you? żQué se le ofrece?
An appropriate answer would be:
No, thanks. I m just browsing. No, gracias. Estoy mirando solamente.
Yes, please. I would like to see . . . Sí, por favor. Quisiera ver . . .
Yes. I d like to buy . . . for . . . Sí, quisiera comprar . . . para . . .
Yes, I m looking for (I need) . . . Sí, estoy buscando (Necesito) . . .
Are there any sales? żHay gangas?
Are your prices reduced? żHay una buena rebaja de precios?
After being helped, you might hear the salesperson ask:
Anything else? żQué más?
żAlgo más?
Unless you need to continue with an order or explain other needs, you
can respond: No, gracias. Me quedo con éste (ésta). (No, thank you. I ll
take this.)
DEBER (TO HAVE TO)
The verb deber expresses what the subject should do:
yo debo nosotros debemos
122
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 123
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
tÅ› debes vosotros debéis
él debe ellos deben
Uses of Deber
Deber has some special uses when you want to persuade someone to do
something and when it expresses an obligation:
" Deber is used primarily to express obligation:
Debo salir. I have to leave.
I must leave.
I am supposed to leave.
I should leave.
" Deber de + infinitive is used to express probability:
Debe de estar atrasado. He must be late.
He is probably late.
" Deber in the imperfect + de + infinitive may also be used to express
probability in the past: Debía de estar atrasado. (He must have
been late.)
" The imperfect subjunctive of deber means ought to or should, and
expresses obligation (for more on the imperfect subjunctive see  The
Imperfect Subjunctive,  The Perfect and Pluperfect Subjunctive,
and  Offering Encouragement later in this chapter):
Debieras ir de compras. You should go shopping.
You ought to go shopping.
" Deber means to owe when followed by a noun: Le debo cinco
dólares a Juan. (I owe John five dollars.)
TENER QUE
Like deber, you can use the irregular verb tener + que + infinitive to
express obligation:
Yo tengo que trabajar. I have to work.
TÅ› tienes que lavar el coche. You have to wash the car.
Él tiene que poner la mesa. He has to set the table.
123
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 124
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Nosotros tenemos que cocinar. We have to cook.
Vosotros tenéis que lavar la ropa. You have to do the laundry.
Ellos tienen que ir de compras. They have to go shopping.
HAY QUE + INFINITVE
Hay que + infinitive is used in a general way to express what people must
do:
Hay que comer para vivir. You have to eat to live.
Hay que llegar a tiempo. You have to arrive on time.
UNDERSTANDING AND FORMING
THE PRESENT SUBJUNCTIVE
Like the conditional, the subjunctive is a mood (a form of the verb show-
ing the subject s attitude), not a tense (a form of the verb showing time).
You may use the subjunctive to persuade someone to follow a course of
action because it shows, among other things, wishing and wanting, need
and necessity, and feelings and emotions. The subjunctive is used much
more frequently in Spanish than in English.
Because the subjunctive is not a tense, the present subjunctive can
be used to refer to actions in the present or the future. The imperfect,
perfect, and pluperfect subjunctive refer to a completed past action.
Es necesario que él trabaje. It is necessary for him to work./
He has to work.
Es posible que ellas lleguen It s possible that they will arrive
a tiempo. on time.
Lamenté que Ud. haya esperado. I was sorry that you waited.
The following conditions must be present if the subjunctive is to be used:
" The sentence usually must contain two different clauses with two
different subjects.
" The clauses must be joined by que (that), which is followed by
the subjunctive.
" Among other things, the main clause must show need, necessity,
emotion, or doubt.
124
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 125
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
The Subjunctive of Regular Verbs
To form the present subjunctive of regular verbs, and many irregular
verbs, drop the -o from the first person singular indicative (yo) form of
the present and add the subjunctive endings:
YO TÚ ÉL NOSOTROS VOSOTROS ELLOS
-ar verbs -e -es -e -emos -éis -en
-er verbs -a -as -a -amos -áis -an
-ir verbs -a -as -a -amos -áis -an
The next table shows how this is done.
-AR VERBS -ER VERBS -IR VERBS
lavar (to wash) comer (to eat) abrir (to open)
yo lav yo como yo abr
o  o
yo lave yo coma yo abra
tÅ› laves tÅ› comas tÅ› abras
él lave él coma él abra
nosotros lavemos nosotros comamos nosotros abramos
vosotros lavéis vosotros comáis vosotros abráis
ellos laven ellos coman ellos abran
Notice that the endings are the reverse of the present tense endings,
which can be found in Chapter 22:00: ar to e; er and ir to a.
Verbs Irregular in the Yo Form
The following table shows verbs that are irregular only in the yo form of
the present tense and form the present subjuntive accordingly.
SUBJUNCTIVE STEM
VERB YO FORM AND ENDINGS
escoger (to choose) escojo escoj (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
conocer (to know) conozco conozc (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
destruir (to destroy) destruyo destruy (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
hacer (to do, make) hago hag (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
oír (to hear) oigo oig (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
poner (to put) pongo pong (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
125
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 126
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
salir (to leave) salgo salg (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
traer (to bring) traigo traig (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis,-an)
valer (to be worth) valgo valg (-a, -as, -a, -amos, -áis, -an)
venir (to come) vengo veng (-a, -as, -a, -amos, áis, -an)
Spelling Changes in the Present Subjunctive
In the present subjunctive, the following spelling changes are made:
-car verbs: change c to qu
-gar verbs: change g to gu
-zar verbs: change z to c
YO FORM SUBJUNCTIVE STEM
INFINITIVE PRETERIT AND ENDINGS
buscar busqué busqu (-e, -es, -e, -emos, -éis, -en)
pagar pagué pagu (-e, -es, -e, -emos, -éis, -en)
cruzar crucé cruc (-e, -es, -e, -emos, éis, -en)
Note that these verbs have the same spelling changes as they did in the
yo form of the preterite (see Chapter 21:00).
Stem-Changing Verbs in the Present Subjunctive
Stem-changing -ar, -er, and -ir verbs may or may not have the same stem
changes in the present subjunctive as they do in the present indicative.
Note: Changes in the stem occur in all persons, except the first- and
second-person plural (nosotros, vosotros).
-ar and -er Verbs
NOSOTROS/
E TO IE YO STEM VOSOTROS STEM
cerrar (to close) yo cierro cierr- cerr-
querer (to want) yo quiero quier- quer-
NOSOTROS/
O TO UE YO STEM VOSOTROS STEM
contar (to tell) yo cuento cuent- cont-
volver (to return) yo vuelvo vuelv- volv-
126
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 127
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
-ir Verbs
NOSOTROS/
E TO IE YO STEM VOSOTROS STEM
sentir (to regret) yo siento sient- sint-
NOSTROS/
O TO UE YO STEM VOSOTROS STEM
dormir (to sleep) yo duermo duerm- durm-
NOSOTROS/
E TO I YO STEM VOSOTROS STEM
pedir (to ask) yo pido pid- pid-
Note the accent marks in some -iar and -uar verbs in all forms except
nosotros:
enviar (to send) yo envío env(-íe, -íes, -íe, -iemos, -iéis, -íen)
continuar (to continue) yo continÅ›o contin(-Å›e, -Å›es, -Å›e, -uemos, -uéis, -Å›en)
Verbs Irregular in the Subjunctive
Some verbs follow no rules for the formation of the subjunctive and must
be memorized. The ones that are used the most frequently are:
dar (to give): dé, des, dé, demos, deis, den
estar (to be): esté, estés, esté, estemos, estéis, estén
haber (to have): haya, hayas, haya, hayamos, hayáis, hayan
ir (to go): vaya, vayas, vaya, vayamos, vayáis, vayan
saber (to know): sepa, sepas, sepa, sepamos, sepáis, sepan
ser (to be): sea, seas, sea, seamos, seáis, sean
Expressions of Need and Necessity
The subjunctive may be used to persuade someone of the need or neces-
sity to do something or to make requests or demands. The expressions
below are typically followed by the subjunctive.
SPANISH MEANING
Es mejor que . . . It is better that . . .
Más vale que . . . It is better that . . .
Es importante que . . . It is important that . . .
Es necesario que . . . It is necessary that . . .
127
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 128
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Es preferible que . . . It is preferable that . . .
Es tiempo que . . . It is time that . . .
Es urgente que . . . It is urgent that . . .
Es śtil que . . . It is useful that . . .
Es importante que vayas al It is important you go to
supermercado. the supermarket.
Es urgente que hable al médico It s urgent that he call
por telefono. the doctor.
Be aware that the Spanish subjunctive may have many different mean-
ings in English and will often not allow for an exact, word-for-word
translation:
Es necesario que pongas la mesa. You have to set the table.
It is necessary that you
set the table.
In Spanish, the subjunctive is often equivalent to an infinitive in English:
Quiero que tÅ› vayas de compras. (I want you to go to the store.)
Verbs of Wishing and Wanting
The subjunctive is often used after the verbs listed below:
decir to tell, say ojalá if only . . .
desear to desire, wish, want pedir to ask for, request
esperar to hope permitir to permit
hacer to make, cause preferir to prefer
insistir to insist querer to wish, want
mandar to command, order
Él pide que yo haga el trabajo. He asks that I do the work.
Prefiero que tÅ› vayas a la farmacia. I prefer you to go to the pharmacy.
When using the subjunctive in English, we often omit the word that. In
Spanish however, que must always be used to join the two clauses:
Es importante que él lave el coche. It s important that he wash the car.
Quiero que tÅ› cortes el césped. I want you to mow the lawn.
128
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 129
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
Avoiding the Subjunctive
In all of the examples shown thus far, the verb in the dependent clause
(where the subjunctive is used) and the verb in the main clause (need,
necessity, wishing, or wanting) have different subjects. If the subjects in
both clauses are the same, que is omitted and the infinitive replaces the
subjunctive:
Ella quiere que yo vaya a la panadería. She wants me to go to the bakery.
Ella quiere ir a la panadería. She wants to go to the bakery.
The verbs dejar (to allow), hacer (to make, do), mandar (to order),
permitir (to permit), and prohibir (to forbid) may be followed by either
the subjunctive or the infinitive:
Me mandan que salga. They order me to leave.
Me mandan salir.
THE IMPERFECT SUBJUNCTIVE
The imperfect subjunctive is used in the dependent clause (the clause
after que) when the verb in the main clause is in the past. For the verbs
deber and querer, the imperfect subjunctive form may be used to express
the conditional:
Le mandaron que saliera. They ordered him to leave.
Debieras ir a Espańa. You should go to Spain.
Quisiera trabajar. I would like to work.
The imperfect subjunctive of all verbs is formed by dropping the -ron
ending of the third person plural (ellos) of the preterite tense and adding
either of the endings below. Either is correct as long as they are used con-
sistently:
SUBJECT ENDING OR ENDING
yo -ra -se
tÅ› -ras -ses
él -ra -se
nosotros -´ramos -´semos
vosotros -rais -seis
ellos -ran -sen
129
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 130
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
NOTE
The nosotros form of the imperfect subjunctive has an accent on the
vowel immediately before the ending, whether you use the -ra ending or
the -se ending.
The following table shows how to form the imperfect subjunctive.
INFINITIVE PRETERIT IMPERFECT SUBJUNCTIVE
Third Person Plural
hablar habla hablara, hablaras, hablara,
ron
habláramos, hablarais, hablaran
OR
hablase, hablases, hablase,
hablásemos, hablaseis, hablasen
vender vendie vendiera, vendieras, vendiera,
ron
vendiéramos, vendierais, vendieran
OR
vendiese, vendieses, vendiese,
vendiésemos, vendieseis, vendiesen
abrir abrie abriera, abrieras, abriera,
ron
abriéramos, abrierais, abrieran
OR
abriese, abrieses, abriese,
abriésemos, abrieseis, abriesen
THE PERFECT AND PLUPERFECT SUBJUNCTIVE
The perfect and pluperfect subjunctives are formed in the same manner
as other compound tenses. Take the present subjunctive form of the help-
ing verb haber (haya, hayas, haya, hayamos, hayáis, hayan) to form the
perfect subjunctive, and take the imperfect subjunctive of haber (hubiera/
hubiese; hubieras/hubieses; hubiera/hubiese; hubiéramos/hubiésemos;
hubierais/hubieseis; hubieran/hubiesen) to form the pluperfect subjunc-
tive and add the past participle:
130
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 131
"
1 5 : 0 0 U S I N G S P A N I S H A R O U N D T H E H O M E
Es importante que Uds. lo hayan visto. It is important that you have
seen it.
Era importante que Uds. lo hubieran It was important that you had
(hubiesen) visto. seen it.
The perfect and pluperfect subjunctives are compound forms expressing
actions completed in the past. The perfect subjunctive expresses what the
subject has done, while the imperfect subjunctive expresses what the
subject had done. The verb in the main clause may be in the present tense.
OFFERING ENCOURAGEMENT
We have seen how the subjunctive can be used to convince someone to
follow a course of action. The best way to persuade someone to do some-
thing, whether it be a chore or a fun activity, is to offer a bit of encour-
agement.
PHRASE SPANISH
A little more effort! Ä„Un poquito más de esfuerzo!
Don t hesitate! Ä„No vacile!
Go for it! Ä„Vaya por eso!
Keep going! ĄContinśe!/ĄSiga!
You have to try! Ä„Tiene que tratar!
You re almost there! Ä„Casi está allí!
You re getting there! Ä„Ya está llegando!
All of the phrases of encouragement can be changed to familiar com-
mands by changing to the tÅ› command form, which you will learn in the
next chapter.
You re almost there! Ä„Ya casi llegas!
Continue! ĄContinśa!
131
10 (119-132) chapter 1500 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 132
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
Express the following things to someone:
1. You are just browsing (in a store).
2. You d like to buy a car for your family.
3. He/she has to listen.
4. He/she is supposed to go to the bakery.
5. He/she ought to make the beds.
6. He/she owes you five dollars.
7. It is necessary to go shopping.
8. You want him/her to throw out the garbage.
9. You want to go to the bookstore.
10. Encourage someone to wash the car.
132
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 133
Offering Ideas
and Issuing
Commands
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Making proposals
" Giving commands
" Getting there
" Using idioms
In this lesson you ll learn how to be
persuasive when you make suggestions
and how to use commands to give and
receive directions.
133
133
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 134
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
MAKING PROPOSALS
In English, to persuade someone to do something or go somewhere you
ask,  How about . . . ? or you use the contraction  Let s. Other
expressions that allow you to make suggestions can also be quite
idiomatic and, therefore, cannot be translated word for word from
English to Spanish. There are several ways to get around this problem.
" To express  Why don t we . . . ? use żPor qué no + the present
tense nosotros form of the verb: żPor qué no vamos a EspaÅ„a? (Why
don t we go to Spain?)
" Use tener ganas de + an infinitive to ask what a person feels like
doing: żTiene(s) ganas de ir a Espańa? (Do you feel like going to
Spain?)
" Use querer + an infinitive of a verb to ask if a person wants to do
something: żQuiere(s) ir a Espańa? (Do you want to go to Spain?)
" Use vamos a + an infinitive to make a suggestion similar to the
English contraction  Let s : Vamos a ir a Espańa. (Let s go to
Spain.)
" Use the nosotros form of the present subjunctive of the verb to also
express  Let s : Vayamos a Espańa. (Let s go to Spain.)
COMMANDS
Commands are very useful for directing people to locations. The subject
of a command is understood to be you, because you are being told where
to go or what to do.
Remember, there are four ways to say you in Spanish and you must
always use the polite forms (Ud., Uds.) when you don t know the other
party:
SINGULAR PLURAL
Familiar tÅ› vosotros
Polite Ud. Uds.
Polite Commands
To form polite commands with regular verbs:
1. Take the yo form of the present tense and drop the final -o.
2. For infinitives ending in -ar, add -e for the singular and -en for
the plural command.
3. For infinitives ending in -er or -ir, add -a for the singular and -an
for the plural.
134
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 135
"
1 4 : 0 0 O F F E R I N G I D E A S A N D I S S U I N G C O M M A N D S
YO IN UD. UDS.
INFINITIVE PRESENT COMMAND COMMAND MEANING
hablar hablo hable hablen speak
comer como coma coman eat
escribir escribo escriba escriban write
Verbs with irregular yo forms follow the same rules for forming com-
mands as regular verbs:
tener: tengo tenga tengan have
decir: digo diga digan tell
The following verbs are irregular:
dar: doy dé den give
ir: voy vaya vayan go
ser: soy sea sean be
The subject pronoun may or may not be used with commands in Spanish:
Vuelva (Ud.). Return.
Vengan (Uds.). Come.
To make a command negative, simply put no in front of the verb: No
hable (Ud.). (Don t speak.)
Familiar Commands
Affirmative and negative familiar commands are formed in different ways:
" The singular affirmative tÅ› command is formed by dropping the
final s from the present tense, tÅ› form of the verb.
Hablas Habla.
 .
" The plural affirmative vosotros command is formed by dropping
the final r from the infinitive and adding d.
Habla . Hablad.
r
" The negative tÅ› and vosotros command forms are identical to the
corresponding present subjunctive forms (see Chapter 15:00).
No hables. No habléis.
135
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 136
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
The table below illustrates the formation of the familiar commands.
INFINITIVE AFFIRMATIVE NEGATIVE
hablar habla (tÅ›) no hables (tÅ›)
hablad (vosotros) no habléis (vosotros)
comer come (tÅ›) no comas (tÅ›)
comed (vosotros) no comáis (vosotros)
escribir escribe (tÅ›) no escribas (tÅ›)
escribid (vosotros) no escribáis (vosotros)
Irregular Commands
Irregular commands occur only in the affirmative singular tÅ› form. All
other command forms are regular as shown here.
INFINITIVE AFFIRMATIVE NEGATIVE
TÅ›/Vosotros TÅ›/Vosotros
decir (to tell) di/decid no digas/digáis
hacer (to do) haz/haced no hagas/hagáis
ir (to go) ve/id no vayas/vayáis
poner (to put) pon/poned no pongas/pongáis
salir (to leave) sal/salid no salgas/salgáis
ser (to be) sé/sed no seas/seáis
tener (to have) ten/tened no tengas/tengáis
valer (to be worth) val/valed no valgas/valgáis
venir (to come) ven/venid no vengas/vengáis
Refer to the following for the high-frequency verbs you will need in
order to give and receive directions.
DIRECTION TÚ/VOSOTROS UD./UDS.
Continue Continśa/Continuad Continśe/Continśen
Do not continue No continÅ›es/continuéis No continÅ›e/continÅ›en
Cross Cruza/Cruzad Cruce/Crucen
Do not cross No cruces/crucéis No cruce/crucen
136
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 137
"
1 4 : 0 0 O F F E R I N G I D E A S A N D I S S U I N G C O M M A N D S
Get off Baja/Bajad Baje/Bajen
Do not get off No bajes/bajéis No baje/bajen
Go down Baja/Bajad Baje/Bajen
Do not go down No bajes/bajéis No baje/bajen
Go up Sube/Subid Suba/Suban
Do not go up No subas/subáis No suba/suban
Go Ve/Id Vaya/Vayan
Do not go No vayas/vayáis No vaya/vayan
Pass Pasa/Pasad Pase/Pasen
Do not pass No pases/paséis No pase/pasen
Take Toma/Tomad Tome/Tomen
Do not take No tomes/toméis No tome/tomen
Turn Dobla/Doblad Doble/Doblen
Do not turn No dobles/dobléis No doble/doblen
Walk Camina/Caminad Camine/Caminen
Do not walk No camines/caminéis No camine/caminen
To give proper directions, you will need the names of the means of trans-
portation. When explaining the means of transportation a person will
take, use a definite article (el, la, los, las) and say: Toma el autobśs. (Take
the bus.) When saying that someone travels by a certain means of trans-
portation, be careful to use to the correct preposition:
TRANSPORTATION SPANISH
airplane en avión (m.)
bicycle en bicicleta
bus en autobśs (m.)
car en coche (m.), en carro
on foot a pie (m.)
subway en metro
taxi en taxi
train en tren
137
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 138
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Also use a + definite article (al, a la, a los, a las) to express where to get
the transportation you need. Study the following:
I am going . . . Voy . . .
PLACE SPANISH
to the airport al aeropuerto
to the bus stop a la parada de autobśs
to the dock al muelle
to the gate a la puerta
to the platform al andén
to the station a la estación
to the taxi stand a la parada de taxis
to the terminal a la terminal
to the track a la vía
Use the numbers given in Chapter 16:00 to obtain or give gate, platform,
or track numbers: Tś vas al aeropuerto y tomas el avión a la puerta
nśmero seis. (You go to the airport and you take the plane at gate num-
ber six.)
To give or receive adequate directions, you also need the prepositions
and prepositional idioms showing location and direction:
PREPOSITION MEANING
a at, to
arriba above, on top of
cerca nearby
en in, into, within, on
hacia toward
por by, through
sobre over, above
PHRASE MEANING
a la derecha to the right
a la izquierda to the left
al centro downtown
al centro (de) in the middle (of)
138
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 139
"
1 4 : 0 0 O F F E R I N G I D E A S A N D I S S U I N G C O M M A N D S
al otro lado (de) on the other side (of)
alrededor de around
debajo de beneath
enfrente de opposite, facing, across from
junto a alongside
por aquí (allá) this way, that way, nearby
todo derecho straight ahead
In English, when we give directions, we often refer to the number of
blocks a person has to walk. In Spanish, use the word una cuadra (a
block): Vivo a dos cuadras de aqui. (I live two blocks from here.)
Commands with Reflexive Verbs
With reflexive verbs, the subject pronoun is usually dropped but the
reflexive pronoun must be used. In negative commands, the reflexive
pronoun precedes the verb:
Don t get up early! Ä„No se levante (Ud.) temprano!
Ä„No se levantan (Uds.) temprano!
Ä„No te levantas (tÅ›) temprano!
Ä„No os levantéis (vosotros) temprano!
In affirmative commands, the reflexive pronoun follows the verb and is
attached to it. Note that the final d is dropped from the vosotros form
before adding the reflexive pronoun. An accent mark is placed on the
stressed vowel of the tÅ›, Ud., and Uds. forms. To find the stressed vowel
in most instances, simply count back three vowels and add the accent:
Get up! Ä„Levántese (Ud.)!
Ä„Levántense (Uds)!
Ä„Levántate (tÅ›)!
Ä„Levántaos (vosotros)!
GETTING THERE
Being able to understand and knowing how to give directions is an
important survival skill for those traveling abroad. Should you get lost
and find yourself in need of instructions, the following sentences will
prove useful. The blanks can be filled in with proper names or a tourist
attraction, store, sporting event, etc.
139
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 140
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
I m lost. Estoy perdido(a).
Can you tell me how to żPuede decirme cómo se va a . . .
get to . . . ?
Where is (are) . . . ? żDónde está(n) . . .
Being able to follow directions that are given to you will be of utmost
importance, whether you are lost or simply looking for a place that you
can t seem to locate:
It s (Is it) far away.(?) (ż)Está lejos.(?)
It s (Is it) nearby.(?) (ż)Está cerca.(?)
It s (Is it) this way.(?) (ż)Está por aquí.(?)
It s (Is it) that way.(?) (ż) Está por allá.(?)
It s (Is it) straight ahead.(?) (ż) Es derecho.(?)
Turn right (left) at the light. Doble a la derecha (a la izquierda)
en el semáforo.
Stop! Ä„Alto!
Follow me. Sígame.
There it (they) is (are). Allá está(n).
It would be better to take (definite article + means of transportation) . . .
Sería mejor tomar (el/la + means of transportation) . . .
And if you are far from your destination:
Is it to the north? żEstá al norte?
Is it to the south? żEstá al sur?
Is it to the east? żEstá al este?
Is it to the west? żEstá al oeste?
USING IDIOMS
In English, we use idioms and idiomatic expressions all the time without
even realizing that we are doing so. An example will help you understand
exactly how an idiom works. The phrase  She fell head over heels for him
does not mean in a literal sense that she fell head first and tripped over
her feet. To someone who doesn t speak English well, this sentence could
140
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 141
"
1 4 : 0 0 O F F E R I N G I D E A S A N D I S S U I N G C O M M A N D S
be extremely confusing. But a native speaker immediately understands the
underlying meaning of this phrase that she really liked him a lot.
Idioms occur in every language, are generally indigenous to that spe-
cific language, and do not translate well from one language to the next.
If a Spanish speaker were to say,  Este coche cuesta un ojo de la cara,
she would mean that the car costs a small fortune, even though the liter-
al translation of the sentence is,  This car costs an eye from your face.
An idiom, then, is a word or expression whose meaning cannot be eas-
ily understood by analyzing or translating every word in the sentence.
Use the idioms in the following table to express your opinions and
accentuate the positive.
IDIOM SPANISH
as for me a pesar de todo
in my opinion en mi opinión
of course por supuesto
OK de acuerdo
on the contrary al contrario
to tell the truth a decir verdad
without a doubt sin duda
POSITIVE REINFORCEMENT
If you would like to persuade someone to do something, positive rein-
forcement might work. Reinforcing your opinions by using the words
and expressions presented below should help you convince even the most
stubborn among you.
PHRASE SPANISH PHRASE SPANISH
It s a good idea! Ä„Es una It s magnificent! Ä„Es magnífico(a)!
buena idea!
It s great! Ä„Es excelente! It s sensational! Ä„Es sensacional!
It s important! Ä„Es importante! It s super! Ä„Es estupendo(a)!
It s interesting! Ä„Es interesante! It s superb! Ä„Es fenomenal!
Combine expressions from the previous two tables to be persuasive:
A decir verdad, es fenomenal! To tell the truth, it s superb!
A pesar de todo, es magnífico. All the same, it s magnificent.
141
11 (133-142) chapter 1400 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 142
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
COMPLAINTS
If you have persuaded someone to go along with you and they are not
satisfied, you can expect to hear one of the following phrases:
COMPLAINT SPANISH
It s annoying! Ä„Es fastidioso(a)!
It s boring! Ä„Es aburrido(a)!
It s disgusting! Ä„Es asqueroso(a)!
It s frightful! Ä„Es terrible!
It s horrible! Ä„Es horrible!
It s ridiculous! Ä„Es ridículo(a)!
TIME S UP!
Without looking back, do the following:
1. Use żPor qué no . . . to suggest going to a restaurant.
2. Propose going to the movies by using tener ganas de.
3. Ask a friend if he/she wants to go shopping.
4. Suggest to a friend:  Let s go to the Prado museum.
5. Using an affirmative command, tell someone to continue walking
three blocks.
6. Using a negative command, tell someone not to go straight ahead.
7. Tell a friend to wake up early.
8. Give a positive reason for going to visit El Morro castle in Puerto Rico.
9. Say that in your opinion, it s great.
10. Give a negative reaction toward going to the theater.
142
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 143
Asking
Questions
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Asking yes/no questions
" Asking for information
" Getting around
" Questioning new acquaintances
In this lesson you ll learn how to ask
questions in a variety of different ways.
No matter what the situation, no matter
what your needs, you ll be able to get
the information you seek.
143
143
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 144
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
ASKING YES/NO QUESTIONS
The easiest questions, by far, are those that demand a simple yes or no
answer. There are four ways to obtain this information. You can use:
" Intonation
" The tag żNo es verdad? (Isn t that so?)
" The tag żEstá bien?
" Inversion
Using Intonation
Questions are often asked by changing your intonation and raising your
voice at the end of a statement. In conversation, just put an imaginary
question mark at the end of your thought and speak with a rising inflec-
tion. When writing a question, make sure to put an inverted question
mark (ż) at the beginning of the sentence and a regular one at the end
of the sentence: żTienes ganas de ir al cine? (Do you feel like going to
the movies?)
When you speak with a rising inflection, your voice starts out lower
and gradually keeps rising until the end of the sentence. In a sentence
that states a fact, your voice rises and then lowers by the end of the
sentence.
To form a negative question, simply put no before the conjugated verb
in simple and compound tenses and whenever there are two verbs:
żNo tienes ganas de ir al cine? Don t you feel like going to the movies?
żNo has escrito la carta? Didn t you write the letter?
Using żNo Es Verdad? and żEstá Bien?
żNo es verdad? and żEstá bien? are tags that can have a variety of mean-
ings: isn t that so?; right?; isn t (doesn t) he/she?; aren t (don t) they?;
aren t (don t) we?; aren t (don t) you?; and so on. żNo es verdad? and
żEstá bien? may be placed at the end of a statement, especially when the
expected answer is yes:
Tienes ganas de ir al cine. You feel like going to the movies,
żNo es verdad? don t you?
Vamos al cine. żEstá bien? We re going to the movies. OK?
Using Inversion
Inversion refers to reversing the word order of the subject noun or pro-
noun and verb form. Remember to raise your voice at the end of the
phrase to show that you are asking a question:
Ud. va al cine. żVa Ud. al cine?
144
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 145
"
1 3 : 0 0 A S K I N G Q U E S T I O N S
Juan es de Espańa. żEs Juan de Espańa?
Ud. se levanta tarde. żSe levanta Ud. tarde?
When there are two verbs or a compound tense, put the subject noun or
pronoun after the phrase containing the second verb:
Ella quiere salir. żQuiere salir ella?
María quería trabajar allí. żQuería trabajar allí María?
Ana está estudiando arte. żEstá estudiando arte Ana?
Él ha escrito esta carta. żHa escrito esta carta él?
To make a question with inversion negative, put no before the inverted
verb and pronoun. For reflexive verbs, remember to keep the reflexive
pronouns before the conjugated verb, from which it may not be separated.
żNo es espańol el nińo? Isn t the boy Spanish?
żNo querías salir? Didn t you want to go out?
żNo se levantó temprano Marta? Didn t Martha wake up early?
żNo han lavado el coche ellas? Didn t they wash the car?
INFORMATION QUESTIONS
No matter what your reason for studying Spanish, many occasions will
arise when a simple yes/no response is inadequate. For this reason, it is
important to know how to ask for information. Interrogative adjectives,
adverbs, and pronouns will allow you to accomplish this task.
Interrogative Adjectives
The interrogative adjectives qué (which, what), cuánto(-a) (how much),
and cuántos(-as) (how many) are used before nouns. Cuánto must agree
in number and gender with the noun it modifies as shown here:
MASCULINE FEMININE
Singular żcuánto? żcuánta?
Plural żcuántos? żcuántas?
An interrogative adjective may be placed at the beginning of the sentence
or after the verb, but it must always precede its noun and any modifiers
of that noun. In spoken Spanish you may hear the second form, shown
below, but only for emphasis.
145
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 146
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
żQué revista lees? What magazine are you reading?
żLees qué revista?
żCuánto tiempo necesitas? How much time do you need?
żNecesitas cuánto tiempo?
żCuánta comida van a comer? How much food are they going to eat?
żVan a comer cuánta comida?
żCuántos miembros hay? How many members are there?
żHay cuántos miembros?
żCuántas personas vienen? How many people are coming?
żVienen cuántas personas?
Interrogative adjectives may be preceded by a preposition:
żA qué hora llegó? At what time did he arrive?
żDe cuántas personas hablaba? About how many people was
he speaking to?
żCon cuánto dinero vas a viajar? How much money will you
travel with?
Interrogative Adverbs
Adverbs asking for information help you find out what you need to
know. Use the interrogative adverbs listed in the table below with inver-
sion to form questions.
ADVERB SPANISH
how? żcómo?
when? żcuándo?
where (to)? żdónde?
why? (for what reason) żpor qué?
why? (for what purpose) żpara qué?
Interrogative adverbs are followed by inversion:
żCómo se llama (Ud.)? What s your name?
żPor qué está (él) atrasado? Why is he late?
146
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 147
"
1 3 : 0 0 A S K I N G Q U E S T I O N S
Some interrogative adverbs can also be preceded by prepositions:
żPara cuándo necesita (Ud.) When do you need the papers by?
los papeles?
żDe dónde son (ellas)? Where are they from?
żPara Qué? and żPor Qué? żPara qué? asks about a purpose:
żPara qué usas este libro? Why (For what purpose) do you
use this book?
 Uso este libro para aprender  I use this book to learn Spanish.
el espańol.
żPor qué? asks about a reason:
żPor qué vas a la biblioteca? Why (For what reason) do you
go to the library?
 Voy a la biblioteca porque  I go to the library because I need
necesito un libro. a book.
NOTE
Questions with żpor qué? call for an answer with porque (because),
while questions with żpara qué? call for an answer with para (for, to).
Interrogative Pronouns
If you were in a store trying to make a decision about which of two or
more items to choose, you might want to ask the salesperson which
one would be the right choice, or what the price is. The interrogative
pronouns listed below will help you ask your questions properly.
PRONOUN SPANISH
Who? żquién(es)?
What? żqué?
What? Which one(s) żcuál(es)?
How much? żcuánto?
How many? żcuántos(as)?
The interrogative pronouns żquién(es)? and żcuál(es)? agree in number
with the nouns they replace, while żcuánto? agrees in both number and
gender with the noun being replaced:
147
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 148
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
żQuién trabaja? Who is working?
(The answer requires the name of one person.)
żQuiénes trabajan? Who is working?
(The answer requires at least two names.)
żCuál de estas películas prefieres? Which (one) of these films
do you prefer?
(The answer requires the name of one film.)
żCuáles de estas películas Which (ones) of these films do
prefieres? you prefer?
(The answer requires at least two names.)
żCuánto cuesta esta camisa? How much does this shirt cost?
żCuántos están aquí? How many are here?
żCuántas son? How many (females) are there?
A preposition + quién refers to people. A preposition + que refers to
things.
żDe quién hablas? żDe qué hablas?
Whom are you speaking about? What are you speaking about?
żA quién se refiere? żA qué se refiere?
To whom are you referring? What are you referring to?
żAdónde vas? żDe dónde eres?
Where are you going? Where are you from?
żQué? and żCuál? żQué? usually means  what and asks about a defini-
tion, description, or an explanation. When it comes before a noun,
however, żqué? means  which.
żQué es esto? What is this?
żQué está pensando? What are you thinking?
żQué programa estás mirando? Which program are you watching?
148
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 149
"
1 3 : 0 0 A S K I N G Q U E S T I O N S
żCuál? means  what or  which (one, ones) and asks about a choice or
a selection:
żCuál es su nombre? What is your name?
żCuál de los tres quiere Ud.? Which (one) of the three do you want?
żCuáles son los días de la semana? What are the days of the week?
HAY
The verb haber is used impersonally to ask and answer questions. The
expression hay can mean  there is (are) as a statement or  is (are)
there as a question. Note the following about the uses of hay:
" As a question, hay can be used by itself using intonation: żHay un
restaurante por aquí? (Is there a restaurant nearby?)
" It can be used with a preceding question word: żDónde hay un
restaurante por aquí? (Where is a nearby restaurant?)
" Hay can also be used to ask a negative question: żNo hay un
restaurante por aquí? (Isn t there a restaurant nearby?)
" You can use hay in a non-interrogative sentence to answer a
question: Hay un restaurante por aquí. (There is a restaurant
nearby.)
Expressions with Hay
Hay is generally used to refer to certain weather or physical conditions:
There s moonlight. Hay luna.
It s foggy. Hay neblina.
It s sunny. Hay sol.
Hay que + infinitive means to be necessary to: Hay que beber agua para
vivir. (One must drink water to live.)
ASKING FOR DIRECTIONS
You can ask for directions by using the following phrases:
Where is . . . ? żDónde está . . . ?
Where are . . . ? żDónde están . . . ?
Can you tell me how to get to . . . ? żPuede Ud. decirme cómo se va a . . . ?
149
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 150
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Where is the Prado? żDónde está el Prado?
żPuede Ud. decirme cómo se
va al Prado?
El Prado, por favor.
Where are the bathrooms? żDónde están los baÅ„os/los servicios?
żPuede Ud. decirme cómo se va
a los bańos/los servicios?
Los bańos/los servicios, por favor.
ASKING FOR A PRICE
Being able to ask for prices in a foreign country is always a valuable tool.
Use the following phrases when you need to know how much something
costs:
żCuánto cuesta (un/una) . . . ? What s the price of (a) . . . ?
żCuánto cuesta este (esta)/ How much does this/that . . . cost?
ese (esa) . . . ?
żCuánto cuestan estos (estas)/ How much do these/those . . . cost?
esos (esas) . . . ?
żCuánto cuesta un periódico? How much does a newspaper cost?
żCuánto cuesta(n) este (estos) How much does this (do these)
periódico(s)? newspaper(s) cost?
żCuánto cuesta(n) esta (estas) How much does this (do these)
revista(s)? magazine(s) cost?
When asking for a price, make sure that all the singular and plural, mas-
culine and feminine elements of the sentence agree:
żCuánto cuestan estas cartas? How much do these cards cost?
żCuánto cuesta el pantalón blanco? How much do the white pants cost?
QUESTIONING NEW ACQUAINTANCES
When you meet someone for the first time, there are many questions you
would like to ask to get to know that person better. Here are some of the
most common questions that could be used to get information by using
the polite or familiar verb forms:
150
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 151
"
1 3 : 0 0 A S K I N G Q U E S T I O N S
What s your name? żCómo se llama (Ud.)?
żCómo te llamas?
What is your wife s (child s) name? żCómo se llama su (tu) esposa
(nińo, nińa)?
Where are you from? żDe dónde es (eres)?
What is your nationality? żCuál es su (tu) nacionalidad?
What is your profession? żCuál es su (tu) profesión?
How old are you? żCuántos aÅ„os tiene(s)?
How many people are in żCuántas personas hay en su (tu)
your family? familia?
Where are you staying? żDónde se (te) aloja(s)?
Where do you live? żDónde vive(s)?
What is your address? żCuál es su (tu) dirección?
What is your phone number? żCuál es su (tu) nÅ›mero de teléfono?
LACK OF COMMUNICATION
When you ve asked a question and don t understand the answer or need
more information, use the following expressions to help you get the
information you need.
PHRASE SPANISH
Excuse me. Perdón.
Excuse me. Perdóneme. (polite)
Excuse me. Perdóname. (familiar)
Excuse me. Con permiso.
I don t understand. No comprendo.
I don t understand. No entiendo.
I didn t hear you. No le (te) oí.
I didn t understand you. No le (te) entendí.
What? żCómo?
Please repeat it. Repita, por favor. (polite)
Please repeat it. Repite, por favor. (familiar)
151
12 (143-152) chapter 1300 8/1/03 10:36 AM Page 152
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Speak more slowly. Hable más despacio. (polite)
Speak more slowly. Habla más despacio. (familiar)
What did you say? żQué dijo (dijiste)?
One more time. Otra vez.
I m sorry. Lo siento.
NOTE
You can use perdón and perdóneme if you have disturbed or bumped
into someone, whereas you should use con permiso when leaving,
asking permission to pass through a group or crowd, or when walking
in front of a person.
TIME S UP!
Without looking back in the chapter, try to complete the following:
1. Ask a person for his/her name.
2. Ask a person for his/her address.
3. Ask a person for his/her phone number.
4. Ask where a person is from.
5. Ask a person s age.
6. Ask if there is a restaurant nearby.
7. Ask which one of the films he/she prefers.
8. Ask a person his/her profession.
9. Ask for the price of a newspaper.
10. Say that you are sorry and that you don t understand.
152
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 153
Answering
Questions
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Answering yes and no questions
" Using negative expressions
" Answering questions with żqué?
and żcuál?
" Answering questions with interrogative
adverbs
" Talking on the phone
" Facing phone problems
In this lesson you ll learn how to correctly
answer the questions people ask you
by giving affirmative or negative responses
or by providing necessary information.
You ll also learn how to conduct a phone
conversation.
153
153
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 154
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
ANSWERING YES
Use sí to answer a question affirmatively:
żQuieres ir al cine? Do you want to go to the movies?
 Sí, es una buena idea.  Yes, that s a good idea.
Esta película es fantástica. This film is great.
 Creo que sí.  I think so.
ANSWERING NO
In Chapter 17:00 you learned how to use no to respond negatively. Other
common negatives are listed below. Negative answers may begin with no.
NEGATIVE SPANISH
neither . . . nor ni . . . ni
neither, not either tampoco
never, (not) ever jamás, nunca
no one, nobody nadie
no, none, (not) any ninguno(-a)
no, not no
nothing nada
To answer negatively, do the following:
" In simple and compound tenses, always put no before the
conjugated verb. No may be repeated for emphasis:
żBailas bien? No bailo bien. No, no bailo bien.
Do you dance well? I don t dance well. No, I don t dance well.
żQuiere comer? No quiero comer. No, no quiero comer.
Do you want to eat? I don t want to eat. No, I don t want to eat.
żHa terminado? No ha terminado. No, no ha terminado.
Did he finish? He didn t finish. No, he didn t finish.
" Direct and indirect object pronouns, discussed in greater detail in
Chapter 10:00, also remain before the conjugated verb when a
negative construction is used:
154
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 155
"
1 2 : 0 0 A N S W E R I N G Q U E S T I O N S
żVio el hombre? No lo vi. No, no lo vi.
Did you see the man? I didn t see him. No, I didn t see him.
" Spanish sentences may have more than one negative. When no is one
of the negatives, it precedes the conjugated verb. If no is omitted,
another negative precedes the verb:
No canto nunca. Nunca canto. I never sing.
No habla nadie. Nadie habla. No one is speaking.
No le creo a nadie Nunca le creo a nadie. I never believe anyone.
nunca.
No lo vi tampoco. Tampoco lo vi. I didn t see it either.
No prefiero ni rojo Ni rojo ni verde prefiero. I don t prefer either
ni verde. red or green.
" Each part of the ni . . . ni construction precedes the word or words
stressed:
No como ni frutas ni legumbres. I eat neither fruits nor vegetables.
La comida no estaba ni buena The meal was neither good nor bad.
ni mala.
No le gusta ni bailar ni cantar. He doesn t like to dance or to sing.
" An infinitive may be negated as follows: Es mejor no decir nada.
(It s better not to say anything.)
" The negatives nadie, nada, nunca, and jamás are used after
comparisons and in phrases beginning with sin (without) or antes
(de or que) (before):
Juega mejor que nadie. He plays better than anyone.
Lo comprendo más que nunca. I understand it better than ever.
Lo aprecia más que nada. She treasures it more than anything.
Llegó sin traer nada. He arrived without bringing anything.
Hablé antes que nadie. I spoke before anyone else.
Antes de hacer nada, ella tiene Before doing anything, she has to
que hacer su tarea. do her homework.
155
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 156
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
" Negatives may be used alone (without no):
żQué estás haciendo? What are you doing?
 Nada.  Nothing.
żHa estado en Espańa? Have you been to Spain?
 Jamás.  Never.
" Negatives may be used with two verbs by placing no before the
conjugated verb and another negative word after the second verb:
No quiero hacer nada. I don t want to do anything.
No he visto a nadie. I didn t see anyone.
" Ninguno (not any) drops the final -o and adds an accent to the
u = ningśn before a masculine singular noun. The feminine singular
form is ninguna. There are no plural forms. When used as an
adjective, ninguno may be replaced by alguno (a more emphatic
negative), which follows the noun:
No tengo ninguno. I don t have any.
No tengo ningśn problema. I have no problem.
No tengo problema alguno. I don t have a problem.
" A negative expression that begins with a preposition retains that
preposition when placed before the verb: En nada pienso. (I m not
thinking about anything.)
The words in the first column below, when used in questions, produce
the corresponding negative response listed in the second column:
alguien (someone) nadie (no one)
siempre (sometimes) jamás/nunca (never)
algo (something) nada (nothing)
también (also) tampoco (neither)
alguno(a) (some, any) ninguno(a) (none, not any)
żBuscas algo? No busco nada.
Are you looking for something? I m not looking for anything.
156
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 157
"
1 2 : 0 0 A N S W E R I N G Q U E S T I O N S
NEGATIVE EXPRESSIONS
The following common negative expressions will prove useful in any
number of everyday situations:
" No importa. (It doesn t matter.):
Él estará atrasado. He s going to be late.
 No importa.  It doesn t matter.
" De nada. (You re welcome.) or No hay de qué. (You re welcome.):
Muchas gracias por todo. Thank you for everything.
 De nada. (No hay de qué.)  You re welcome.
" Ä„De ninguna manera! (Certainly not!/Not at all!):
żTe molesta? Does that bother you?
 Ä„De ninguna manera!  Not at all!
" Todavía no. (Not yet.):
Quieres salir? Do you want to leave?
 Todavía no.  Not yet.
" Ahora no. (Not now.):
żQuiere comer? Do you want to eat?
 Ahora no.  Not now.
" Ya no. (No longer.): Ya no estudio el espańol. (I m no longer
studying Spanish.)
" Ni yo tampoco.( Neither do I.):
Ella no quiere bailar. She doesn t want to dance.
 Ni yo tampoco.  Neither do I.
" No hay remedio. (It can t be helped.):
Tienes que esperar. You have to wait.
 No hay remedio.  It can t be helped.
" No obstante (Nevertheless/However/In spite of): Está nevando.
No obstante él va a trabajar. (It s snowing. Nevertheless he s going
to work.)
157
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 158
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
" No cabe duda. (There s no doubt.): No cabe duda que ella va a tener
éxito. (There s no doubt that she s going to succeed.)
PERO VERSUS SINO
Pero and sino both express  but. Pero is used in a more general sense
and may also mean  however :
No puedo telefonearle ahora, pero voy a telefonearle más tarde.
I can t call him now, but I ll call him later.
No tiene mucho dinero, pero está contento.
He doesn t have much money, but (however) he is happy.
Sino is only used after a negative statement to express a contrast (on the
contrary):
No canta mÅ›sica popular sino romántica.
He doesn t sing popular music, but he sings romantic music.
No compra el grande sino el pequeńo.
He doesn t buy the big one but (rather) the little one.
ANSWERING INFORMATION QUESTIONS
Certain key words and phrases will help you answer just about any ques-
tion that might arise. Note carefully how to present the correct informa-
tion for which you are being asked.
Answering Questions with żQué? and żCuál?
Answering questions with the interrogative adjective żqué? and with the
interrogative pronoun żcuál(es)? requires that you keep in mind the num-
ber and gender of the nouns to which they refer. Simply use a definite
article + an appropriate adjective that agrees in number and gender with
the noun referred to and you have a quick, easy answer.
To express  the . . . one(s) you must use an adjective as a noun. The
adjective must agree in number and gender with the noun it is describ-
ing. This is usually done with adjectives showing color (el blanco
the white one), size (las grandes the big ones), and nationality (la
espańola the Spanish one).
żCuáles camisas prefieres? Which (ones of the) shirts do you prefer?
żQué camisas prefieres? What shirts do you prefer?
158
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 159
"
1 2 : 0 0 A N S W E R I N G Q U E S T I O N S
Las azules. The blue ones.
Las pequeńas. The small ones.
Las espańolas. The Spanish ones.
żCuál de los carros quiere? Which one of the cars do you want?
żQué carro quiere? What car do you want?
El blanco. The white one.
El grande. The big one.
El espańol. The Spanish one.
Some answers to the most commonly asked questions should be at your
fingertips:
żCómo se (te) llama(s)? What s your name?
 Me llamo . . .  My name is . . .
żCuál es su (tu) dirección? What s your address?
 Mi dirección es . . .  My address is . . .
żCuál es su (tu) profesión? What s your profession?
 Soy . . .  I am . . .
żCuál es su (tu) nÅ›mero de What s your phone number?
teléfono?
 Mi nÅ›mero de teléfono es . . .  My phone number is . . .
żCuántos aÅ„os tiene(s)? How old are you?
 Tengo . . . ańos.  I am . . . years old.
Remember that when a or de (or any of their forms) is in the question,
a or de (or any of their forms) must appear in the answer:
żDe qué libro hablas? Which book are you talking about?
 De Don Quijote.  Don Quijote.
159
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 160
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
żA quiénes de sus amigas le To which of your friends have you written?
ha escrito?
 A María y a Juanita.  To Maria and Juanita.
Answering Questions with Interrogative Adverbs
Use the following guidelines to answer questions containing interroga-
tive adverbs:
" żCómo? (how) may be answered with a preposition (por, en, or a)
followed by a noun or an explanation:
żCómo vas a Madrid? How are you going to Spain?
 En tren.  By train.
żCómo te llamas? What s your name?
 Me llamo . . .  My name is . . .
żCómo estás? How are you?
 Muy bien.  Very good.
" żCuánto(a)(s) (How much, many) must be answered with a number
or a quantity:
żCuánto cuesta este CD? How much does this CD cost?
 Cien pesos.  A hundred pesos.
żCuánta carne quieres? How much meat do you want?
 Quinientos gramos.  Five hundred grams.
" A question with żCuándo? (when) is answered by giving a time or
an expression of time (see Chapter 16:00):
When do you want to leave? żCuándo quieres salir?
In fifteen minutes. En quince minutos.
At eight o clock. A las ocho.
Immediately. Inmediatamente.
" Answer a question with żdónde? by naming a place, using the
preposition en:
160
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 161
"
1 2 : 0 0 A N S W E R I N G Q U E S T I O N S
żDónde vives? Where do you live?
 Vivo en . . .  I live in . . .
" Answer a question with żadónde? by using the preposition
a (al, a los, a las):
żAdónde vas? Where are you going?
 Voy al banco.  I m going to the bank.
" Answer żde dónde? by using the preposition de (del, de la, de los)
+ place:
żDe dónde eres? Where are you from?
 Soy de . . .  I m from . . .
" Answer a question that asks żpor qué? (why) with porque (because)
and a reason:
żPor qué está atrasado? Why are you late?
 Porque perdí mi tren.  Because I missed my train.
" Answer a question with żquién? (who, whom), whether it is used as
a subject, direct object, or after a preposition, by naming a person:
żQuién habla? Who is speaking?
 Juan.  John.
żA quién busca? Whom are you looking for?
 A un vendedor.  A salesperson.
żCon quién quiere hablar? Whom do you want to speak with?
 Con la Seńora López.  With Mrs. Lopez.
" Answer żqué? with the name of a thing:
żQué se cayó? What fell?
 Mis gafas.  My glasses.
żQué busca Ud.? What are you looking for?
 Una pluma.  A pen.
161
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 162
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
żCon qué escribe Ud.? What are you writing with?
 Con un lápiz.  With a pencil.
When a preposition is used in a question, the same preposition must also
be used in the answer:
żPara quién trabajó? For whom did he work?
 Para su padre.  For his father.
ON THE PHONE
Having a phone conversation with a person speaking another language
is difficult at best. Without the help of body language, communication
can be a chore. Use the phrases presented below to provide and obtain
information on the phone.
Calling
SPANISH MEANING
A ver. (Colombia) hello
Hola. (Argentina) hello
Bueno. (Mexico) hello
Diga. (Spain) hello
Oigo. (Cuba) hello
Aló. hello
żEstá . . . ? Is . . . in (there)?
Es . . . It s . . .
żEstá en casa . . . ? Is . . . in (there)?
Habla . . . This is . . .
Quisiera hablar con . . . I would like to speak to . . .
żCuándo regresa? When will he (she) be back?
Llamo más tarde. I ll call back later.
No importa. It s (not) important.
Tengo que colgar. I have to hang up.
162
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 163
"
1 2 : 0 0 A N S W E R I N G Q U E S T I O N S
Answering
SPANISH MEANING
A ver. (Colombia) hello
Hola. (Argentina) hello
Bueno. (Mexico) hello
Diga. (Spain) hello
Oigo. (Cuba) hello
Aló. hello
żQuién habla? Who s calling?
No cuelgue. Hold on./Don t hang up.
Un momentito. Just a moment.
No está. He/She is not in.
żDesea Ud. dejar algśn recado? Do you want to leave a message?
Lo siento. No puedo entenderle. I m sorry, I can t understand you.
Un poco más alto, por favor. A little louder, please.
Siga . . . Escucho. Go on . . . I m listening.
Phone Problems
If you ve made a mistake or if you re having trouble getting connected,
or if there s trouble on the line, here are the phrases you will need to
explain the problem:
It s a mistake. Es un error.
I have the wrong number. Tengo el nśmero equivocado.
There s no answer. No contesta.
We got cut off (disconnected). Se nos cortó la línea.
The line is busy. La línea está ocupada.
Please redial the number. Marque (Ud.) de nuevo el nśmero,
por favor.
The telephone is out of order. El teléfono está fuera de servicio
(dańado, descompuesto).
163
13 (153-164) chapter 1200 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 164
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
There s no dial tone. No hay tono (seńal).
There s a lot of static on the line. Hay mucha estática.
We have a bad connection. Tenemos una comunicación mala.
I m sorry to have bothered you. Disculpe la molestia.
If you want to speak to an operator, say: El (la) operador(a), por favor.
TIME S UP!
Without looking in the lesson, see if you can answer these questions:
1. żNo quiere ir al cine esta noche? (say yes)
2. żTiene ganas de comer en un restaurante? (say no)
3. żUd. fuma? (say no)
4. żCómo se llama Ud.?
5. żDónde vive Ud.?
6. żCuál es su nÅ›mero de teléfono?
7. żCuántos aÅ„os tiene Ud.?
8. żCuánto cuesta un viaje a EspaÅ„a?
9. żCuáles películas populares prefiere Ud?
10. żQué hay en su escritorio (desk)?
164
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 165
Seeking Help
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Getting help anywhere
" At the post office
" At the hair salon
" At the dry cleaner s
" At the optician s
" At the camera store
" At the jeweler s
" Getting special services for
special needs
In this lesson you ll learn how to get all
the personal services you might need while
traveling in a Spanish-speaking country.
165
165
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 166
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
GETTING HELP ANYWHERE
Whether you are seeking certain services or are trying to have something
repaired, use the phrases below at the post office, the hair salon, the dry
cleaner, the shoemaker, the optometrist, the jeweler, or the camera store:
Can you help me, please? żPuede Ud. ayudarme, por favor?
I need . . . Necesito . . .
I m looking for . . . Busco . . .
Where is the nearest . . . ? żDónde está la . . . más cercana?
PLACE SPANISH
post office oficina de correos
hair salon peluquería
dry cleaner s tintorería
optician s óptica
jeweler s joyería
camera store tienda de fotografía
Do you have . . . ? żTiene Ud. . . . ?
Do you sell . . . ? żVende Ud. . . . ?
What time do you open? żA qué hora abre Ud.?
What time do you close? żA qué hora cierra Ud.?
What days are you open (closed)? żQué días abre (cierra) Ud.?
Can you fix . . . for me? żPuede Ud. arreglarme . . . ?
Can you fix it (them) today? żPuede Ud. arreglármelo/la (los/las) hoy?
May I have a receipt? żPuede darme un recibo?
Can you fix it (them) temporarily żPuede Ud. arreglármelo/la (los/las)
(while I wait)? temporalmente (mientras espero)?
How much does it cost? żCuánto cuesta?
AT THE POST OFFICE
If you travel to a foreign country, you will quite likely have to make a
stop or two at a post office to purchase stamps or to send packages. Use
the following table for the postal phrases you will need.
166
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 167
"
1 1 : 0 0 S E E K I N G H E L P
TERM SPANISH
address la dirección
envelope el sobre
letter la carta
to mail (send) mandar por correo
mailbox el buzón
package el paquete
postage el franqueo
postal worker el cartero
rate la tarifa de franqueo
stamp el sello
Special forms, paperwork, and postal rates apply to different types of
letters and packages. If you need to send something C.O.D., you will be
sending it contra reembolso. Use the phrases below to get the type of
service you require: żCuál es la tarifa de franqueo de . . . a los Estados
Unidos? (What is the postal rate of . . . to the United States?)
an airmail letter una carta por correo aéreo
a registered letter una carta certificada
a special delivery letter una carta urgente
Use the preposition por (as opposed to para) to explain how you would
like to send a letter or package: Quisiera mandar esta carta por correo . . .
(I would like to send this letter by . . . mail.)
regular regular
air aéreo
special delivery urgente
How much do these żCuánto cuestan estos sellos?
stamps cost?
AT THE HAIR SALON
Men and women alike have to look for a sign that says peluquero(a) for
a hairdresser. Un salón de belleza indicates a beauty parlor. To express
what you need, say: Quisiera . . . por favor. (I would like . . . please.) fol-
lowed by these words:
167
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 168
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
SERVICE SPANISH SERVICE SPANISH
a coloring un tinte (vegetal) a pedicure una pedicura
a haircut un corte de pelo a permanent una permanente
a manicure una manicura a shampoo un champÅ›
To say how you would like your hair, use the phrase Quisiera tener el
cabello . . . (I would like to have my hair . . .) with the words listed here:
long largo straight lacio (liso)
medium mediano auburn rojizo
short corto black negro
wavy ondulado blond rubio
curly rizado brunette castańo
If you would like to be a redhead, you would say: Quisiera ser pelirrojo(a).
AT THE DRY CLEANER S
Should you have a problem with your clothing, explain what services
you need: żPuede Ud. . . . (este/esta/estos/estas) . . . por favor? (Can you
. . . [this, these . . . ] please?)
dry clean lavar en seco remove quitar
mend remendarme sew coser
press plancharme starch almidonarme
Make sure to tell the dry cleaner if there s a problem: Hay . . . (There is
[are] . . . )
a hole un hoyo
a button missing un botón que falta
a loose button un botón flojo
a spot, stain una mancha
a tear un desgarrón
REPAIRS AND MORE REPAIRS
Use the verb remendar when referring to clothing or shoe repairs: żPor
favor, puede Ud. remendarme esta camisa (estos zapatos)? (Can you
please repair this shirt [these shoes] for me?)
168
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 169
"
1 1 : 0 0 S E E K I N G H E L P
Use the verb reparar when referring to equipment: żPor favor, puede
Ud. repararme este reloj? (Can you please repair this watch for me?)
AT THE OPTICIAN S
For those who depend upon glasses or contact lenses, a ripped lens or a
broken pair of glasses can ruin a vacation if proper measures aren t taken
immediately. Optical centers are available in all countries, but it helps to
know the proper vocabulary words, terms, questions, and expressions so
that you can have your problem solved as quickly as possible. One day
the following phrases may come in handy:
I have a problem with my . . . Tengo un problema con mis . . .
glasses lentes/gafas
contact lenses lentes de contacto
bifocals gafas bifocales
progressive lenses mis lentes progresivos
The lens (frame) is broken. El lente (el armazón) está roto.
My lens (contact) is torn. Mi lente de contacto está rasgado.
Can you replace it? żPuede Ud. darme otra?
AT THE CAMERA SHOP
The words and expressions listed below will be useful should you have
to make a trip to a camera store.
camera una cámara
video camera una videocámara
roll of film una película, un rollo
36 exposures de treinta y seis exposiciones
black and white en blanco y negro
color a color
Being Impulsive
Perhaps you just can t wait to get home to see if your pictures turned out
all right. Or maybe you met someone on your trip and want to give that
person a copy of a picture to be treasured forever as a souvenir of this
wonderful vacation. Off you go to the nearest camera or drug store, roll
169
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 170
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
of film in hand. If you want to have your film developed, say: Quisiera
que me revele este carrete (rollo) (inmediatamente). (I would like to have
this film developed [immediately].)
AT THE JEWELER S
It s always best to leave your expensive jewelry home, but if you take
something along and need a repair, or if you simply want to treat your-
self to something new, use the words in the table below to refer to the
specific items you are wearing, that you want repaired, or that you want
to buy.
JEWELRY SPANISH
bracelet la pulsera
earrings los aretes
necklace el collar
ring el anillo
engagement ring el anillo de compromiso
watch el reloj
To find out the price you would ask:
żCuánto cuesta? How much is it?
żCuánto vale? How much is it worth?
Sometimes an item of jewelry needs further description by naming the
stones it contains. The names of different jewels that might interest you
are listed here:
JEWEL SPANISH JEWEL SPANISH
diamond un diamante ruby un rubí
emerald una esmeralda sapphire un zafiro
pearls las perlas
If you are unsure about a stone or want its weight, you would ask:
żQué es esa piedra? What is that stone?
żDe cuántos quilates es? How many carats is it?
170
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 171
"
1 1 : 0 0 S E E K I N G H E L P
SPECIAL SERVICES AND NEEDS
When there s a problem, people can have special needs, whether it s
obtaining help in finding a lost item or dealing with physical challenges.
Refer to these sentences when you need help:
Ayśdeme por favor. Please help me.
Necesito un intérprete. I need an interpreter.
żDónde está la comisaría de policía? Where is the police station?
żDónde está la Embajada Americana? Where is the American Embassy?
He perdido . . . I ve lost . . .
ITEM SPANISH
my checkbook mi chequera
my documents mis documentos
my money mi dinero
my passport mi pasaporte
my traveler s checks mis cheques de viajero
my wallet mi cartera/mi billetera
For those who are physically challenged, the words below may prove
invaluable, along with the phrase: żDónde puedo conseguir . . . ? (Where
can I get . . . ?)
NEED SPANISH
cane un bastón
closed-captioned TV una sistema de subtitulación
hearing aid un aparato para sordos
wheelchair una silla de ruedas
These items can be purchased, rented from, or located by organizations
dedicated to the needs of the physically challenged. There are also many
pharmacies (farmacias) that specialize in the rental of medical appli-
ances el alquiler de aparatos médicos.
171
14 (165-172) chapter 1100 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 172
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
Ask the following without looking back at the lessons:
1. For help in general
2. What time a store opens
3. For a receipt
4. For the price of an airmail stamp
5. For a haircut
6. To have a suit dry-cleaned
7. If you can have your contact lens replaced
8. For a roll of 36-exposure film
9. To have your watch fixed
10. For the nearest police station
172
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 173
Expressing
Positive Opinions
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Making suggestions
" Going to the movies and watching
television
" Using demonstrative pronouns
" Using direct object nouns and pronouns
" Using indirect object pronouns
" Using gustar and other similar verbs
" Positioning object pronouns
" Using the subjunctive to express
emotions and feelings
In this lesson you ll learn how to invite
someone to participate in leisure activities
using direct and indirect object pronouns.
You ll also see how to express positive
opinions, feelings, and emotions with and
without the subjunctive.
173
173
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 174
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
MAKING SUGGESTIONS
Certain key phrases are readily available to you if you d like to suggest
an outing or an activity to someone. These phrases include indirect
object pronouns, which will be explained in greater depth later in this
chapter. For the phrases that follow, you only need to pay attention to
using the correct indirect object form for you. Note that the singular
polite forms are presented and the familiar forms are enclosed in brackets.
When you become more familiar with indirect object pronouns, you may
substitute the plural forms for you in any of these sentences. In each case,
the conjugated verb must be followed by an infinitive. For now, concen-
trate on committing these phrases to memory, because they are so useful
in a wide variety of situations.
Do(n t) you want to . . . ? ż(No) le (te) parece . . . ?
Are(n t) you interested in . . . ? ż(No) le (te) interesa . . . ?
Would(n t) it please you to . . . ? ż(No) le (te) gustaría . . . ?
Do(n t) you want to go to the ż(No) Le (Te) parece bien ir al campo?
country?
 Yes, I would.  Sí, me parece bien ir al campo.
Are(n t) you interested in going to ż(No) le (te) interesa ir al cine?
the movies?
 No, I m not interested.  No, no me interesa.
Would(n t) it please you to go out? ż(No) le (te) gustaría salir?
 Yes, it would.  Sí me gustaría salir.
LEISURE ACTIVITIES
Leisure activities play an important role in travel and tourism. The list
below gives a variety of popular attractions, events, and pastimes.
ACTIVITY SPANISH ACTIVITY SPANISH
ballet el ballet hike la caminata
beach la playa movies el cine
cards los naipes opera la ópera
concert el concierto party la fiesta
exhibit la exposición television la televisión
174
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 175
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
The Spanish language designates certain verbs to accompany certain
activities. Use the verb mirar to say that you watch la televisión. Use
jugar(ue) a + a definite article to say that you play games. Use dar with
una caminata to describe a hike. And use ir + a + a definite article with
other places listed.
Yo miro la televisión. I watch television.
Yo juego a los naipes. I play cards.
Yo doy una caminata. I go for a hike.
Yo voy al ballet. I go to the ballet.
To invite someone to go on a picnic say: żQuiere(s) hacer una gira al
campo? (Would you like to go on a picnic?)
Going to the Movies and Watching Television
The same types of themes (horror, adventure, mystery, comedy, drama,
romance) appear in films and on television. Use the words listed here
when you want to see or ask about a movie or program.
PROGRAM SPANISH
adventure film una película de aventura
cartoon los dibujos animados
comedy una comedia
drama un drama
game show un programa de concursos
horror movie una película de horror
love story una película de amor
news las noticias
police story una película policíaca
science-fiction una película de ciencia ficción
soap opera una telenovela
spy movie una película de espía
talk show un programa de entrevistas
weather el pronóstico del tiempo meteorológico
175
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 176
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
What s on TV? żQué hay en la televisión?
What film is showing? żQué película están pasando?
What program is playing? Qué programa están pasando?
What kind of film is it? żQué tipo de película es esa?
DEMONSTRATIVE PRONOUNS
Demonstrative pronouns (this [one], that [one], these, those) replace a
noun referring to a person, place, thing, or idea and may be used alone.
These pronouns must agree in number and gender with the nouns to
which they refer. Demonstrative pronouns are distinguished from
demonstrative adjectives by an accent mark.
Demonstrative Pronouns
MASCULINE FEMININE NEUTER MEANING
éste ésta esto this (one)
éstos éstas these
ése ésa eso that (one) [near]
ésos ésas those
aquél aquélla aquello that (one) [far]
aquéllos aquéllas those
Note the following about how to use demonstrative pronouns:
" Demonstrative pronouns can be distinguished from demonstrative
adjectives by their accented letter: este libro y ése (this book and
that one).
" Demonstrative pronouns agree in number and gender with the
nouns to which they refer:
I prefer this coat and those. Prefiero este abrigo y ésos.
I ll take this skirt and that one. Me llevo esta falda y aquélla.
" Demonstrative pronouns can be followed by the words aquí, ahí
(which indicates proximity to the the person spoken to), and
allá (which recognizes distance from the speaker and the person
spoken to):
176
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 177
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
these ones estos ahí
that one aquél allá
Which (pair of) pants do you żCuáles pantalones prefieres?
prefer?
These or those? żÉstos aquí o esos allá?
" The neuter forms, esto, eso, and aquello, are invariable because
they do not refer to specific nouns but to statements, ideas, and
understood nouns. These forms contain no accent as they have no
corresponding demonstrative adjectives.
He is late and that makes Él está atrasado y eso me enoja.
me angry.
What is this (that)? żQué es esto (eso, aquello)?
In a question asking about something unknown, such as the preceding
question, the neuter form of the pronoun is used until the noun is iden-
tified, after which the pronoun must correspond in number and gender
with the noun to which it refers.
Phrases using the definite articles el (la, los, las) + de, meaning  that
of or  the one of and el (la, los, las) + que, meaning  the one that,
are used as demonstrative pronouns.
El (La, Los, Las) de Marta es (son) importante(s).
The one(s) of Martha are important.
El (La, Los, Las) que está(n) aquí me interesa(n).
The one(s) that is (are) here interest(s) me.
El coche de Juan es distinto del de Julio, pero es muy parecido
al que tiene Roberto.
Juan s car is different from Julio s, but it is very similar to the
one Robert has.
The Former and the Latter
To express  the latter (the latest, the most recently mentioned), use éste
(ésta, éstos, éstas) and to express  the former (the most remotely men-
tioned), use aquél (aquélla, aquéllos, aquéllas).
In English, we usually speak about  the former and the latter. In
Spanish, the word order is reversed, and they refer to  the latter and the
former, which is often less confusing:
177
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 178
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
żQué piensas de estas gafas de sol grandes y de éstas pequeÅ„as?
What do you think of these large and small sunglasses?
Pienso que éstas (las pequeÅ„as) son más bonitas que aquéllas
(las grandes).
I think that these (the latter the small ones) are prettier than those
(the former the big ones).
OBJECT PRONOUNS
Object pronouns are used so that an object noun doesn t have to be con-
tinuously repeated. This allows for a more free-flowing conversational
tone. Object pronouns are classified as either direct or indirect. The fol-
lowing table lists the object pronouns.
DIRECT OBJECT PRONOUNS INDIRECT OBJECT PRONOUNS
Pronoun English Pronoun English
me me me (to) me
te you (familiar) te (to) you (familiar)
le him le (to) him, her, you, it
lo him, it, you
la her, it, you
se himself, herself, itself se (to) himself, herself, itself
nos us nos (to) us
os you (polite) os (to) you
los them, you les (to) them, you
las them, you
se themselves se (to) themselves
NOTE
1. The forms me, te, se, nos, and os are direct and indirect object
pronouns. They are also reflexive pronouns (see Chapter 18:00).
2. The direct object pronoun lo is preferred to le to express him or you
in Latin America.
Yo invito a Carlos. I invite Carlos.
Yo le invito. I invite him. (In Spain)
Yo lo invito. I invite him. (In Latin America)
178
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 179
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
Direct Object Pronouns
Direct objects (which can be nouns or pronouns) answer the question
whom or what the subject is acting upon and may refer to people, places,
things, or ideas. A direct object pronoun replaces a direct object noun.
TÅ› compras el libro. You buy the book.
TÅ› lo compras. You buy it.
Yo miro las películas. I watch the movies.
Yo las miro. I watch them.
Yo te quiero. I love you.
TÅ› me quieres. You love me.
Ud. nos ve. You see us.
Nosotros le vemos. We see you.
When using object pronouns, make sure that your conjugated verb
agrees with the subject and not the object pronoun.
The Personal A
The personal a has no meaning and merely indicates that the direct
object is a person. The personal a is only used before a direct object noun
(not before a pronoun) when the direct object is:
" A person or persons: Visito a mis amigos. (I visit my friends.)
" A pet: Cuido a su perro. (I watch her dog.)
" A pronoun referring to an indefinite person: żVes a alguien?
(Do you see anyone?)
The personal a is not used with the verb tener: Tengo muchos amigos.
(I have many friends.)
Indirect Object Pronouns
Indirect objects (which can be nouns or pronouns) answer the question
to or for whom the subject is doing something. Indirect objects only refer
to people. An indirect object pronoun replaces an indirect object noun
but is used in Spanish when the noun is mentioned. A key to the correct
usage of an indirect object pronoun is the preposition a (al, a la, a los, or
a las), which means  to or  for (unlike the personal a, which has no
meaning) followed by the name or reference to a person. Use a él, a ella,
or a Ud. to clearly differentiate to whom you are referring.
179
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 180
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Ella le escribe a Juan. She writes to John.
Ella le escribe (a él). She writes to him.
Él le habla a la muchacha. He speaks to the girl.
Él le habla (a ella). He speaks to her.
Ud. me compra un regalo. You buy a gift for me.
Yo le compro un regalo. I buy a gift for you.
Some Spanish constructions with direct and indirect object pronouns dif-
fer from the English:
" Verbs that take an indirect object in English do not necessarily take
an indirect object in Spanish. The following verbs take a direct
object in Spanish:
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
esperar to wait for llamar to call, name
buscar to look for pagar to pay for (something)
escuchar to listen to mirar to look at
esperar to hope for (to)
" Verbs that take a direct object in English do not necessarily take a
direct object in Spanish. These verbs take an indirect object in
Spanish because to or for is implied or because the verb is followed
by a:
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
contestar to answer pagar to pay ([to] someone)
dar to give pedir to ask
decir to tell preguntar to ask
escribir to write regalar to give a gift
explicar to explain telefonear to call (on the phone)
mandar to send
Gustar and Other Similar Verbs. Although gustar (to please, to like) is per-
haps the most common of the verbs using indirect objects, there are
many others, which are listed here:
180
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 181
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
agradar to please, to be importar to matter, care
pleased with
bastar to be enough interesar to interest
doler (ue) to be painful parecer to seem
encantar to adore quedar to remain, have left
faltar to lack, need tocar to be one s turn
Verbs requiring an indirect object follow these rules:
" The Spanish indirect object is the subject of the English sentence, so
using these verbs requires that you think backwards a bit:
Me gustan los libros. I like the books. (The books are pleasing
to me.)
Nos falta una pluma. We need a pen. (A pen is lacking to us.)
" Always use the third person singular form of gustar with an action
or actions:
Le gusta bailar y cantar. He likes to dance and sing. (Dancing
and singing are pleasing to him.)
" The indirect object pronoun may be preceded by the preposition
a + the corresponding prepositional pronoun mí, ti, él, ella, Ud.,
nosotros, vosotros, ellos, ellas, Uds. for stress or clarification:
A mí me parece imposible. It seems impossible to me.
A ellos les toca jugar. It is their turn to play.
" The indirect object noun generally precedes the indirect object
pronoun:
A Paco no le queda nada. Paco has nothing left.
A las nińas les gusta ir The girls like to go downtown.
al centro.
The Prepositions to, for, and from
The prepositions to, for, and from are not expressed in Spanish before
indirect object pronouns, and they may or may not be expressed in
English. Note that if one of these prepositions could be used, then an
indirect pronoun is called for.
181
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 182
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Me mostró su batería. He showed his drums to me.
(He showed me his drums.)
Le compré este libro. I bought this book for him.
(I bought him this book.)
Nos cobraron el dinero. They collected the money from us.
Position of Object Pronouns
Study the following rules for the placement of pronouns:
" Object pronouns, direct or indirect, including reflexive pronouns,
in simple and compound tenses, are placed before the verb:
Yo lo tomo. I take it.
Él no la ha visto. He hasn t seen her.
Nosotros nos We get up early.
levantamos temprano.
" With an affirmative command, the object pronoun follows the verb
and is attached to it. An accent mark is normally required on the
stressed vowel (count back three vowels and add the accent):
Affirmative: Cómpralo. Buy it.
But:
Negative: No lo compres. Don t buy it.
" With an infinitive or a gerund, the object pronoun may precede the
conjugated verb, or follow the infinitive or gerund and be attached
to it. When attached to the gerund, add the required accent on the
stressed vowel:
Lo quiero comprar. I want to buy it.
Quiero comprarlo.
Lo estoy haciendo. I m doing it.
Estoy haciéndolo.
Double Object Pronouns
More than one pronoun may be used in a sentence at a time. In Spanish,
unlike in English, the indirect object pronoun (usually a person) precedes
the direct object pronoun (usually a thing):
182
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 183
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
Él me lo describe. He describes it to me.
Ella te la da. She gives it to you.
Note the following:
" The indirect object pronouns le and les change to se before the direct
object pronouns lo, la, los, las: Yo se los leo. (I read them to you
[him, her].)
" The phrases a Ud./Uds., a él/ellos and a ella/ellas may be used to
clarify the meaning of se: Yo se la doy a ella (a Uds.). (I give it
to her [you].)
" The same rules for the position of single object pronouns apply for
double object pronouns:
Infinitive: Me lo quiere dar. He wants to give it to me.
Quiere dármelo.
Gerund: Me lo está dando. He s giving it to me.
Está dándomelo.
Affirmative command: Démelo. Give it to me.
Negative command: No me lo dé. Don t give it to me.
USING ACCENTS
When attaching two pronouns to an infinitive, the general rule of thumb
is to count back three vowels and then add an accent: Él va a com-
prármelo. (He is going to buy it for me.) When the pronouns are placed
before the conjugated verb, no accent is added: Él me lo va a comprar.
(He is going to buy it for me.)
When the affirmative command has more than one syllable, count
back four vowels and then add the accent: Dígamelo. (Tell it to me.) No
accent is added for the negative command: No me lo diga. (Don t tell it
to me.)
When the pronouns are attached to a present participle, count back
four vowels and add the accent: Élla está leyéndoselo. (She is reading it
to him [her].)
POSITIVE FEELINGS
An invitation can be extended using a direct object pronoun: żUd. quiere
(Tś quieres) acompańarme (nos) . . . ? (Would you like to acompany me
[us]?) To accept, use sí and one of the following phrases:
183
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 184
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
EXPRESSION SPANISH
Why not! ĄCómo no!
Gladly! Ä„Con mucho gusto!
Great! Ä„Magnífico!
I adore . . . Me encanta(n) . . .
I like . . . Me gusta(n) . . .
Of course. Claro.
Of course. Por supuesto.
OK. De acuerdo.
That would please me. Me gustaría.
What a good idea. Ä„Qué buena idea!
Why not? żPor qué no?
With pleasure. Con placer.
USING THE SUBJUNCTIVE TO EXPRESS
EMOTIONS AND FEELINGS
The subjunctive is used after verbs and expressions of feeling and emo-
tion, such as fear, joy, sorrow, and surprise. To express your feelings to
someone else, use this formula: subject pronoun + estar (conjugated)
+ adjective + (de) que + . . .The adjectives below will help you.
ADJECTIVE SPANISH ADJECTIVE SPANISH
afraid asustado(a) furious furioso(a)
angry enojado(a) happy alegre, feliz
delighted encantado(a) proud orgulloso(a)
displeased enfadado(a) sad triste
embarrassed avergonzado(a) unhappy infeliz
Ella está alegre de que Uds. She is happy that you will accept
acepten su invitación. her invitation.
Estoy triste que ellos no vengan. I m sad that they aren t coming.
184
15 (173-186) chapter 1000 8/1/03 10:37 AM Page 185
"
1 0 : 0 0 E X P R E S S I N G P O S I T I V E O P I N I O N S
Conjugate tener with the following nouns when you want to express
feelings and emotions:
miedo de fear (of)
vergüenza de shame (of)
Tengo miedo de que él no diga I m afraid that he won t
la verdad. tell the truth.
The following reflexive verbs may be conjugated and used with the
subjunctive:
VERB MEANING
enojarse to become angry
enfadarse to become angry
alegrarse (de) to rejoice, be happy
Me alegro de que hagas el viaje I am happy that you are taking
a Francia. a trip to France.
TIME S UP!
1. Ask a friend if he wants to go to the beach.
2. Ask what s on television.
3. Ask what kind of film is playing.
4. Say you d like to see a comedy.
5. Invite someone to have a picnic in the country.
6. Say:  I love you.
7. Say that the gifts please you.
8. Say:  I need a pen.
9. Say:  Show it to me, please.
10. Express a positive feeling about a play you saw.
185
This page intentionally left blank.
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 187
Planning Outdoor
Activities
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Engaging in sports
" Playing the game
" Describing the weather
" Expressing negative opinions and
indifference
" Using the subjunctive with expressions
of doubt and after impersonal
expressions
In this lesson you ll learn how to talk
about sports and the weather. You ll also
learn how to express your dissatisfaction
or indifference toward various activities by
using the subjunctive and relative pronouns.
187
187
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 188
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
SPORTS
Because sports are popular around the world, the sports listed below
might be of interest to you.
The verbs hacer and jugar + a + definite article are commonly used to
describe participation in a sport. In the list of sports, a 1 indicates that
you should use the verb hacer, while a 2 indicates that you use jugar. All
other verbs in the chart are listed beneath the name of the sport.
SPORT SPANISH
aerobics los ejercicios aeróbicos1
baseball el béisbol2
basketball el baloncesto2/el básquetbol2
bicycling montar a bicicleta
cycling el ciclismo1
fishing ir de pesca
football el fśtbol americano2
golf el golf2
ice skating patinar
roller skating patinar
skiing esquiar
soccer el fśtbol2
swimming la natación1/nadar
tennis el tenis2
Engaging in Sports
When speaking about sports, one might say:
Let s play a game of . . . Let s have a . . . match.
Vamos a jugar a . . . Hagamos un partido de . . .
Vamos a jugar al fśtbol. Hagamos un partido de tenis.
Once you ve determined the sport in which you want to engage, refer to
the words below to select the appropriate playing field.
188
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 189
"
0 9 : 0 0 P L A N N I N G O U T D O O R A C T I V I T I E S
FIELD SPANISH
beach la playa
course (golf) el campo (de golf)
court la cancha
field el campo
gymnasium el gimnasio
ocean el océano
park el parque
pool la piscina
stadium el estadio
track la pista
Let s go to the gym. Vamos al gimnasio.
It s also important to make sure you have the appropriate and necessary
equipment as listed below. Use these phrases to get you started.
I need . . . I need . . . Could you lend (rent) me . . .
Me falta(n) . . . Necesito . . . Podrías prestarme (alquilarme) . . .
EQUIPMENT SPANISH
ball la pelota
ball (basketball) el balón
bat el bate
bathing suit el traje de bańo
bicycle la bicicleta
boat el barco
fishing rod la cańa de pesca
golf clubs los palos de golf
helmet el casco
jogging shoes los tenis
skates los patines
ski bindings las ataduras
skis los esquís
189
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 190
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
THE WEATHER
In order to participate in any sport or outdoor activity, favorable weather
conditions should prevail. The expressions in the table below will help
you determine whether el pronóstico (the forecast) is encouraging: żQué
tiempo hace? (What s the weather?)
The third person singular of the verb hacer hace is used to express
many weather conditions. Hay is used to express visible conditions.
WEATHER SPANISH
It s beautiful. Hace bien tiempo.
It s cloudy. Está nublado.
It s cold. Hace frío.
It s foggy. Hay niebla.
It s hot. Hace calor.
It s humid. Hay humedad.
It s overcast. Está cubierto.
It s pouring. Hay lluvias torrenciales.
It s raining. Llueve.
It s snowing. Está nevando.
It s sunny. Hay sol.
What s the Temperature?
If you want to know the temperature, keep in mind that in Europe and
Latin America the Centigrade (Celsius) thermometer is used.
To convert Fahrenheit to Centigrade, subtract thirty-two from the
Fahrenheit temperature and multiply the remaining number by 5D 9. This
will give you the temperature in degrees Centigrade.
To convert Centigrade to Fahrenheit, multiply the Centigrade temper-
ature by 9D 5, then add thirty-two. This will give you the temperature in
degrees Fahrenheit.
Some questions and answers you will need in order to express the tem-
perature are:
What s the temperature? żCuál es la temperatura?
It s ten below. Hay una temperatura de diez grados bajo cero.
It s zero. Hay una temperatura de cero grados.
It s seventy degrees. Hay una temperatura de setenta grados.
190
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 191
"
0 9 : 0 0 P L A N N I N G O U T D O O R A C T I V I T I E S
NOTE
Use hacer to express weather conditions: Hace calor. (It s hot weather.)
Use tener to express physical conditions of a person: Tiene calor.
(He is hot.)
EXPRESSING NEGATIVE OPINIONS
An invitation, whether made in the affirmative or negative, might elicit
a negative response. Use the phrases listed here to decline an invitation:
Don t you want to come żNo quiere(s) ir conmigo (con nosotros)?
with me (us)?
EXPRESSION SPANISH
I hate . . . Odio . . .
I don t like . . . No me gusta . . .
I m not a fan of . . . No soy aficionado(a) a . . .
I m sorry but . . . Lo siento pero . . .
It s too difficult. Es demasiado difícil.
That doesn t interest me. No me interesa.
Why? żPor qué?
You ve got to be kidding! Ä„Qué va!
EXPRESSING INDIFFERENCE
If you ve been invited out and are indifferent or indecisive about whether
to go or not, use one of the expressions below.
EXPRESSION SPANISH
I don t care. No me importa.
I doubt it. Lo dudo.
I really don t know. No sé.
It depends. Depende.
It doesn t matter. Me da igual.
It s the same to me. Me da lo mismo.
Perhaps./Maybe. Quizás./Tal vez.
Whatever you want. Como quiera(s).
191
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 192
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
USING THE SUBJUNCTIVE WITH
EXPRESSIONS OF DOUBT
The subjunctive is used after verbs and expressions of doubt, denial,
disbelief, and probability. The indicative (simple and compound tenses)
is used after verbs and expressions of certainty. When certain verbs and
expressions are used in the negative or the interrogative, they imply
uncertainty or doubt and the subjunctive is required. When doubt is
negated, certainty or probability exists and the indicative is used.
No pienso que ella pueda venir. I don t think she can come.
No dudo que él nos acompaÅ„ará. I don t doubt that he will accompany us.
Él sabe que tÅ› irás al partido. He knows you will go to the game.
Note that all of the following expressions are followed by que and
another clause.
INDICATIVE (CERTAINTY)SUBJUNCTIVE (UNCERTAINTY)
Spanish English Spanish English
yo creo I believe yo no creo I don t believe
żCree Do you
Ud. . . . ? believe . . . ?
yo estoy I m sure yo no estoy I m not sure
seguro(a) seguro(a)
yo no dudo I don t doubt yo dudo I doubt
yo no niego I don t deny yo niego I deny
yo opino I m of the yo no opino I m not of
opinion the opinion
yo pienso I think yo no pienso I don t think
żPiensa Do you
Ud . . . ? think . . .?
yo sé I know yo no sé I don t know
USING THE SUBJUNCTIVE AFTER
IMPERSONAL EXPRESSIONS
The subjunctive is also used after the impersonal expressions that show
doubt, emotion, or opinion. The following expressions can be used to
state either positive or negative feelings and can also be used to persuade
someone to follow a course of action.
192
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 193
"
0 9 : 0 0 P L A N N I N G O U T D O O R A C T I V I T I E S
EXPRESSION SPANISH
it s a pity es una lástima
it could be puede ser
it s curious es curioso
it s doubtful es dudoso
it s enough es suficiente
it s fair es justo
it s good es bueno
it s impossible es imposible
it s incredible es increíble
it s interesting es interesante
it s nice es bueno
it s normal es normal
it s possible es posible
it s strange es extrańo
it s surprising es sorprendente
it s unfair es injusto
it seems parece
Note that these expressions take the subjunctive even when preceded
by no:
It is not surprising that you will No es sorprendiente que Ud. nos
accompany us. acompańe.
It is not probable that he wants No es probable que él quiera salir.
to go out.
The following impersonal expressions show certainty and, therefore,
require the indicative:
SPANISH MEANING SPANISH MEANING
es cierto it is certain, sure es exacto it is exact
es claro it is clear es seguro it is sure
es evidente it is evident es verdad it is true
193
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 194
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Es claro que ella vendrá. It s clear that she will come.
But:
No es claro que ella venga. It s not clear that she will come.
CONTRARY-TO-FACT CONDITIONS
A contrary-to-fact condition expresses what would have happened had
circumstances been different from what they currently are. In other
words, you are talking about a hypothetical situation. The conditional
mood expresses what would happen and the si clause, using a verb in the
imperfect subjunctive, expresses if something else occurred: Yo estaría
contenta si tś aceptaras la invitación. (I would be happy if you accepted
the invitation.) (See Chapter 20:00 for more on si clauses.)
SEQUENCE OF TENSES OF THE SUBJUNCTIVE
The tense (time frame) of the subjunctive in a dependent clause depends
on the tense of the verb used in the main clause. Always keep in mind the
time to which you are referring when choosing the tenses to use. For
example, look at the chart below. If the main clause is in the present, you
may use either the present or perfect subjunctive in the dependent clause,
depending on the meaning you wish to convey. If, however, the verb in
the main clause is in the preterite, you may only use either the imperfect
or pluperfect subjunctive. Use the following chart to help pick the cor-
rect tense of the subjunctive.
MAIN CLAUSE DEPENDENT CLAUSE
present present subjunctive
present perfect OR
future perfect subjunctive
command
que
imperfect imperfect subjunctive
preterite OR
conditional pluperfect subjunctive
pluperfect
194
16 (187-196) chapter 0900 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 195
"
0 9 : 0 0 P L A N N I N G O U T D O O R A C T I V I T I E S
TIME S UP!
1. Invite someone to go swimming.
2. Ask someone if he/she plays golf.
3. Suggest that someone play tennis with you.
4. Say you need skates.
5. Ask someone if they could lend you a bicycle.
6. Ask someone for today s weather.
7. Give a simplified version of today s weather forecast in Spanish.
Make sure to include the temperature.
8. Say that you don t like to play tennis because it s too difficult.
9. Say that you doubt that your friend will play basketball.
10. Say that you are sure that the weather will be nice.
195
This page intentionally left blank.
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 197
Making
Comparisons
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Making comparisons of inequality
" Comparing adjectives
" Comparing adverbs
" Comparing nouns
" Making comparisons of equality
In this lesson you ll learn how to make
comparisons of inequality using adjectives,
adverbs, and nouns. You ll also learn how
to use these words to make statements
showing equality.
197
197
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 198
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
ANIMALS
Animals are compared all the time for their prowess, their size, their
speed, their intelligence, and their good and bad traits. The list below
gives the names of animals commonly used in comparisons:
ANIMAL SPANISH ANIMAL SPANISH
bird el ave, el pájaro giraffe la jirafa
bull el toro horse el caballo
cat el gato leopard el leopardo
cheetah el guepardo lion el león
chicken, hen la gallina monkey el mono
cow la vaca pig el cochino
dog el perro rabbit el conejo
elephant el elefante tiger el tigre
fish el pez whale la ballena
fox el zorro
IN THE CLASSROOM
In a classroom setting, students are constantly comparing grades, teachers,
classes, class requirements, and homework assignments. Teachers also
have a habit of comparing their students. The following list will give you
the vocabulary you need to make classroom comparisons.
ITEM SPANISH ITEM SPANISH
backpack la mochila homework la tarea
board la pizarra principal el director
book el libro pupil el (la) estudiante
chalk la tiza school la escuela
classroom la sala de clase teacher el profesor
desk el escritorio test el examen,
la prueba
grade la nota textbook el libro de texto
grammar la gramática university la universidad
198
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 199
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
NOTE
In Spanish there is a distinction between the terms for course and
subject. El curso has more of a connotation of an individual lesson,
while la materia refers to the discipline of the subject itself:
Da un curso de espańol. He gives Spanish lessons.
El espaÅ„ol es una materia fácil. Spanish is an easy subject.
By the end of this chapter you will be able to compare the subjects listed
here:
SUBJECT SPANISH SUBJECT SPANISH
art el arte geography la geografía
biology la biología history la historia
chemistry la química mathematics las matemáticas
English el inglés music la mÅ›sica
French el francés science la ciencia
COMPARISONS OF INEQUALITY
Comparisons of inequality show that two things are not equal. These
comparisons have three forms:
" The positive states the fact:
Adjective: Spanish is easy.
Adverb: A tiger runs quickly.
Noun: I make mistakes.
" The comparative states more or less:
Adjective: Spanish is easier than math. Math is harder than history.
Adverb: A tiger runs more quickly than a turtle. A tiger runs less
quickly than a cheetah.
Noun: I make more mistakes than Robert. I make fewer
mistakes than Maria.
" The superlative states the most or the least:
Adjective: Spanish is the easiest. Math is the hardest.
Adverb: A turtle runs the slowest of all animals. A cheetah runs
the fastest of all animals.
199
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 200
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Noun: Maria makes the most mistakes of anyone. Robert makes
the fewest mistakes of anyone.
Most comparatives in English end in -er or use the word less or more.
Most superlatives in English end in -est or use the word least or most.
El tigre es grande. The tiger is big.
El caballo es más grande. The horse is bigger.
El elefante es el más grande. The elephant is the biggest.
Comparison of Adjectives
Adjectives are compared as follows:
" Positive: interesante (interesting): El espańol es interesante. (Spanish
is interesting.)
" Comparative: menos interesante (less interesting), más interesante
(more interesting):
Las matemáticas son menos Math is less interesting than
interesantes que la historia. history.
El espaÅ„ol es más interesante Spanish is more interesting than
que la historia. history.
" Superlative: el (la/los/las) menos interesante(s) (the least interesting),
el (la/los/las) más interesante(s) (the most interesting):
Las matemáticas son las Math is the least interesting.
menos interesantes.
El espaÅ„ol es el más Spanish is the most interesting.
interesante.
A few adjectives have irregular comparatives and superlatives:
POSITIVE COMPARATIVE SUPERLATIVE
bueno(a)(s) mejor(es) el/la (los/las) mejor(es)
good better (the) best
malo(a)(s) peor(es) el/la (los/las) peores
bad worse (the) worst
pequeÅ„o(a)(s) más pequeÅ„o(a)(s) el/la (los/las) más pequeÅ„o(a)(s)
small smaller (size) the smallest (size)
200
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 201
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
pequeńo(a)(s) menor(es) el/la (los/las) menor(es)
small lesser, younger the least, the youngest
grande(s) más grande(s) el/la (los/las) más grande(s)
big bigger biggest
grande(s) mayor(es) el/la (los/las) mayor(es)
great greater, older the greatest, the oldest
El perro es el mejor amigo del hombre. A dog is man s best friend.
Sus notas son peores que las mías. His grades are worse than mine.
Él es más pequeÅ„o que su hermano. He is smaller than his brother.
Es el hermano menor. He is the youngest brother.
Es la casa más grande. It s the biggest house.
Es el mayor de la familia. He is the oldest in the family.
In order to form the comparative and superlative of adjectives correctly,
take note of the following rules:
" In the comparative, use adjectives to compare two or more things
in one sentence and introduce the second element with que (than):
El espaÅ„ol es más interesante Spanish is more interesting than
que la historia. history.
El tigre es menos grande The tiger is shorter (less big) than
que el elefante. the elephant.
" The second element of the comparison may be a noun, a subject
pronoun, a possessive pronoun, an adjective, an adverb, or a clause:
Noun: La biología es más fácil que la física.
(Biology is easier than physics.)
Subject Pronoun: Ella es más baja que yo.
(She is shorter than I.)
Possessive Pronoun: Su perro es más grande que el mío.
(His dog is bigger than mine.)
Adjective: Ellos son más dotados que inteligentes.
(They are more gifted than intelligent.)
201
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 202
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Adverb: Estudió más que antes.
(He studied more than before.)
Clause: Ellas son más importantes de lo que yo pensaba.
(They are more important than I thought.)
" Comparative and superlative adjectives agree in number and gender
with the nouns they modify:
Una vaca es menos feroz A cow is less ferocious than a tiger.
que un tigre.
Los profesores son más Teachers are more intelligent
inteligentes que los alumnos. than students.
" To express  in or  of in a superlative sentence, use the preposi-
tion de + definite article: La jirafa es el animal más alta del mundo.
(The giraffe is the tallest animal in the world.)
" In a superlative sentence, you may place the noun between the arti-
cle (el/la/los/las) and the adjective: Es el perro más precioso de
todos. (It s the most beautiful dog of all.)
" Mejor and peor generally precede the noun, whereas mayor and
menor generally follow the noun (when comparing differences
in age):
mi mejor amigo my best friend
las peores películas the worst films
mi hermana mayor my older sister
su hermano menor his younger brother
But:
de mayor importancia of more importance
The antonyms (opposites) in the following chart should help you when
making comparisons using adjectives.
ADJECTIVE ANTONYM
Spanish English Spanish English
ancho wide estrecho narrow
antiguo old moderno modern
bajo low alto high
202
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 203
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
caliente hot frío cold
contento happy triste unhappy
corto short largo long
fácil easy difícil hard
fuerte strong débil weak
grande big pequeńo little
guapo handsome feo ugly
limpio clean sucio dirty
pobre poor rico rich
viejo old nuevo new
Comparison of Adverbs
Adverbs are compared as follows:
" Positive: rápidamente (quickly): Los perros corren rápidamente.
(Dogs run quickly.)
" Comparative: menos rápidamente (less quickly), más rápidamente
(more quickly):
Los perros corren menos rápidamente que los caballos.
Dogs run slower (less quickly) than horses.
Los guepardos corren más rápidamente que los caballos.
Cheetahs run faster than horses.
" Superlative: menos rápidamente (the least quickly), más rápidamente
(the most quickly):
Los guepardos son los que corren más rápidamente.
Cheetahs are the ones that run the fastest.
Los perros son los que corren menos rápidamente.
Dogs are the ones that run the slowest.
Because there is no distinction between the comparative and superlative
forms of adverbs, use que to express  than in the comparative:
203
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 204
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Los guepardos corren más rápidamente que los perros.
Cheetahs run faster than dogs.
Los perros corren menos rápidamente que los guepardos.
Dogs run slower than cheetahs.
In order to form the comparative and superlative of adverbs correctly,
take note of the following rules:
" In the comparative, use adverbs to compare two or more things in
one sentence and introduce the second element with que (than):
Los perros corren menos rápidamente que los caballos.
Dogs run slower than horses.
Los tigres corren más rápidamente que los gatos.
Tigers run faster than cats.
" In an affirmative sentence, de (than) replaces que before a number:
Gané más (menos) de cien dólares.
I earned more (less) than a hundred dollars.
But:
No gané más que cien dólares.
I didn t earn more than a hundred dollars.
" The second element of the comparison may be a noun, a subject
pronoun, a possessive pronoun, an adverb, or a clause:
Noun: Los gatos juegan más silenciosamente que los leones.
(Cats play more quietly than lions.)
Subject Pronoun: Ella habla más rápidamente que yo.
(She speaks more quickly than I.)
Possessive Pronoun: Su perro corre más rápidamente que el mío.
(Her dog runs faster than mine.)
Adverb: Él trabaja más rápidamente que bien.
(He is working more quickly than well.)
Clause: Los guepardos corren más rápidamente de lo que yo pensaba.
(Cheetahs run faster than I thought.)
204
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 205
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
" If the second clause in a comparison has a different verb, use de
together with a form of the article (el, la, los, las) when necessary:
Yo compré más libros de los que Ud. me recomendó. (I bought
more books than you recommended.)
" To express  in or  of in a superlative sentence, use the preposi-
tion de + definite article: Los guepardos son los animales que corren
más rápidamente de todos los animales. (Cheetahs are the animals
that run the fastest of all animals.)
Comparison of Nouns
Nouns are compared in the same way as adjectives and adverbs:
" Comparative: menos que (fewer [than]), más que (more [than]):
Tengo menos materias que Ud.
I have fewer subjects than you.
Un perro come más carne que legumbres.
A dog eats more meat than vegetables.
" Superlative: lo menos (the least), lo más (the most):
Hace lo menos posible de la clase.
She does the least possible in the class.
Haces lo más errores posibles de todos los alumnos
You make the most possible mistakes of all the students.
To form the comparative and superlative of nouns correctly, take note of
the following rules:
" In the comparative, use nouns to compare two or more things in one
sentence and introduce the second element with que (than):
Tengo menos tareas que tÅ›. I have less homework than you.
Tienes más trabajo que yo. You have more work than I (do).
" The second element of the comparison may be a noun, a subject
pronoun, a possessive pronoun, or a clause:
Noun: Tengo mejores notas que esos alumnos.
(I have better grades than those students.)
Subject Pronoun: Tiene más libros que yo.
(He has more books than I.)
205
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 206
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Possessive Pronoun: Mi clase tiene más alumnos que la tuya.
(My class has more students than yours.)
Clause: Una jirafa come más hierba de lo que yo pensaba.
(A giraffe eats more grass than I thought.)
" To express  in or  of in a superlative sentence, use the preposi-
tion de + definite article: Hace lo más trabajo posible de todos los
profesores. (He does the most possible work of all the teachers.)
Comparison of Verbs
When comparing infinitives of verbs, use que + an infinitive in the
second part of the comparison:
Prefiero ir al cine que ir al teatro.
I prefer going to the theater rather than to the movies.
Me gustaría más comer pescado que comer carne.
I d rather eat fish than meat.
COMPARISONS OF EQUALITY
Comparisons of equality show that two things are the same. Follow
these simple formulas:
" Tan + adjective or adverb + como (as . . . as):
Ella es tan inteligente como su hermano.
She is as intelligent as her brother.
Hablo espańol tan elocuentemente como tś.
I speak Spanish as eloquently as you.
" Tanto(-a, -os, -as) [used as an adjective] + noun + como (as
much/many . . . as). Tanto remains invariable when used
as an adverb.
Él tiene tantos amigos como tÅ›.
He has as many friends as you.
No tengo tanta paciencia como mi esposo.
I don t have as much patience as my husband.
206
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 207
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
Ella lee tanto como su hermano y yo.
She reads as much as her brother and I (do).
THE ABSOLUTE SUPERLATIVE
Use the absolute superlative when no comparison is involved. Simply add
-ísimo, -ísima, ísimos, ísimas to the adjective according to the gender
(masculine or feminine) and number (singular or plural) of the noun
being described. The meaning is the same as muy + adjective:
La blusa es muy cara. The blouse is very expensive.
La blusa es carísima.
Los perros son muy lindos. The dogs are very sweet.
Los perros son lindísimos.
Note the following exceptions to the rule:
" To express  very much use muchísimo:
Lo quiero mucho. I love him a lot.
Lo quiero muchísimo.
" Drop the final vowel of an adjective before adding -ísimo:
La casa es muy grande. The house is very big.
La casa es grandísima.
" Adjectives ending in -co (-ca for feminine adjectives), -go (-ga for
feminine adjectives), or -z change c to qu, g to gu, and z to c before
adding -ísimo:
La limonada es muy fresca. The lemonade is very fresh.
La limonada es fresquísima.
Las avenidas son muy largas. The streets are very long.
Las avenidas son larguísimas.
El tigre es muy feroz. The tiger is very fierce.
El tigre es ferocísimo.
207
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 208
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
An adverb may be formed by adding -mente to the feminine form
(-ísima) of the adjective:
Ella canta muy lentamente. She sings very slowly.
Ella canta lentísimamente.
COMPARATIVE AND SUPERLATIVE EXPRESSIONS
The following comparative and superlative expressions will help you
speak more colloquially:
" hacer lo mejor que puede (to do one s best): Hacemos lo mejor que
podemos. (We do our best.)
" hacer lo más (menos) posible (as much [little] as possible): Este
muchacho hace lo más posible. (This boy does as much as possible.)
" lo más (menos) . . . posible (as . . . as possible): Ella trabaja lo
menos rápidamente posible. (She works as slowly as possible.)
" cuanto más . . . más (the more . . . the more): Cuanto más come,
más quiere. (The more you eat, the more you want.)
" cuanto menos . . . menos (the less . . . the less): Cuanto menos
estudia, menos aprende. (The less you study, the less you learn.)
" cuanto más . . . menos (the more . . . the less): Cuanto más come,
menos tiene hambre. (The more you eat, the less hungry you are.)
" cada vez más (more and more): Aprendes cada vez más rápidamente.
(You learn more and more quickly.)
" cada vez menos (less and less): Los alumnos descansan cada vez
menos. (The students rest less and less.)
THE SUBJUNCTIVE AFTER
SUPERLATIVE EXPRESSIONS
Use the subjunctive after superlative expressions to show an opinion,
a feeling, or an emotion:
El espańol es la mejor lengua (indicative) que Ud. pueda estudiar
(subjunctive).
Spanish is the best language you can study.
Sé que este mapa es el peor (indicative) que se venda (subjunctive).
I know that this map is the worst that they sell.
208
17 (197-210) chapter 0800 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 209
"
0 8 : 0 0 M A K I N G C O M P A R I S O N S
Use the indicative after a superlative to state a fact when no opinion on
the part of the speaker is involved. The indicative is also used after the
superlative of an adverb:
Es su mejor amiga que llamó. It s his best friend who called.
Corre lo más rápidamente que puede. He is running as fast as he can.
TIME S UP!
1. Compare two animals.
2. Compare two classroom subjects.
3. Compare two people using adjectives.
4. Use the superlative to describe a person you know.
5. Compare the way in which two people do things using adverbs.
6. Use the superlative to say what someone does best.
7. Say that you have more work than I.
8. Make a comparison of equality between you and a family member.
9. Say that you have as much patience as your friend.
10. Use the subjunctive to say that you think this is the best book
you can buy.
209
This page intentionally left blank.
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 211
Meeting Your
Needs on the
Road and
Elsewhere
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Acquiring hotel accommodations
" Using the subjunctive
" Using relative pronouns
In this lesson you ll learn much about
selecting the proper accommodations and
getting the facilities and services you
require. You ll also learn more about the
subjunctive, and how to make exclamations
and use relative pronouns.
211
211
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 212
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
HOTEL ACCOMMODATIONS AND AMENITIES
The following is a list of the amenities you may desire when staying in a
hotel. Start with the question: żHay . . . ? (Is [Are] there . . . ?)
AMENITY SPANISH
air conditioning el aire acondicionado
a doorman un portero
an elevator un ascensor
a laundry service una lavandería
a maid service el servicio de limpieza
rooms for the disabled habitaciones equipadas para los minusválidos
a swimming pool una piscina
television la televisión
tennis courts canchas de tenis
valet parking la atendencia del garaje
If you are traveling with a pet, you may be surprised to learn that animals
are accepted as family members in most hotel and restaurant establish-
ments. You may want to ask: żAcepta Ud. perros en el establecimiento?
(Do you accept dogs?)
Room Needs
When booking a room, if you have a preference as to view or location,
you can make your wishes known by saying the following: Quisiera una
habitación . . . (I would like to have a room . . . ):
with a balcony con balcón
with a garden con jardín
with a terrace con una terraza
on the courtyard que dé al patio
on the garden que dé al jardín
on the sea con vista al mar
If you ve found that you are missing something you need, use the words
and expressions that follow to get what you desire:
212
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 213
"
0 7 : 0 0 M E E T I N G Y O U R N E E D S O N T H E R O A D A N D E L S E W H E R E
I would like . . . Quisiera . . .
I need . . . Me falta(n) . . .
I need . . . Necesito . . .
a bar of soap una barra de jabón
a blanket una manta
a hair dryer un secador de cabello
hangers unas perchas
a pillow una almohada
a towel una toalla
toilet paper un rollo de papel higiénico
NOTE
Not all hotel rooms in Spanish-speaking countries have private bathroom
facilities. If that is what you want, ask the following: żTienen las
habitaciones bańo privado? (Do the rooms have private toilet facilities?)
EXCLAMATIONS
Exclamations can be used to give your positive or negative opinion about
something. Make sure to use an inverted exclamation point (Ä„) before the
exclamation and a regular one (!) after it. Use the adjectives below to
express your pleasure or displeasure by saying What a . . . ! or How
much/many . . . !
Ä„Qué . . . ! What (a) . . . ! How . . . !
Ä„Cuánto(a) . . . ! How much . . . !
Ä„Cuántos(as) . . . ! How many . . . !
Ä„Qué hotel! What a hotel!
Ä„Qué grande es! How large it is!
Ä„Cuántas ventanas tiene! How many windows it has!
To make an exclamation more emphatic, use más or tan before the adjec-
tive: Ä„Qué habitación tan (más) lujosa! (What a luxurious room!)
213
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 214
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
THE SUBJUNCTIVE IN
THIRD PERSON COMMANDS
Use the subjunctive in third person singular or plural commands:
Que entre él (ella). Let (Have) him (her) come in.
Que hablen ellos (ellas). Let (Have) them speak.
Que sean felices. May they be happy.
Ä„Viva el rey! Long live the king!
THE SUBJUNCTIVE AFTER CONJUNCTIONS
Use the subjunctive after certain conjunctions when uncertainty, doubt,
purpose, or anticipation is implied.
Conjunctions are words that connect and relate vocabulary words
and pronouns, as well as two clauses in a sentence. You use them repeat-
edly in speaking and writing. Conjunctions do not change their form to
indicate meaning.
You may use the subjunctive with the following conjunctions. Those
with an asterisk (*) always take the subjunctive, because doubt, uncer-
tainty, or purpose is implied:
" Conjunctions that express time:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
hasta que until
*antes (de) que before
Yo esperaré hasta que venga el portero.
I ll wait until the porter comes.
(Expresses doubt: he may not come.)
Yo esperé hasta que vino.
I waited until he came.
(Expresses certainty: he showed up.)
" Conjunctions that express purpose:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
a fin de que in order that
*para que in order that
de modo que so that
de manera que so that
214
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 215
"
0 7 : 0 0 M E E T I N G Y O U R N E E D S O N T H E R O A D A N D E L S E W H E R E
Yo saldré a fin de que la criada pueda limpiar la casa.
I ll leave so that the maid can clean the room.
(Expresses purpose: so that she may clean.)
" Conjunctions that express condition:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
*con tal (de) que provided that
*a menos que unless
*en caso de que in case (that)
*a condición (de) que on condition of
Me quedaré en este hotel con tal de que tengan una piscina.
I ll stay in this hotel provided that they have a pool.
(Expresses doubt: maybe there is a pool and maybe there isn t.)
" Conjunction that expresses concession:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
aunque although
Aceptaré esta habitación aunque sea pequeÅ„a.
I ll take this room although it may be small.
(Expresses doubt: maybe the room is small and maybe it isn t.)
Aceptaré esta habitación aunque es pequeÅ„a.
I ll take this room although it is small.
(Expresses certainty: the room is small.)
" Conjunction that expresses negation:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
*sin que without
El portero se fue sin que yo lo supiera.
The porter left without my knowing it.
(Expresses purpose: in such a way that I didn t notice.)
215
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 216
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
" Conjunction that expresses fear:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
por miedo (de) que for fear that
Telefoneo por miedo de que la criada no venga.
I m calling for fear that the maid isn t coming.
(Expresses emotion: shows fear)
The following conjunctions use the indicative to refer to past or present
actions or events, and the subjunctive to refer to future events that are
considered uncertain:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
así que as soon as
cuando when
después (de) que after
en cuanto as soon as
hasta que until
luego que as soon as
mientras que while
tan pronto como as soon as
Ella limpió su habitación mientras comían.
She cleaned their room while they ate.
But:
Ella limpiará su habitación mientras coman.
She will clean their room while they are (will be) eating.
Use the infinitive after these conjunctions when the subject does not
change:
CONJUNCTION MEANING
para in order to
porque because
sin without
antes de before
216
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 217
"
0 7 : 0 0 M E E T I N G Y O U R N E E D S O N T H E R O A D A N D E L S E W H E R E
Llamó para reservar una habitación. He called to reserve a room.
Salío sin decir nada. He left without saying anything.
Te telefonearé antes de salir. I ll call you before leaving.
THE SUBJUNCTIVE IN RELATIVE CLAUSES
Use the subjunctive in a relative clause if the antecedent (the person or
thing mentioned in the main clause) is indefinite, desired but not yet
found, or nonexistent (or whose existence is in doubt):
Busco un hotel que sea cómodo.
I m looking for a comfortable hotel.
żConoce Ud. a alguien que pueda ayudarme?
Do you know anyone who can help me?
No puedo encontrar a nadie que sepa ese nÅ›mero de teléfono.
I can t find anyone who knows that phone number.
But:
Conozco a alguien que puede ayudarle.
I know someone who can help you.
RELATIVE PRONOUNS
A relative pronoun (who, which, that) joins a main clause to a depend-
ent clause. This pronoun introduces the dependent clause that describes
someone or something mentioned in the main clause. The person or
thing the pronoun refers to is called the antecedent. A relative clause may
serve as a subject, a direct object, or an object of a preposition. The fol-
lowing list shows the relative pronouns in Spanish:
ANTECEDENT ANTECEDENT
Person Thing Clause/Idea
Subject que que lo que/lo cual
Direct object que que lo que/lo cual
Object of all a a
prepositions
de quien(es) de que
en en
con con
217
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 218
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Que
Que (who, whom, which, that), the most frequently used relative pro-
noun, is the subject or object of a relative clause and may refer to people
or things.
Es el hombre que ganó un premio.
He s the man who won a prize.
(antecedent = person = subject of relative clause)
Es el hotel que ganó un premio.
It s the hotel that won a prize.
(antecedent = thing = subject of relative clause)
Es un hombre que yo admiro.
He s a man I admire.
(antecedent = person = object of relative clause)
Es una pintura que yo admiro.
It s a painting I admire.
(antecedent = thing = object of relative clause)
Although frequently omitted in English, the relative pronoun is always
expressed in Spanish: Es un país que yo visito frecuentemente. (It s a
country [that] I visit often.)
Que and Quien (Objects of a Preposition)
Que (which, whom) is used as the object of a preposition referring
primarily to things: Es el hotel de que yo hablo. (That s the hotel about
which I am speaking.) Quien (whom) is used as the object of a preposi-
tion referring to people: Miguel es el muchacho con quien yo viajo.
(Michael is the boy with whom I am traveling.) Note that in both cases
the preposition precedes the relative pronoun quien or que.
Quien may be used in the following circumstances:
" Instead of que to introduce a clause not necessary to the meaning of
the sentence: Arturo, quien me ha escrito, quiere hablarme. (Arturo,
who wrote to me, wants to speak to me.)
" As a direct object. The personal a is required in a quien (whom),
which may replace que as the direct object in more formal style:
Son los hombres a quienes (que) yo vi esta mańana. (Those are the
men I saw this morning.)
218
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 219
"
0 7 : 0 0 M E E T I N G Y O U R N E E D S O N T H E R O A D A N D E L S E W H E R E
" As a subject to express  he (she, those, the one, the ones) who :
Quien trabaja mucho, gana mucho. (The one who works a lot, earns
a lot.)
NOTE
El (la, los, las) que may be used in place of quien as a subject:
El que trabaja mucho, gana mucho. (He who works a lot, earns a lot.)
El Cual and El Que
The longer forms of the relative pronouns, el cual (la cual, los cuales, las
cuales) and el que (la que, los que, las que), are used as follows:
" For clarity and emphasis when there are two antecedents:
El (la, los, las) que or el (la, los, las) cual(es) may be used to refer to
the latter (the one that is mentioned last):
La madre de Julio, el que (el cual) esta enfermo, le prepara sopa.
The mother of Julio, who is sick, prepares soup for him.
(Julio is sick.)
El (la, los, las) que or el (la, los, las) cual(es) can also be used to refer
to the former (the one that is mentioned first), especially when the two
antecedents are of the same gender:
La madre de Julio, la que (la cual) esta enferma, esta en cama.
Julio s mother, who is sick, is in bed.
(The mother is sick.)
El padre de Julio, el que (el cual) esta enfermo, esta en cama.
Julio s father, who is sick, is in bed.
(The father is sick.)
" After prepositions other than a, con, de, and en to refer to things:
Es la compaÅ„ía para la cual (la que) él trabaja. (It s the company for
which he works.)
Note that de + el = del before que and cual: Es el edificio delante del que
(del cual) él se cayó. (That s the building in front of which he fell.)
219
18 (211-220) chapter 0700 8/1/03 10:38 AM Page 220
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Lo Que and Lo Cual
The relative pronoun lo que (lo cual) is the neuter form of el que and is
used when there is no antecedent noun as follows:
" Lo que means  what (that which) and is the subject of a verb:
Me pregunto lo que pasó. (I wonder what happened.)
" Lo que means  what (that which) and is the object of a verb:
Yo sé lo que quiere decir eso. (I know what that means.)
" Lo que is used after the pronoun todo to express  everything that
or  all that :
Me gusta todo lo que es espańol. I like everything that is Spanish.
No escuché todo lo que Ud. dijo. I didn t hear everything you said.
Cuyo
Cuyo(-a,-os,-as) (whose) is a relative adjective that must agree in gender
and number with the people or things possessed, not with the possessor:
La casa, cuyas puertas son rojas, es la mía. (The house, whose doors are
red, is mine.)
TIME S UP!
1. Ask if your hotel has a garage.
2. Say you want a room with an ocean view.
3. Say you need another pillow.
4. Use an exclamation to say:  What a great room!
5. Use the subjunctive to say:  Let them come in!
6. Say that you will stay at the hotel provided there are tennis courts.
7. Say that you re searching for a luxurious hotel.
8. Ask if there s a person who speaks English.
9. Say:  That s the room I want.
10. Say that you have everything that you need.
220
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 221
Speaking of Food
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Using adverbs and nouns of quantity
" Selecting an eating establishment
and getting started
" Selecting meats, poultry, and fish
" Selecting vegetables and fruits
" Cooking to perfection
" Using or avoiding herbs, condiments,
and spices
" Selecting a drink and a dessert
" Using proper restaurant etiquette
In this chapter you ll learn how to buy the
quantity of food you want and how to order
in a restaurant.
221
221
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 222
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
QUANTITIES
Should you decide to purchase food in a store in a Spanish-speaking
area, you ll want to be able to express the correct quantity. In the
Spanish-speaking world, the metric system is used for measuring quanti-
ties of food: Liquids are measured in liters, and solids are measured in
kilograms. If you are accustomed to dealing with ounces, pounds, pints,
quarts, and gallons, the list below gives you a quick conversion chart:
APPROXIMATE DRY MEASURES APPROXIMATE LIQUID MEASURES
1 ounce = 28 grams 1 ounce = 30 milliliters
1
D 4 pound = 125 grams 16 ounces (1 pint) = 475 milliliters
1
D 2 pound = 250 grams 32 ounces (1 quart) = 950 milliliters
(approximately 1 liter)
3
D 4 pound = 375 grams 1 gallon = 3.75 liters
1.1 pounds = 500 grams
2.2 pounds = 1000 grams
(1 kilogram)
Adverbs and adjectives of quantity can help you to generalize or be more
specific about the amounts you need. They are used to give an unspeci-
fied amount:
as much, many tanto(-a,-os,-as)
enough bastante, suficiente
how much, many cuanto(-a,-os,-as)
less, fewer menos
a little, few poco(-a,-os,-as)
more más
much, many mucho(-a,-os,-as)
so much, many tanto(-a,-os,-as)
too much, many demasiado
Adverbs of quantity do not require the use of the preposition de (of): No
tengo bastante carne. (I don t have enough meat.)
222
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 223
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
NOUNS OF QUANTITY
Nouns of quantity allow for a measurement based on weight or the type
of container as shown here:
MEASUREMENT SPANISH
2 pounds of un kilo de
a bag of un saco de
a bar of una tableta de, una barra de
a bottle of una botella de
a box of una caja de
a can of una lata de
a dozen una docena de
a package of un paquete de
a slice of un trozo de
Nouns of quantity are followed by de to express of. No definite article is
used: Deme quinientos gramos de carne, por favor. (Give me a pound of
meat, please.)
To ask for or to refer to an unspecified quantity (to say that you want
part of a whole [some or any]) simply use the noun:
Deme jamón, por favor. Please give me some ham.
No tenemos carne. We don t have any meat.
Use the definite article (el, la, los, las) with nouns in a general sense:
Me gusta el chocolate. I like chocolate.
But:
Deme chocolate. Give me some chocolate.
Use un or una when speaking about one portion or serving.
Un café, por favor. A coffee, please.
Una lata de café, por favor. A can of coffee, please.
223
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 224
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
EATING ESTABLISHMENTS
The Spanish-speaking world offers a wide variety of eating establish-
ments to suit your hunger and your pocketbook, whether you are eating
breakfast (el desayuno), lunch (el almuerzo), dinner (la cena), or a mid-
morning or late afternoon snack (la merienda):
" Un bar, una tasca, or una taberna: A pub or bar in Spain in which
drinks and small snacks known as tapas or pinchos are served.
" Un café: A small neighborhood restaurant.
" Una cafetería: A small, informal café where snacks and drinks
are served.
" Una cantina: A Spanish-American men s bar where women are
excluded.
" Una cervecería: A pub specializing in barreled German beer
and wine.
" Una fonda, hostería, venta, or posada: An inn specializing in
regional dishes.
" Una hacienda: A Spanish-American ranch-style restaurant.
" Un merendero or chiringuito: An outdoor stand, generally located
at the beach, that sells seafood, drinks, and ice cream.
FOODS
Whether you are dining in or out, knowing the names of Spanish foods
will help you get exactly what you like to eat. The tables and lists that
follow will help you with your choices from soup to nuts and will serve
as useful tools in deciphering a Spanish menu.
Appetizers (Los Aperitivos)
Chances are that you will not be ordering a cocktail in the restaurant
before your dinner. This is because in the Spanish-speaking world, it is
customary to stop off before dinner at a bar, and in Spain, a tapas bar.
Some tapas bars offer a wide variety of appetizers, while others serve
only one or two kinds. Tell your waiter: Para empezar, me gustaría (yo
deseo, yo quiero) . . . (To begin, I ll have . . . ) Then choose from the
appetizers listed below.
artichokes alcachofas
eggs huevos
mushrooms champińones
snails caracoles
spicy sausage chorizo
tortilla chips tostadas
224
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 225
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
Soups (Las Sopas)
You can expect to find the following soups on a Spanish menu:
cazuela spicy fish, vegetable, or meat soup
gazpacho cold puréed uncooked vegetables
potaje madrileÅ„o thick, puréed cod, spinach, and chickpea soup
pozole pork and hominy soup
sopa de ajo garlic soup
sopa de verduras green vegetable soup
Main Meals (Los Platos Principales)
Whether you go to the butcher (a la carnicería), to the delicatessen (a la
charcutería), or to dine out, the names of the meats, fowl, and fish will
come in handy. To select the meal you want, say: Quisiera . . . (I would
like . . . )
Meat (Las Carnes)
bacon el tocino
beef la carne de res
chop la chuleta
ham el jamón
lamb el cordero, el borrego
oxtails el rabo de buey
pork el cerdo
roast beef el rosbif
sausage la salchicha
sirloin el solomillo
steak el bistec
veal la ternera
Fowl and Game (La Carne Ave y de Caza)
chicken el pollo
duck el pato
goose el ganso
225
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 226
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
turkey el pavo
venison el venado
Fish and Seafood (Los Pescados y los Mariscos)
anchovy la anchoa
bass la merluza
clam la almeja
codfish el bacalao
crab el cangrejo
lobster la langosta
mussel el mejillón
octopus el pulpo
oyster la ostra
shrimp los camarones, las gambas
squid el calamar
tuna el atśn
NOTE
Rice (el arroz) is a very important staple in Spain and is used as the
base for the ever-popular paella. This dish varies from region to region
but always contains saffron-flavored rice. The most popular is paella
valenciana, with chicken, seafood, peas, and tomatoes.
Salad (La Ensalada)
Refer to the following lists for the names of vegetables, fruits, and nuts
that you might like in your salad.
Vegetables (Las Legumbres)
beans (green) las judías
broccoli el brécol
cabbage la col
carrots las zanahorías
corn el maíz
226
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 227
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
cucumber el pepino
lettuce la lechuga
onion la cebolla
peas los guisantes
peppers las pimientas
potato la patata
spinach la espinaca
squash el calabacín
tomato el tomate
Fruits (Las Frutas)
apple la manzana
avocado el aguacate
banana la banana
grape la uva
lemon la lima
lime el limón
olive la aceituna
orange la naranja
pear la pera
pineapple la pińa
raisin la pasita
strawberry la fresa
Nuts (Las Nueces)
almond la almendra
chestnut la castańa
hazelnut la avellana
walnut la nuez
227
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 228
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Eggs (Huevos)
Eggs (huevos) are quite popular in the Spanish-speaking world, but not
for breakfast. Refer to the following list to ask for eggs prepared the way
you like them:
fried with spicy fritos rancheros
tomato sauce
hard-boiled duros
omelette una tortilla
poached escalfados
scrambled revueltos
Cooking It to Perfection
To ensure that your main course is cooked to your liking, specify how
you want it by saying: Lo (La, Los, Las) quiero . . . (I want it . . . )
baked horneado
boiled hervido
fried frito
grilled asado a la parrilla
roasted rostizado
rare poco asado
medium a término medio
well-done bien cocido
Herbs, Condiments, and Spices
(Las Hierbas, los Condimentos y las Especias)
Use the following words to specify what seasonings you would like in
your meal:
butter la mantequilla
garlic el ajo
jam, jelly la mermelada
mayonnaise la mayonesa
mustard la mostaza
oil el aceite
228
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 229
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
parsley el perejil
pepper (black) la pimienta
pepper (red) el pimiento
saffron el azafrán
salt la sal
sugar el azścar
Drinks (Las Bebidas)
If you would like to order a beverage, una bebida, look for something
listed here:
beer la cerveza
champagne el champán
cocoa el chocolate
coffee el café
black solo
with milk con leche
decaffeinated descafeinado
juice el jugo
mineral water el agua mineral
milk la leche
tea el té
wine el vino
If you want to be specific about a type of juice, use de + the name of the
fruit: el jugo de naranja (orange juice).
The Spanish usually drink wine with dinner. The wines you might
order include the following:
red wine el vino tinto
white wine el vino blanco
dry wine el vino seco
champagne el champán
229
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 230
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Desserts (Los Postres)
Desserts are always a sweet ending to a delicious meal. Consider order-
ing one of the following:
caramel custard el flan
cookies las galletitas
ice cream el helado
marzipan el marzapán
pie el pastel
rice pudding el arroz con leche
sponge cake el bizcocho
yogurt el yogur
TABLE SETTINGS
If something is missing from your place setting or if you need something
additional at the table, use the following terms to ask your server as
follows:
I need . . . Necesito . . .
I m missing . . . Me falta(n) . . .
bowl un tazón
cup una taza
dinner plate un plato
fork un tenedor
glass un vaso
knife un cuchillo
menu un menÅ›
napkin una servilleta
saucer un platillo
teaspoon una cucharita
tablespoon una cuchara
wine glass una copa
A waiter is called el camarero and a waitress is called la camarera.
230
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 231
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
RESTAURANT ETIQUETTE
When reserving a table, you can use the following information:
I would like to reserve a Quisiera reservar una mesa . . .
table . . .
for this evening. para esta noche.
for tomorrow evening. para mańana por la noche.
for Saturday evening. para el sábado por la noche.
for six people at 8:00 P.M. para seis personas a las ocho de la noche.
on the terrace. en la terraza.
To find out about the menu, you would ask:
What is today s specialty? żCuál es el plato del día?
What do you recommend? żQué recomienda Ud.?
What is the house specialty? żCuál es la especialidad de la casa?
Good manners dictate that when your meal arrives, you wish your fellow
diners buen provecho, a hearty appetite.
DIETARY RESTRICTIONS
Whether because of personal preference, or in order to follow the advice
of a doctor, it is very important to be able to express any dietary restric-
tions you might have:
I am on a diet. Estoy a régimen (dieta).
I m a vegetarian. Soy vegetariano(a).
I can t have anything made No puedo comer nada con . . .
with . . .
I can t have . . . No puedo tomar . . .
dairy products productos lácteos.
alcohol alcohol.
saturated fats grasas saturadas.
shellfish mariscos.
I m looking for a dish Estoy buscando un plato . . .
(that is) . . .
231
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 232
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
high in fiber. con mucha fibra.
kosher. comida permitida por la religión judía.
low in cholesterol. con poco colesterol.
low in fat. con poca grasa.
low in sodium. con poca sal.
non-dairy. no lácteos.
salt-free. sin sal.
sugar-free. sin azścar.
with . . . con . . .
without . . . sin . . .
without artificial coloring sin colorantes artificiales
without preservatives sin preservativos
PROBLEMS
If your meal isn t up to par, explain the problem using the phrases in this
list.
It . . . El (La) . . .
is cold está frío(a)
is too rare está demasiado crudo(a)
is overcooked está sobrecocido(a)
is burned está quemado(a)
is too salty está muy salado(a)
At the end of the meal, to ask for the check, you would say: La cuenta,
por favor. (The check, please.)
232
19 (221-234) chapter 0600 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 233
"
0 6 : 0 0 S P E A K I N G O F F O O D
TIME S UP!
1. Ask the butcher for 500 grams of meat.
2. Say that you will begin your meal with snails.
3. Name a vegetable you like.
4. Say you want your dish cooked medium.
5. Order a dessert.
6. Say you need another wine glass because yours is dirty.
7. Reserve a table for this evening for four people at 9:30 P.M.
on the terrace.
8. Ask for today s specialty.
9. Explain that you can t have any dairy products.
10. Ask for the check.
233
This page intentionally left blank.
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 235
Medical Needs
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Going to the pharmacy
" Using prepositional modifiers
" Expressing medical problems
" Going to the doctor
" Asking and answering  how long?
In this chapter you ll learn how to get the
drugstore items and medical attention
you need. You ll also learn how to use body
language to convey your feelings and to
say how long you ve been suffering.
235
235
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 236
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
AT THE PHARMACY
If you ve accidentally left a toiletry article at home, run out of something
you need, or are just feeling under the weather, you ll probably want to
take a fast trip to a local pharmacy.
Una farmacia, easily identifiable by a green cross above the door, sells
prescription drugs, over-the-counter medications, and items intended for
personal hygiene. When the pharmacy is closed, there may be a sign on
the door indicating where a nearby all-night pharmacy, una farmacia de
guardia (de turno) is located.
To ask for an over-the-counter cure, you would say: żTiene Ud. algo
para . . . ? (Do you have a cure for . . . ?)
To fill a prescription, tell the druggist:
Necesito esta medicina. I need this medication.
żPodría Ud. preparar esta Could you please fill this prescription
receta (en seguida)? (immediately)?
If you re looking for a product you can purchase off the shelf, begin by
telling a clerk what you re looking for and then use the words listed
below to express your needs:
Busco . . . I m looking for . . .
Necesito . . . I need . . .
żTiene Ud . . . ? Do you carry . . . ?
ITEM SPANISH
aspirin la aspirina
bandages las vendas
brush un cepillo
condoms los condones
cough syrup el jarabe para la tos
deodorant el desodorante
makeup el maquillaje
mouthwash el elixir bucal
razor la maquinilla de afeitar
sanitary napkins las toallas higiénicas
scissors las tijeras
shampoo el champÅ›
236
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 237
"
0 5 : 0 0 M E D I C A L N E E D S
shaving cream la crema de afeitar
sleeping pills las pastillas para dormir
soap (bar) una barra de jabon
tampons los tampones
thermometer un termómetro
tissues los pańuelos de papel
toothbrush el cepillo de dientes
toothpaste la pasta dentífrica
If you re traveling with a baby, you might need the following:
bottle un biberón
diapers (disposable) los pańales (desechables)
pacifier un chupón
PREPOSITIONAL MODIFIERS
Prepositions relate two elements of a sentence. Some of the examples
below use the preposition in the Spanish version but not in the English
one.
" Noun to noun: Me corté el dedo del pie. (I cut my toe.)
" Verb to verb: Empieza a llorar. (He begins to cry.)
" Verb to noun: Ella trabaja con sus manos. (She works with
her hands.)
" Verb to pronoun: Ella habla bien de él. (She speaks well about him.)
" A preposition + a noun modifying another noun is equivalent to
an adjective:
el jarabe para la tos cough medicine
las gotas para los ojos eye drops
las hojas de afeitar razor blades
los pańuelos de papel paper handkerchiefs (tissues)
" A preposition + a noun modifying a verb is equivalent to an adverb:
El doctor trabaja con cuidado. (The doctor works carefully.)
Note the following about the use of prepositions:
" The preposition para or de + noun is used to express the use,
the function, or the characteristic of an object:
237
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 238
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
el jarabe para la tos cough syrup
una bolsa de hielo ice pack
un dedo del pie toe
" The preposition para or de + verb may be used to describe the
purpose of a noun:
la loción para broncearse suntan lotion
la maquinilla de afeitar electric razor
" The preposition de + noun is used to express the source, the goal,
or the content of an object:
la almohadilla de calefacción heating pad
los pańuelos de papel tissues
PARTS OF THE BODY
If illness strikes while you are traveling, it is best to know the parts of the
body so that you can describe exactly what ails you.
BODY PART SPANISH BODY PART SPANISH
ankle el tobillo lip el labio
arm el brazo lung el pulmón
back la espalda mouth la boca
chest el pecho nail la uńa
ear la oreja neck el cuello
elbow el codo nose la nariz
eye el ojo shoulder el hombro
face la cara skin la piel
finger el dedo stomach el estómago
foot el pie throat la garganta
hand la mano toe el dedo del pie
head la cabeza tongue la lengua
heart el corazón tooth el diente
knee la rodilla wrist la muńeca
leg la pierna
238
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 239
"
0 5 : 0 0 M E D I C A L N E E D S
MEDICAL PROBLEMS
When someone is concerned about your health, you would expect to
hear:
żQué le (te) pasa? What s the matter with you?
żCómo está(s)? How are you?
To say that you or someone else has an ache or hurt, you could answer
in one of two ways:
1. Use the verb tener (to have) to express what you have and where.
Remember to conjugate tener and use the correct form of de: Tengo
dolor de . . . (I have a . . . ache.): Tiene dolor de cabeza. (She has a
headache.)
Although Spanish speakers use tener to express what s bothering
them, English may not include the word have: Tengo dolor de oídos.
(My ears hurt.)
2. Use the verb doler (to hurt) plus an indirect object to express that
something hurts. Pay special attention to the following:
" Use the appropriate indirect object pronoun to refer to those who
might be in pain. Literally, you are explaining the body part is
hurting (to + person). The indirect object pronouns are:
me to me nos to us
te to you os to you
le to him, her les to them
" Use the correct form of the definite article (el, la, los, las) that agrees
with the body part in question. (See the list on page 238 for the
names of the body parts with their corresponding definite article.)
Because the indirect object pronoun is used, it would be redundant
to use the possessive adjective.
" Doler must agree in number (singular or plural) with the part that is
hurting:
singular: duele
plural: duelen
Me duelen los oídos. My ears hurt me.
Le duele la espalda. His back hurts.
Should you need to explain your symptoms to the doctor, use the words
in the following list. Preface your explanation with: Tengo . . . (I have
(a/an) . . .)
239
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 240
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
SYMPTOM SPANISH SYMPTOM SPANISH
broken bone un hueso roto indigestion la indigestión
cough una tos infection una infección
cramp un calambre migraine una jaqueca
cut una cortadura pain un dolor
diarrhea la diarrea sprain una torcedura
fever una fiebre
Other expressions for health symptoms you may need to know include:
I m coughing a lot. Estoy tosiendo mucho.
I m sneezing. Estoy estornudando.
I m bleeding. Estoy sangrando.
I m nauseous. Tengo náuseas.
I m constipated. Estoy estreńido(a).
I feel bad. Me siento mal.
I have trouble sleeping. No puedo dormir.
I m exhausted. Estoy agotado(a).
I hurt everywhere. Me duele todo el cuerpo.
Use the following phrase when you need a dentist: Tengo un dolor de
muelas. (I ve got a toothache.)
AT THE DOCTOR S
A visit to the doctor will require that you answer these questions based
on your medical history. Some common medical problems are listed here:
Have you had . . . ? żHa sufrido . . . ?
Do you suffer from . . . ? żSufre Ud. de . . . ?
PROBLEM SPANISH
allergic reaction una reacción alérgica
asthma el asma
cancer el cáncer
cold un resfriado, un catarro
240
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 241
"
0 5 : 0 0 M E D I C A L N E E D S
dizziness el vértigo
flu la gripe
heart attack un ataque al corazón
stroke un ataque de apoplejía
To answer questions about your medical history say:
I ve had . . . He sufrido . . .
I suffer from . . . Sufro de . . .
You may also use the reflexive verb, sentirse (ie), to express how you feel:
I feel well. Me siento bien.
Do you feel very well? żTe sientes muy bien?
He (She, You) feel(s) better. Se siente mejor.
We feel poorly. Nos sentimos mal.
Do you feel very poorly? żOs sentís muy mal?
They (You) feel worse. Se sienten peor.
Asking and Answering  How Long?
The phrases below suggest the different ways you may hear the question
that asks how long you ve had your symptoms or complaints, and the
ways in which to answer correctly. The phrases vary in difficulty but all
mean the same thing:
QUESTION ANSWER
żDesde cuándo . . . ? (Present tense) Desde hace . . .
Since when + present tense . . . ? (Present tense) Since + time . . .
żDesde cuándo sufre Ud.? (Sufro) Desde hace una semana.
Since when have you been suffering? (I ve suffered) Since last week.
żCuánto tiempo hace que . . . ? Hace + time + que +present tense.
How long has (have) . . . been . . . ? (Present tense) For + time
żCuánto tiempo hace que Ud. sufre? Hace dos días (que sufro).
(How long have you been suffering?) (I ve been suffering) For two days.
241
20 (235-242) chapter 0500 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 242
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
To express these questions in the past, use the imperfect:
QUESTION ANSWER
żDesde cuándo . . . Ud.? (Sufría) desde hacía . . .
How long had . . . been . . . ? (Imperfect) For + time.
żDesde cuándo sufría Ud.? (Sufría) Desde hacía un día.
How long had you been suffering? (I had suffered) For one day.
żCuánto tiempo hacía que . . . Hacía + time (+ que + imperfect).
How long had . . . been . . . ? It had been + time.
żCuánto tiempo hacía que Ud. sufría. Hacía una semana (que sufría).
How long had you been suffering? It had been a week.
If you need to pay a visit to the doctor or dentist, you might ask the
concierge, el conserje, at your hotel: żDónde está el consultorio del doctor
(del dentista) más cercano? (Where is the nearest doctor s [dentist s] office?)
The doctor s office is referred to as el consultorio, the waiting room is
la sala de espera, and the nurse is el (la) enfermero(a).
Before paying the doctor s bill, la nota or la factura, remember to ask:
żPodría darme un recibo para mi seguro médico? (Could you please give
me a receipt for my medical insurance?)
TIME S UP!
1. Ask to have a prescription filled immediately.
2. Say that you re looking for aspirin.
3. Ask where they have tissues.
4. Say you have a headache.
5. Ask someone what s the matter.
6. Say that your feet hurt.
7. Say that you have a toothache.
8. You have the flu. Give your symptoms.
9. Say you suffer from dizziness.
10. Tell how long you ve been suffering.
242
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 243
Clothing Needs
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Selecting clothing
" Selecting sizes and getting alterations
" Expressing a problem
" Selecting colors
" Making a purchase
In this chapter you ll learn how to
describe and buy clothing in just the
right size. You ll also learn how to give
your opinion about items you see, and
how to use demonstrative pronouns.
243
243
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 244
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
CLOTHING
While traveling you ll undoubtedly want to do some shopping, or at least
some window shopping. Articles of clothing (la ropa) that you may want
to purchase are listed here:
CLOTHING/ACCESSORY SPANISH
bathing suit el traje de bańo
belt el cinturón
blouse la blusa
boots las botas
bra el sostén
briefs los calzoncillos
coat el abrigo
dress el vestido
gloves los guantes
handkerchief el pańuelo
hat el sombrero
jacket la chaqueta
jacket (men s) el saco
jeans los vaqueros
lingerie la ropa interior femenina
pajamas las pijámas
panties los pantaloncillos de mujer, pantaletas
pants los pantalones
panty hose, tights las pantimedias
pocketbook la bolsa
raincoat el impermeable
robe la bata
scarf la bufanda
shirt la camisa
shoes los zapatos
shorts los pantalones cortos
244
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 245
"
0 4 : 0 0 C L O T H I N G N E E D S
skirt la falda
sneakers los tenis
socks los calcetines
sports coat la chaqueta deportiva
stockings las medias
suit el traje
sweater el suéter
tie la corbata
T-shirt la camiseta, la playera
underwear la ropa interior
wallet la cartera
If you are looking for a particular department in a store, ask for el
departamento de: żDónde está el departamento de ropa para hombres
(mujeres)? (Where is the department for men s [women s] clothing?)
To tell the salesperson what you are looking for, say:
I m looking for . . . Busco . . .
I need . . . Necesito . . .
I would like . . . Quisiera . . .
SIZES
Europe and Latin America use the metric system; consequently, their cloth-
ing sizes are different from ours. The conversion chart on page 246 will
help determine the sizes you wear. You will be asked your size as follows:
żQué talla es Ud.? What is your size (clothing)?
żQué nÅ›mero calza Ud.? What is your size (shoes)?
To give an appropriate answer for clothing, say:
Soy una talla . . . I wear . . .
Mi talla es . . . My size is . . .
pequeńa small
mediana medium
grande large
245
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 246
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Or give the number of your size: Mi talla es treinta y ocho. (I wear size
38.) For shoes, you would say: Mi nśmero es . . . (I wear shoe size . . . )
Women s Shoes
American 5 51D 2 6 61D 2 7 71D 2 8 81D 2 9 91D 2 10 101D 2
Continental 36 37 38 39 40 41
Women s Dresses and Suits
American 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18
Continental 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 42 44 46
Men s Shoes
American 7 71D 2 8 81D 2 9 91D 2 10 101D 2 11 111D 2
Continental 39 40 41 42 43 44 45
Men s Shirts
American 14 141D 2 15 151D 2 16 161D 2 17 171D 2
Continental 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
Men s Suits
American 34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
Continental 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58
If the item you select is too small or too large, you can ask for the appro-
priate size as follows:
Quisiera una talla más grande. I would like the next larger size.
Quisiera una talla más pequeÅ„a. I would like the next smaller size.
ALTERATIONS
There might be times when you buy something and need to have it
altered, or need to repair the clothing you have. You will have to find
a tailor, un sastre (oon sahs-treh), or a shoemaker, un zapatero (oon sah-
pah-teh-roh), who can help you. The words listed below will help you
describe the problem or the parts of the garment in need of servicing. An
appropriate way to begin your conversation is: żPodría Ud. remendar
este (esta, estos, estas) . . . por favor? (Could you please alter [repair])
this . . . ?)
246
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 247
"
0 4 : 0 0 C L O T H I N G N E E D S
PART SPANISH
button el botón
cuff (shirt) el puńo
cuff (pants) la vuelta
heel el tacón
hem el bajo, el ruedo
lining el forro
pleat el pliegue, la pinza
pocket el bolsillo
sleeve la manga
waist la cintura
zipper el cierre
If you need a dressing room to change your clothes, ask: żDónde está el
vestuario?
PROBLEMS
To explain a problem to a salesperson or a tailor, you would say:
No me gusta(n). I don t like it (them).
No me queda(n) bien. It doesn t (They don t) suit (fit) me.
And then give your reasons:
El (La) es demasiado . . . It is too . . .
Los (Las) son demasiados . . . They are too . . .
Remember to add an s to the adjective when using the plural:
La camisa es demasiada holgada. The shirt is too baggy.
Los pantalones son demasiados holgados. The pants are too baggy.
ADJECTIVE SPANISH
baggy holgado(a)
long largo(a)
loose holgado(a), suelto(a)
247
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 248
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
low-cut escotado(a)
narrow estrecho(a)
short corto(a)
small pequeńo(a)
tight apretado(a)
wide ancho(a)
If you re still not satisfied, ask or say:
Do you have anything . . . ? żTiene Ud. algo . . . ?
Show me something . . . Muéstreme algo . . .
more inexpensive más barato
more expensive más caro
smaller más pequeÅ„o
larger más grande
shorter más corto
longer más largo
else más
When your clothing has been adjusted to your liking, you might respond:
I like it (them). Me gusta(n).
It fits me perfectly. Me queda perfectamente.
It suits (fits) me. Me queda bien.
It s elegant. Es elegante.
It s nice. Es agradable.
It s practical. Es práctico.
COLORS
To describe your color preferences, use the colors in this list:
COLOR SPANISH COLOR SPANISH
beige beige blue azul
black negro(a) brown café
248
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 249
"
0 4 : 0 0 C L O T H I N G N E E D S
gray gris purple morado(a)
green verde red rojo(a)
navy azul marino white blanco(a)
orange anaranjado(a) yellow amarillo(a)
pink rosa
To clarify a color as light, add the word claro. To clarify a color as dark,
add the word oscuro.
light green verde claro
dark blue azul oscuro
To express your color preference, use the definite article (el, la, los, or
las) that agrees with the noun and say:
What color do you prefer? I prefer red.
żQué color prefiere? Prefiero el rojo.
To express what color you would like to have a garment, use the prepo-
sition en before the name of the color:
What color shirt do you want? żEn qué color prefiere Ud. la camisa?
I want it in blue. La prefiero en azśl.
The definite article can be used to express  the one as follows:
" el (la, los, las) + adjective : la corbata azul (the blue tie), la azul
(the blue one).
" el (la, los, las) + de: el suéter de lana (the wool sweater), el de lana
(the wool one).
" el (la, los, las) + que: las camisas que compré (the shirts I bought),
las que compré (the ones I bought).
Remember to put the Spanish adjective in its proper place. Refer to
Chapter 19:00 for a refresher course.
a white sweater un suéter blanco
a red skirt una falda roja
white sweaters suéteres blancos
white skirts faldas blancas
249
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 250
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
FABRICS
Tell your salesperson if you are interested in a certain fabric. The follow-
ing list gives the materials (las telas) that are popular.
MATERIAL SPANISH
cotton el algodón
leather el cuero, la piel
linen el hilo
nylon el nilón
silk la seda
suede la gamuza
wool la lana
Use the preposition de to express that an item of clothing is made out of
a certain material: Quisiera un vestido de seda. (I d like a silk dress.)
THE NEUTER LO
The neuter lo can be used with an adjective, with que, or with a past
participle to express what (in the sense of that which) when discussing
things you can buy, or in common, general situations:
" lo + adjective: Compro sólo lo necesario. (I only buy what is
necessary.)
" lo + que: Muéstreme lo que compró. (Show me what you bought.)
PATTERNS
When selecting a garment, the pattern can make a difference in how you
look. Use the phrase below with the patterns listed to select what will be
best for you:
I need something . . . Necesito algo . . .
PATTERN SPANISH
checked de cuadros
in a solid color de color liso
in plaid de tartán
striped con rayas
250
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 251
"
0 4 : 0 0 C L O T H I N G N E E D S
SALES
If you re interested in purchasing something on sale, you would ask:
Are there . . . ? żHay . . . ?
discounts ganga, rebajas
sales saldos, ventas
MAKING A PURCHASE
Don t forget to ask for the price:
żCuánto cuesta . . . ? How much is . . .
żCuánto cuestan . . . ? How much are . . .
If you want to have an item of clothing custom-made, use the verb hacer
followed by an infinitive, meaning  to make (have) someone do some-
thing,  to have something done,  to cause to do, or  to be done.
The construction mandar + hacer may also be used:
Ella hace tejer un suéter. She is having a sweater knit.
Él manda hacer un traje. He is having a suit made.
Hacer and the infinitive form a unit. All nouns follow this unit and all
pronouns precede it.
Me hizo comprar este abrigo. He made me buy this coat.
Me lo hizo comprar. He made me buy it.
GETTING MEASURED
If you need your measurements taken, speak to the tailor, el sastre, or the
dressmaker, el (la) modisto(a), and ask: żPodría tomarme las medidas?
(Could you please take my measurements?)
251
21 (243-252) chapter 0400 8/1/03 10:39 AM Page 252
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
1. Tell what size pants you wear.
2. Give your shoe size.
3. Tell someone his suit is in style.
4. Ask for the children s department.
5. Describe what you are wearing today.
6. Ask for the dressing room.
7. Ask to have your pants altered.
8. Ask the salesperson if you can see something else.
9. Ask the salesperson to show you a red and white checked shirt.
10. Ask if there are any sales today.
252
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 253
Taking Care of
Travel Needs
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Navigating the airport
" Getting to the train station
" Traveling by car
" Dealing with problems on the road
" Dealing with an accident
In this chapter you ll learn how to get
around the airport and then around the
country by train and by car. You ll also
learn how to use the passive voice.
253
253
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 254
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
AT THE AIRPORT
Although there are plenty of signs pointing you in various directions in
an airport, it s a good idea to become acquainted with the words that
may be unfamiliar to you. The terms you need in order to get around an
airport quickly and efficiently are listed below. To get your bearings,
start with this expression: żDónde está(n) . . . ? (Where is [are] . . . ?)
TERM SPANISH
airline la aerolínea
airport el aeropuerto
arrival la llegada
baggage claim area el reclamo de equipaje
bathrooms los bańos, los servicios
(to) cancel cancelar
carry-on luggage el equipaje de mano
customs la aduana
departure la salida
destination el destino
exit la salida
flight el vuelo
domestic nacional
international internacional
gate la puerta
information la información
landing el aterrizaje
currency exchange el cambio de dinero
passport control el control de pasaportes
suitcase la maleta
take-off el despegue
terminal la terminal aerea
ticket el boleto
trip el viaje
254
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 255
"
0 3 : 0 0 T A K I N G C A R E O F T R A V E L N E E D S
NOTE
To express that you are flying standby, say: Tengo un billete (un boleto)
en lista de espera. (I have a stand-by ticket.)
Some key questions you may want to ask include:
Is the flight late in arriving (departing)? żEl vuelo llega (sale) con retraso?
Is there a delay? żHay una demora?
Where does this flight originate? żEn dónde se origina este vuelo?
Is the flight canceled? żEstá anulado este vuelo?
At what time is take-off? żA qué hora sale el avión?
Are there empty seats? żHay asientos libres?
Is the flight full? żEl vuelo está completo (lleno)?
Are there any stopovers? Where? żHace escalas? żDónde?
What cities does this airline serve? żA cuáles ciudades presta servicio
esta línea?
You should also familiarize yourself with the words and phrases describ-
ing the inside of the plane. You can never tell when these terms will come
in handy:
TERM SPANISH
airplane el avión
aisle el pasillo
baggage compartment el compartimento de equipaje
blanket la manta
crew la tripulación
life vest el chaleco salvavidas
passenger el pasajero
seat el asiento
seatbelt el cinturón de seguridad
tray la bandeja
255
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 256
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
AT THE TRAIN STATION
The following list gives you the words you need to know for train travel.
WORD SPANISH
compartment el departamento
smoking fumadores
nonsmoking no fumadores
platform el andén
schedule el horario
station la estación
ticket el billete
first class de primera clase
second class de segunda clase
one-way de ida
round-trip de ida y vuelta
TRAVEL BY CAR
Many tourists opt to see the countryside and discover out-of-the-way
places by renting a car at a local car agency (un alquiler de carros). Use
the phrases below if this is your plan:
I would like to rent a . . .
Quisiera alquilar una . . . (make of car).
I prefer automatic transmission.
Prefiero el cambio automático.
How much does it cost per day (per week) (per kilometer)?
żCuánto cuesta por día (por semana) (por kilómetro)?
How much is the insurance?
żCuánto cuesta el seguro?
Is the mileage included?
żEstá incluida el kilometraje?
Do you accept credit cards? Which ones?
żAcepta Ud. tarjetas de crédito? żCuáles?
256
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 257
"
0 3 : 0 0 T A K I N G C A R E O F T R A V E L N E E D S
The Car s Exterior and Interior
Familiarize yourself with the words listed below in case you have to
describe a problem with the car s exterior.
EXTERIOR PARTS SPANISH
battery la batería
gas tank el tanque de gasolina
headlight el faro delantero
hood la capota
hubcap el tapacubos
license plate la placa de matrícula
motor el motor
muffler el silenciador
rearview mirror el retrovisor
tail light el faro trasero
tire la goma, la llanta
transmission la transmisión
trunk la cajuela, el baśl
wheel la rueda
windshield el parabrisas
windshield wiper el limpiaparabrisas
Once you ve made sure that everything on the outside is in good work-
ing order, check the car s interior and refer to any problems you have by
using the terms below.
INTERIOR PARTS SPANISH
accelerator el acelerador
air bag la bolsa de aire
brakes los frenos
clutch pedal el embrague
turn signal la direccional
gear shift el cambio de velocidades
257
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 258
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
glove compartment la guantera
ignition la ignición
steering wheel el volante
NOTE
Un semáforo or una luz de tráfico refers to a traffic light and is often
followed by rojo (red) or verde (green). The number of lights you have
to pass is often used in giving directions: Doble a la derecha en el
segundo semáforo. (Turn right at the second light.) Una carretera de
peaje (de cuota) is a toll road.
Measuring Distances
In Europe, distance is measured in kilometers. Refer to the following list
for the approximate equivalents.
MILES KILOMETERS
0.62 1
3.1 5
6.2 10
12.4 20
31 50
62 100
Problems on the Road
Here are some phrases you will need if you have car problems:
Could you help me please? żPodría ayudarme por favor?
The car has broken down. El coche se ha averiado.
Where is the nearest gas żDónde está la gasolinería
station (garage)? (el garaje) más cercano?
. . . doesn t (don t) work. . . . no funciona(n).
Please check . . . Inspeccione Ud. por favor . . .
The car is overheating. El coche se calienta.
There s a flat tire. Hay una llanta ponchada.
The battery is dead. La batería está descargada.
258
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 259
"
0 3 : 0 0 T A K I N G C A R E O F T R A V E L N E E D S
There is a leak. Hay un agujero.
Can you fix it (immediately)? żPodría repararlo (la) en seguida?
When will it be ready? żCuándo estará listo?
To get your gas tank filled with the proper gas, say: Llénelo . . . (Fill it
up . . .)
with regular con normal
with super con super
with unleaded sin plomo
with diesel con diesel
Accidents
Should you bear witness to or be involved in an accident (un accidente),
you may need the following verbs in order to have a conversation with
a police officer (un policía) whose English is limited. Refer to el peatón
if a pedestrian is involved.
VERB SPANISH VERB SPANISH
to collide chocar(se) to run over atropellar
to drive conducir, manejar to signal seńalar
to hit chocar (con) to skid patinar
to hurt hacer dańo a to turn around dar una vuelta
to knock down atropellar a to yield ceder
to park estacionar
Should you need to refer to the parts of the road, use the words and
expressions in this list.
PART SPANISH PART SPANISH
crosswalk el punto de cruce lane el carril
entrance la entrada road surface la superficie
exit la salida shoulder el saliente
intersection el crucero traffic circle la glorieta
259
22 (253-260) chapter 0300 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 260
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
THE PASSIVE VOICE
In the active voice, the subject generally performs the action. In the pas-
sive voice, the subject is acted upon.
Active: The car knocked her down.
Passive: She was knocked down by a car.
The passive construction in Spanish resembles English: subject + form of
ser + past participle + por + agent (doer) if mentioned.
The car was driven by that man. El coche fue conducido por este hombre.
The truck has been hit. La camioneta ha sido chocada.
The driver will be arrested. El conductor será arrestado.
In the passive, because the past participle is used like an adjective, it agrees
in number and gender with the subject: Las mujeres fueron atropelladas.
(The women were run over.)
The reflexive construction may substitute for the passive, because the
passive is used less frequently in Spanish than in English. Note that the
subject usually follows the verb:
Spanish is spoken here. Aquí se habla espaÅ„ol.
The cars were bought. Se compraron los coches.
TIME S UP!
1. Ask for help.
2. Ask when your flight departs.
3. Ask if your flight is cancelled.
4. Say you need a round-trip ticket.
5. Tell what car you d like to rent.
6. Say that your car has broken down.
7. Ask for the nearest service station.
8. Ask to have your car filled with regular gas.
9. Say that two cars collided.
10. Say that a dog was hit by a car.
260
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 261
Managing
Your Money
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Attending to your banking needs
" Playing the stock market
" Using present and perfect participles
In this chapter you ll learn all the terms
necessary to conduct banking and stock
market transactions.
261
261
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 262
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
AT THE BANK
There are any number of reasons to go to a bank, un banco, in a foreign
country. As a tourist, you may simply want to exchange money. For
those who conduct business, however, you will have deposits and with-
drawals to make. And for the adventuresome few, the purchase of vaca-
tion or retirement property requires a knowledge of more sophisticated
banking terms.
The following is a list of some banking expressions that should prove
useful in the situations mentioned above:
What are the banking hours? żCuál es el horario de trabajo?
I would like . . . Quisiera . . .
to change some money cambiar dinero
to make a deposit hacer un depósito
to make a withdrawal hacer un retiro
to take out a loan pedir un préstamo
to cash a check cobrar un cheque
to open an account abrir una cuenta
to close an account cerrar una cuenta
What is today s exchange rate?
Cuál es la tasa de cambio del dolár hoy?
What is the status of my acount?
żCuál es el estado de mi cuenta?
Is there a financial assistant who can help me?
żHay un especialista financiero que pueda ayudarme (aconsejarme)?
Do you have an automated teller machine?
żTiene Ud. un cajero automático?
Can I take out money twenty-four hours a day?
żPuedo retirar (sacar) dinero las veinticuatro horas del día?
262
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 263
"
0 2 : 0 0 M A N A G I N G Y O U R M O N E Y
What is the transaction fee?
żCuál es la comisión por la transacción?
I d like to get a personal loan.
Quisiera obtener un préstamo personal.
I d like to take out a mortgage.
Quisiera obtener una hipoteca.
What is the time period of the loan?
żCuál es el plazo del préstamo?
How much are the monthly payments?
żDe cuánto son las mensualidades?
What is the interest rate?
żCuál es la tasa (el tipo) de interés?
Is it a fixed or variable rate?
żEs una tasa (un tipo) fija (fijo) o variable?
What are the terms of payment?
żCuáles son las condiciones de pago?
Banking Terms
If your financial needs are more specific, consult the following list for the
necessary banking terms:
TERM SPANISH
account la cuenta
automated teller el cajero automático
balance el saldo
bank el banco
bill (money) el billete
change (coins) la moneda
change el cambio
263
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 264
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
check el cheque
checking account la cuenta básica
credit el crédito
customer el cliente
debt la deuda
deposit el depósito, el ingreso
exchange rate la tasa de cambio
interest rate la tasa de interés
(to) invest invertir
loan el préstamo
payment el pago
savings account la cuenta de ahorros
signature la firma
teller el cajero
traveler s check el cheque de viajero
window la ventanilla
withdrawal el retiro
THE STOCK MARKET
The words and phrases in this list could be useful if you like to dabble in
foreign markets.
TERM SPANISH
asset el activo
business el negocio
capital el capital
dividend el dividendo
fees los gastos
foreign exchange el mercado de divisas
fund el fondo
growth el crecimiento
investment la inversión
264
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 265
"
0 2 : 0 0 M A N A G I N G Y O U R M O N E Y
market la bolsa
market price el precio de mercado (corriente)
mutual fund el fondo mutualista
rate el índice, la tasa
revenue el ingreso
security la acción
stock la acción, el valor
stock broker el (la) agente de bolsa
You re in the market. You watch the ticket tape every day and often
place a call to your agent. Someday you might need these useful stock
phrases:
Are my stocks going up? żEstán avanzando mis acciones ?
Are my stocks going down? żEstán bajando mis acciones?
What is the price per share? żCuál es el precio por acción?
What is the commission rate? żCuál es la tasa (el tipo) de comisión?
Do you have a prospectus? żTiene Ud. un prospecto?
Do you know a good stockbroker? żConoce Ud. a un buen agente
de bolsa?
What is the status of my account? żCuál es el estado de mi cuenta?
Are my investments secure? żEstán aseguradas mis inversiones?
PRESENT PARTICIPLES
The present participle is not used in the same way in Spanish that it is in
English. Refer to Chapter 22:00 for the formation of the present participle
(el gerundio) in Spanish. Many English words ending in -ing are not equiv-
alent to Spanish present participles (usually ending in -ando or -iendo):
Cashing this check is impossible. Cobrar este cheque es imposible.
I love accounting. Me gusta la contabilidad.
Present participles may be used as follows:
" With the verbs estar, seguir, continuar, and other verbs of motion
to show that an action is currently taking place or continuing at the
moment indicated:
265
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 266
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
We are looking for a bank. Estamos buscando un banco.
Mr. López keeps on speaking. El seńor López sigue hablando.
I ll continue investing. Continuaré invertiendo.
She left, counting her money. Ella salió contando su dinero.
" To express by + an English present participle: Trabajando, ahorrará
mucho. (By working, you will save a lot.)
" As a verb:
Wanting to save money, I opened a bank account.
Deseando ahorrar dinero, abrí una cuenta en el banco.
You left, forgetting your bank book.
Ud. salió, olvidando su libreta de ahorros.
PERFECT PARTICIPLES
The perfect participle is formed with the present participle of the appro-
priate helping verb and the past participle, and is used to show that one
action took place before another:
Having sold his stocks, he bought himself a new car.
Habiendo vendido sus valores, se compró un coche nuevo.
Having gone to the bank early, they avoided long lines.
Habiendo ido al banco temprano, evitaron largas filas.
Note that the present participles of estar, ir, and venir are not used to
form the present progressive tense. Instead, use the correct simple tense:
You re being silly. Eres ridículo.
He was going to the movies. Iba al cine.
We re coming soon. Venimos pronto.
266
23 (261-268) chapter 0200 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 267
"
0 2 : 0 0 M A N A G I N G Y O U R M O N E Y
TIME S UP!
Try to perform the following tasks without looking back in the lesson:
1. Say that you have to go to the bank.
2. Say that you would like to cash some traveler s checks.
3. Ask if they have an automated teller machine.
4. Ask if it s open twenty-four hours.
5. Say that you d like to buy some stocks.
6. Ask if there s a financial assistant to help you.
7. Tell someone that one learns a lot by traveling.
8. Tell someone that you are going to the bank.
9. Say that they came in laughing.
10. Say that, having entered the bank, you went to the teller.
267
This page intentionally left blank.
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 269
The Language
of Business
MASTER THESE SKILLS
" Fulfilling your stationery, photocopying,
and faxing needs
" Fulfilling your computer needs
" Conducting business
" Using prepositions before infinitives
In this lesson you ll learn how to manage
in a business setting, using fax machines,
photocopiers, and computers. You ll also
learn about verbs that need and don t
need prepositions before other verbs.
269
269
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 270
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
STATIONERY NEEDS
The list that follows presents the necessary stationery supplies that can
be purchased en la papelería (at the stationery store). You might begin by
saying: żDónde puedo comprar . . . (Where can I buy . . . )
Supply Spanish
ball-point pen un bolígrafo
calculator (solar) una calculadora (solar)
envelopes los sobres
notebook un cuaderno
paper los papeles
paper clips los sujetapapeles
pen (fountain) una pluma
pencil un lápiz
scotch tape la cinta adhesiva
stationery el papel de cartas
NOTE
The file of information that is kept in a company regarding its accounts
or customers is called un expediente.
PHOTOCOPIES
La fotocopiadora (copier) is an essential machine to any business. Many
stationery stores also provide photocopying services, often at reasonable
prices to students, travelers, and business people on the go. The phrases
below will help you get the copy of the document, paper, or receipt you
need:
I would like to make a photocopy of this paper (this document).
Quisiera hacer una fotocopia de este papel (este documento).
What is the cost per page?
żCuánto cuesta por página?
The verb mandar (conjugated) + hacer is used to express  to have some-
thing done. Use the indirect object le or les (for him, her, or them) or
the preposition para + the name of the person for whom the work is
being done, or the correct prepositional pronoun:
270
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 271
"
0 1 : 0 0 T H E L A N G U A G E O F B U S I N E S S
I m having a photocopy made Yo les mando hacer una
for them. fotocopia.
I m having a photocopy made Yo mando hacer una fotocopia
for my boss. para mi jefe.
I m having a photocopy made Yo mando hacer una fotocopia
for him. para él.
FAXES
Being able to send a fax is a convenient service that allows for efficient,
inexpensive, and rapid transmittal and receipt of important information.
Therefore, fax service has become almost indispensable. The phrases
below will help you with your fax needs:
Do you have a fax machine? żTiene Ud. un fax?
What is your fax number? żCuál es su nÅ›mero de fax?
I d like to send a fax. Quisiera mandar un fax.
Fax it to me. Envíemelo por fax.
I didn t get your fax. No recibí su fax.
Did you receive my fax? żRecibió Ud. mi fax?
Please send it again. żPuede Ud. enviármelo otra vez?
Please confirm receipt of the fax. Favor de confirmar la recepción del fax.
COMPUTERS
A working knowledge of computers is a must in today s world. The
phrases below will get you started if you need basic computer informa-
tion from another individual.
The following computer terms are essential:
to computerize informatizar
computer science la informática
computer scientist el (la) informático(a)
What kind of computer do you have?
żQué sistema (tipo, género) de computadora tiene Ud.?
What operating system are you using?
żQué sistema operador usa Ud. (está Ud. usando)?
271
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 272
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
What word processing program are you using?
żQué procesador de textos usa Ud. (está Ud. usando)?
Do you have . . . ?
żTiene Ud. . . . ?
Do you use . . .?
żUsa Ud. (Está Ud. usando) . . . ?
What is your e-mail address?
żCuál es su dirección de correo electrónico?
The list below gives you the terms and phrases you need to speak about
your computer and the field of computer science.
WORD SPANISH
CD-ROM disk el disco optinśmerico
CPU la unidad central
database la base de datos
desktop computer el ordenador, el (la) computador(a)
diskette el disquete
e-mail el correo electrónico
file el fichero
floppy disk el disco flexible
hardware el hardware
inkjet (de) tinta
keyboard el teclado
laptop computer la computadora portátil
laser (de) laser
modem el modem
mouse el ratón
network la red
operating system el sistema operador
scanner el scanner
272
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 273
"
0 1 : 0 0 T H E L A N G U A G E O F B U S I N E S S
screen la pantalla
search engine el buscador, el navegador
software el software
CONDUCTING BUSINESS
The following vocabulary is for those readers who are serious about con-
ducting business in a Spanish-speaking country.
WORD SPANISH
bill la factura
business los negocios
consumer el consumidor
contract el contrato
cost el precio
discount el descuento, la rebaja
expenditures los gastos
(to) export exportar
(to) import importar
interest rates la taza de interés
job el trabajo
manager el gerente
merchandise la mercancía
office la oficina
owner el propietario
partner el socio
(to) pay pagar
product el producto
property la propiedad
raise el aumento
salary el sueldo
shipment el envío
tax el impuesto
273
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 274
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
Use the following terms to refer to businesspeople:
un hombre de negocios a businessman
una mujer de negocios a businesswoman
PREPOSITIONS BEFORE INFINITIVES
In Spanish, the verb form that follows a preposition is the infinitive.
Llega a hablar espańol. He succeeds in speaking Spanish.
Se alegra de obtener un trabajo. He is glad to get a job.
Tardan en llegar. They are delayed in arriving.
Yo cuento con comprar esas I am counting on buying those
acciones. stocks.
This next list contains some of the more common verbs requiring a
before the infinitive.
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
aprender learn to ir go to
ayudar help to ponerse begin to
comenzar begin to regresar return to (again)
decidirse decide to salir go out to
empezar begin to venir come to
enseńar teach to volver (ue) return to (again)
Some of the more common verbs requiring de before the infinitive are
listed here:
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
acabar have just olvidarse forget
acordarse (ue) remember to tratar try to
alegrarse be glad
Some of the more common verbs requiring en before the infinitive are:
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
consentir consent to insistir insist on
consistir consist of tardar delay in
Some of the more common verbs requiring con before the infinitive are:
274
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 275
"
0 1 : 0 0 T H E L A N G U A G E O F B U S I N E S S
VERB MEANING VERB MEANING
amenazar threaten sońar (ue) dream of
contar (ue) count on
The following prepositions are used before infinitives:
PREPOSITION MEANING PREPOSITION MEANING
a at, to después de after
al upon, on en in, on, of
antes de before en vez de instead of
con with hasta until
de of, to, from sin without
Él descansa en lugar de trabajar. He rests instead of working.
Ella telefonea antes de enviar un fax. She phones before sending a fax.
A verb + preposition + infinitive must have the same subject. If there are
different subjects, que is used and a conjugated verb form (often in the
subjunctive) is used instead of the infinitive:
I insist on working. I insist that you work.
Insisto en trabajar. Insisto en que Ud. trabaje.
I m leaving after eating. I m going after you eat.
Me voy después de comer. Me voy después de que Ud. coma.
The verbs below are used without a preposition before the infinitive.
SPANISH MEANING SPANISH MEANING
deber must, have to pensar intend
dejar allow poder be able to
esperar hope preferir (ie) prefer
hacer make, have querer, desear want, wish
something done
necesitar need saber know (how)
oír hear ver see
El jefe los deja salir. The boss allows them to leave.
Ella debe comprar una computadora. She must buy a computer.
275
24 (269-276) chapter 0100 8/1/03 10:40 AM Page 276
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
TIME S UP!
Try not to look back at the tables, and fill in a preposition, if needed:
1. Lo ayudo ___ completar su trabajo.
2. Queremos ___ hacer negocios.
3. Nosotros acabamos ___ regresar.
4. Insisto ___ recibir un descuento.
5. Ellos sueńan ___ viajar.
6. Él aprende ___ hablar espaÅ„ol.
7. Trato ___ resolver el problema.
8. Ellos cuentan ____ ganar mucho dinero.
9. żSabes ___ utilizar una computadora?
10. Ella sale ____ comprar disquetes.
276
25 (277-282) chapter 0000 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 277
The Final
Countdown
Here s your final opportunity to see if you ve
mastered enough Spanish to get by on your
own. Imagine you are in a Spanish-speaking
country and give an appropriate response
to each situation.
277
277
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
25 (277-282) chapter 0000 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 278
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
1. You are at a party and strike up a conversation with an interesting
person. What information do you give about yourself?
2. You are talking to someone who is speaking too fast. What might
you say?
3. You call a friend on the phone. Someone else answers. How do
you respond?
4. You want to invite a friend to go to a museum with you. What
suggestions would you make?
5. You are lost in the streets of Spain. You stop a passerby and ask
for directions. What might you ask?
6. You don t like your hotel room. Tell this to the concierge and
express why.
7. You are in a gift shop looking for a gift for a friend. Ask a sales-
person for help.
278
25 (277-282) chapter 0000 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 279
"
0 0 : 0 0 T H E F I N A L C O U N T D O W N
8. You realize you have lost your passport. What do you say to the
police officer?
9. Tell a friend about your favorite leisure activity and why you
like it.
10. You are interviewing for a job in a Spanish firm. What do you tell
the head of personnel about yourself?
11. You are in a park in Mexico. Convince some acquaintances to
engage in a sport.
12. You are in a clothing store. Tell the salesperson what you are
looking for.
13. You are going to the movies with a friend. You want to see a spy
movie but your friend wants to see a comedy. Convince your
friend to see the spy movie.
14. You are at the airport and have learned that your flight is
delayed. What do you say to the airline clerk?
279
25 (277-282) chapter 0000 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 280
C O U N T D O W N T O S P A N I S H
15. You want to change your money into the currency of the country
you are visiting. What do you say to the bank teller?
16. A customs officer at the airport asks what you have purchased on
your trip. How do you respond?
17. You are having dinner in a restaurant. Tell the waiter what you
want.
18. A friend has invited you to a bullfight. Express your feelings
about going.
19. You want to make a dinner reservation at a fine restaurant. What
do you say to the person answering the phone?
20. You rented a car and are having problems with it. What do you
say to the rental agent?
21. You want to go to a concert. What information do you ask for on
the phone?
280
25 (277-282) chapter 0000 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 281
"
0 0 : 0 0 T H E F I N A L C O U N T D O W N
22. You have an appointment in town. When you realize you will be
late, you phone your acquaintance. What do you say?
23. You don t feel well. What do you tell the doctor?
24. Your friend has a cousin for you to meet. What questions do you
ask about this person?
281
This page intentionally left blank.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 283
Answer Key
Since there is almost always more than
one way to say something, the statements
and questions given as responses are
just suggestions.
283
283
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 284
A N S W E R K E Y
24:00
1. boo-weh-nohs dee-yahs meh yah-moh hoh-seh seel-bah
2. ah-bloh ehs-pah-nyohl (oon poh-koh)
3. pehr-doh-neh-meh yoh noh kohm-prehn-doh ah-bleh mahs
dehs-pah-see-yoh pohr fah-bohr
4. keh dee-hoh rreh-pee-tah loh pohr fah-bohr
5. kee-see-yeh-rah kam-bee-yahr mees doh-lah-rehs ehn
eh-yoo-rohs pohr fah-bohr
6. pehr-doh-neh-meh dohn-deh ehs-tah lah ehm-bah-hah-dah
ah-meh-ree-kah-nah
7. noh meh see-yehn-toh bee-yehn dohn-deh ehs-tah lah
oh-fee-see-nah dehl meh-dee-koh lah mahs sehr-kah-nah
8. poh-dree-yahs ah-yoo-dahr-meh pohr fah-bohr pehr-dee oon
doh-koo-mehn-toh eem-pohr-tahn-teh
9. kwahn-toh kwehs-tahn ehs-tohs pahn-tah-loh-nehs neh-grohs
ee ehs-tahs kah-mee-sahs rroh-hahs
10. neh-seh-see-toh oo-nah koo-chah-rah oon teh-neh-dohr ee oon
koo-chee-yoh grah-see-yahs
23:00
Part I
1. el banco
2. ese plato
3. esta catedral
4. la flor
5. aquel hombre
Part II
6. un amigo
7. este francés
8. el actor
9. este policía
10. aquel profesor
284
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 285
A N S W E R K E Y
22:00
1. estoy
2. soy
3. tengo
4. quiero
5. puedo
6. busco
7. mido
8. sustituyo
9. viene
10. vamos
21:00
1. tenía
2. iba
3. era
4. prestaba
5. jugaba
6. pidió
7. quería
8. estaba
9. fuimos
10. conocí
20:00
Part I
1. seré
2. querré
3. tendré
4. viviré
5. conduciré
Part II
6. pondría
7. daría
8. haría
9. compraría
10. diría
285
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 286
A N S W E R K E Y
19:00
1. Él piensa profundamente.
2. La seńora López es una mujer alegre.
3. Es un buen hombre.
4. Hablan frecuentemente.
5. Ella compra demasiados vestidos.
6. Necesito más dinero.
7. Es la primera vez.
8. Ellos trabajan facilmente.
9. Necesito cien dólares.
10. Ellos escriben rápidamente.
18:00
1. Buenos días, seÅ„or López.
2. Mucho gusto en conocerle.
3. Me llamo John Smith.
4. Estoy bien, gracias.
5. Soy de los Estados Unidos.
6. Vivo en Nueva York.
7. Soy americano.
8. Voy a Espańa.
9. Le presento a mi esposa, Marta.
10. Adiós. Hasta luego.
17:00
1. żQuiere ir al restaurante conmigo?
2. żPuedes ir al circo con mi familia y yo?
3. Deseo ir al club.
4. Ä„Por supuesto! Quiero ir a la catedral.
5. Lo siento mucho. No puedo ir a la feria. Estoy muy cansado(a).
6. Es imposible. No tengo ganas de ir al centro comercial.
7. No puedo ir al zoológico porque estoy muy ocupado(a).
8. No puedo ir al jardín porque no estoy libre.
9. żIr al cine? Quizás.
10. żIr a la fuente? Lo que prefieras.
286
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 287
A N S W E R K E Y
16:00
1. Tengo veinte ańos.
2. żCuál es la fecha de hoy?
3. Mi cumpleańos es el once de julio de mil novecientos
cuarenta y siete.
4. żQue días esta cerrado el museo?
5. Estamos en el verano.
6. Hoy es el diez de agosto.
7. żCuándo quieres salir?
8. Son las dos y media.
9. żA qué hora nos vemos?
10. La película empieza a las ocho y cuarto.
15:00
1. Estoy mirando solamente.
2. Quisiera comprar un coche para mi familia.
3. Ud. tiene que escuchar.
4. Ud. debe ir a la panadería.
5. Debiera hacer las camas.
6. Ud. me debe cinco dólares.
7. Es necesario ir de compras.
8. Quiero que saque la basura.
9. Quiero ir a la librería.
10. Ä„No vacile! Tiene que lavar el coche.
14:00
1. żPor qué no vamos al restaurante?
2. żTiene(s) ganas de ir al cine?
3. żQuieres ir de compras?
4. Vayamos al Prado.
5. Continśe caminando tres cuadras.
6. No vaya todo derecho.
7. Ä„Despiértate temprano!
8. El Morro es fenomenal.
9. En mi opinión, es estupendo.
10. Ir al teatro es aburrido.
287
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 288
A N S W E R K E Y
13:00
1. żCuál es su nombre?/żCómo se llama Ud.?
2. żCuál es su dirección?
3. żCuál es su nÅ›mero de teléfono?
4. żDe dónde es?
5. żCuántos aÅ„os tiene?
6. żHay un restaurante por aquí?
7. żCuál de las películas prefiere Ud.?
8. żCuál es su profésion?
9. żCuánto cuesta el periódico?
10. Lo siento pero no comprendo.
12:00
1. Sí, quiero ir al cine esta noche.
2. No, no tengo ganas de comer en un restaurante.
3. No, no fumo.
4. Me llamo Juan.
5. Vivo en Pittsburgh.
6. Mi nÅ›mero de teléfono es cinco, cinco, cinco, nueve,
dos, uno, tres.
7. Tengo treinta ańos.
8. Cuesta dos mil quinientos dólares.
9. Prefiero (name two movies).
10. Hay plumas y papeles en mi escritorio.
11:00
1. żPuede Ud. ayudarme, por favor?
2. żA qué hora abre Ud.?
3. żPuede darme un recibo?
4. żCuánto cuesta un sello para una carta por correo aéreo?
5. żPuede Ud. darme un corte de pelo?
6. żPuede Ud. lavar en seco mi traje?
7. żPuede Ud. darme otra lentilla de contacto?
8. Necesito una película de treinta y seis exposiciones.
9. żPuede Ud. arreglar mi reloj?
10. żDónde está la comisaría de policía más cercana?
288
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 289
A N S W E R K E Y
10:00
1. żTe parece ir a la playa?
2. żQué hay en la televisión?
3. żQué tipo de película están pasando?
4. Quisiera ver una comedia.
5. żLe gustaría ir conmigo al campo hacer una gira campestre?
6. Te quiero.
7. A mí me gustan los regalos.
8. Me falta una pluma.
9. Muéstremelo, por favor.
10. Me encanta mucho esta obra de teatro.
09:00
1. Vamos a nadar.
2. żJuega Ud. al golf?
3. żQuiere Ud. jugar al tenis conmigo?
4. Me faltan patines.
5. żPodrías prestarme una bicicleta?
6. żQué tiempo hace hoy?
7. Hoy hace mucho calor. Hay sol. No está nublado.
Hay una temperatura de ochenta grados.
8. No me gusta jugar al tenis porque es demasiado difícil.
9. Dudo que mi amigo juegue al baloncesto.
10. Estoy seguro que va a hacer buen tiempo.
08:00
1. Un perro es más grande que un gato.
2. El espaÅ„ol es más fácil que las matemáticas.
3. Mi hermana es menos grande que mi hermano.
4. Cristina es la más bonita de mis amigas.
5. Mi esposo corre menos rápidamente que mi hijo.
6. Julio trabaja lo más diligentemente.
7. Tengo más trabajo que Ud.
8. Mi madre es tan alta como yo.
9. Tengo tanta paciencia como mi amiga.
10. Pienso que este libro es el mejor que pueda comprar.
289
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 290
A N S W E R K E Y
07:00
1. żHay un garaje?
2. Quisiera una habitación con vista al mar.
3. Necesito otra almohada.
4. Ä„Qué habitación tan magnífica!
5. Ä„Que entren!
6. Me quedaré en este hotel con tal de que tenga una
cancha de tenis.
7. Busco un hotel que sea lujoso.
8. Hay alguien que hable inglés.
9. Esa es la habitación que quiero.
10. Tengo todo lo que necesito.
06:00
1. Necesito quinientos gramos de carne, por favor.
2. Para empezar, quiero caracoles.
3. Me gustan las zanahorias.
4. Quiero mi rosbif a término medio.
5. Quisiera un flan, por favor.
6. Necesito otra copa porque la mía está sucia.
7. Quisiera reservar una mesa en la terraza para esta noche
a las nueve y media para cuatro personas.
8. żCuál es el plato del día?
9. No puedo tomar productos lácteos.
10. La cuenta, por favor.
05:00
1. żPodría Ud. preparar esta receta en seguida?
2. Busco aspirinas.
3. żDónde hay pańuelos de papel?
4. Tengo un dolor de cabeza.
5. żQué le pasa?
6. Me duelen los pies.
7. Tengo un dolor de muelas.
8. Tengo una gripe. Estoy tosiendo mucho. Me siento mal.
No puedo dormir. Me duele todo el cuerpo.
9. Sufro del vértigo.
10. Hace dos semanas que yo sufro.
290
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 291
A N S W E R K E Y
04:00
1. Llevo la talla treinta y dos.
2. Mi nśmero es siete y medio.
3. Su traje está de moda.
4. żDónde está el departamento de niÅ„os?
5. Llevo pantalones negros y una camisa azul.
6. żDónde está el vestuario?
7. żPodría remendar mis pantalones, por favor?
8. żPuedo ver algo más?
9. Muestréme por favor una camisa de cuadros rojas y blancas.
10. żHay gangas hoy?
03:00
1. żPuede Ud. ayudarme, por favor?
2. żCuándo sale mi vuelo?
3. żEstá anulado este vuelo?
4. Necesito un billete de ida y vuelta.
5. Quisiera alquilar un Honda.
6. Mi coche se ha averiado.
7. żDónde está el garaje más cercano?
8. Llénelo con normal.
9. Dos coches se chocaron.
10. Un perro fue chocado por un coche.
02:00
1. Tengo que ir al banco.
2. Quisiera cobrar algunos cheques de viajero.
3. żTiene Ud. un cajero automático?
4. żEstá abierto las veinticuatro horas al día?
5. Quisiera comprar algunos valores.
6. Hay un especialista financiero que pueda ayudarme?
7. Se aprende mucho viajando.
8. Voy al banco.
9. Entraron riendo.
10. Habiendo entrado en el banco, fui al cajero.
291
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 292
A N S W E R K E Y
01:00
1. a
2. 
3. de
4. en
5. con
6. a
7. de
8. con
9. 
10. a
00:00
1. Buenos días. Me llamo John Smith. Soy americano. Mucho gusto
en conocerle.
2. Por favor, hable Ud. más despacio. No comprendo nada.
3. Diga. Habla Ramón. żEstá Isabel? żPuedo hablar con ella?
4. żNo quieres ir conmigo al museo de arte moderno? Hay una
exposición magnífica de las obras de Picasso.
5. Quiero ir a mi hotel y estoy perdido. żSabe Ud. dónde está la
Avenida Quince?
6. No me gusta mi habitación porque no hay vista al mar. żPodría
Ud. cambiarla?
7. Busco un regalo para mi amigo(a). Puede Ud. recomendar algo.
A él (ella) le gustan mucho los deportes.
8. żPuede Ud. ayudarme? He perdido mi pasaporte. żDónde está
el consulado americano?
9. Me gusta mucho jugar al tenis. Es un deporte muy divertido
porque siempre juego con mis amigos.
10. Soy una persona muy diligente y trabajadora. Siempre llego
temprano a la oficina y hago todo lo necesario.
11. żPor qué no jugamos al fÅ›tbol? Hace buen tiempo y tenemos
bastante jugadores. Vamos a divertirnos mucho.
12. Busco pantalones negros en lana. Mi talla es cuarenta y seis.
También busco una camisa azul de talla mediana con rayas
blancas verticales en algodón.
13. No me gustan las comedias. Pienso que son ridículas. żPor qué no
vamos a ver una película de espía que será mucho más divertida?
292
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 293
A N S W E R K E Y
14. Tengo una cita muy importante. żPor qué hay un retraso?
żCuándo va a despegar el avión?
15. Quiero cambiar doscientos dólares americanos en euros. żCuál es
la tasa (el tipo) de cambio del dólar hoy?
16. Compré un reloj de plata, dos botellas de ron, y juguetes para mis
nińos.
17. Para empezar quiero gazpacho. Entonces quiero paella de mariscos
y una ensalada. Voy a tomar vino blanco con mi comida.
18. No me gustaría ir a una corrida de toros. Pienso que es demasiado
violenta.
19. Quisiera reservar una mesa para cuatro personas para esta noche
a las ocho y media.
20. Tengo un problema con el coche que alquilé. Los frenos no
funcionan bien y tengo miedo de conducir el coche.
21. Diga. Necesito información acerca del concierto de esta noche.
żA qué hora empieza y cuánto cuestan los billetes?
22. Lo siento mucho. Voy a llegar tarde porque tengo una goma
pinchada y tengo que repararla. Llegaré en una media hora.
23. Me siento mal. Tengo un dolor de estómago y no tengo ganas
de comer. También tengo fiebre. żPuede Ud. ayudarme?
24. żCuántos aÅ„os tiene su primo(a)? żDe dónde es? żCómo es?
żCuál es su profesión?
293
This page intentionally left blank.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 295
Appendix A
24 Important Words
and Phrases
295
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 296
A P P E N D I X A
ENGLISH SPANISH PRONUNCIATION
1. Hello. Buenos días. boo-weh-nohs
dee-yahs
2. Good-bye. Adiós. ah dee-yohs
3. Please. Por favor. pohr fah-bohr
4. Thank you very much. Muchas gracias. moo-chahs
grah-see-yahs
5. You re welcome. De nada. deh nah-dah
6. Excuse me. Perdón. pehr-dohn
Con permiso. kohn pehr-mee-soh
7. My name is . . . Me llamo . . . meh yah-moh
8. I would like . . . Quisiera . . . kee-see-yeh-rah
9. I need . . . Necesito . . . neh-seh-see-toh
10. Do you have . . . żTiene Ud . . . ? tee-yeh-neh
oo-stehd
11. How do you say . . . żCómo se dice . . .? koh-moh seh
dee-seh
12. Please give me . . . Déme por favor . . . deh-meh pohr
fah-bohr
13. What does this mean? żQué quiere decir esto? keh kee-yeh-reh
deh-seer ehs-toh
14. Can you help me żPuede Ud. ayudarme poo-weh-deh oo-steh
please? por favor? ah-yoo-dahr-meh
pohr fah-bohr
15. Do you speak English? żHabla Ud. inglés? ah-blah oo-stehd
een-glehs
16. I speak a little Spanish. Hablo un poco ah-bloh oon poh-koh
el espańol. ehl ehs-pah-nyohl
17. I don t understand No comprendo. noh kohm-prehn-doh
18. Please repeat. Repita por favor. rreh-pee-tah pohr
fah-bohr
19. What did you say? żQué dijó Ud.? kee dee-hoh
oo-stehd
296
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 297
2 4 I M P O R T A N T W O R D S A N D P H R A S E S
20. I m lost. Estoy perdido(a). ehs-toy
pehr-dee-doh (dah)
21. I m looking for . . . Estoy buscando . . . ehs-toy
boos-kahn-doh
22. Where are the żDónde está los baÅ„os? dohn-deh ehs-tah
bathrooms? lohs bah-nyohs
23. Where is the żDónde está la dohn-deh ehs-tah
police station? comisaria de de lah koh-mee-sah-
policía? ree-yeh deh
poh-lee-see-yah
24. Where is the żDónde está la dohn-deh ehs-tah lah
American Embassy? embajada americana? ehm- bah-hah-dah
ah-meh-ree kah-nah
297
This page intentionally left blank.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 299
Appendix B
Verb Glossary
299
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 300
A P P E N D I X B
CONJUGATING REGULAR VERBS
-ar Verbs
Usar, to use
Gerund: usando Past participle: usado Commands: Ä„Use Ud.! Ä„Usen Uds.!
Ä„Usemos!
Present Preterit Imperfect Future Conditional
(do) (did) (was) (will) (would)
uso usé usaba usaré usaría
usas usaste usabas usarás usarías
usa usó usaba usará usaría
usamos usamos usábamos usaremos usaríamos
usáis usasteis usábais usaréis usaríais
usan usaron usaban usarán usarían
-er Verbs
Comer, to eat
Gerund: comiendo Past participle: comido Commands: Ä„Coma Ud.!
Ä„Coman Uds.! Ä„Comamos!
Present Preterit Imperfect Future Conditional
como comí comía comeré comería
comes comiste comías comerás comerías
come comió comía comerá comería
comemos comimos comíamos comeremos comeríamos
coméis comisteis comíais comeréis comeríais
comen comieron comían comerán comerían
-ir Verbs
Vivir, to live
Gerund: viviendo Past participle: vivido Commands: Ä„Viva Ud.! Ä„Vivan
Uds.! Ä„Vivamos!
Present Preterit Imperfect Future Conditional
vivo viví vivía viviré viviría
vives viviste vivías vivirás vivirías
300
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 301
V E R B G L O S S A R Y
vive vivió vivía vivirá viviría
vivimos vivimos vivíamos viviremos viviríamos
vivís vivisteis vivíais viviréis viviríais
viven vivieron vivían vivirán vivirían
CONJUGATING STEM-CHANGING VERBS
-ar Verbs
Pensar (e to ie), to think
Present: pienso, piensas, piensa, pensamos, pensáis, piensan
Other verbs like pensar include cerrar (to close), comenzar (to begin),
and empezar (to begin).
Mostrar (o to ue), to show
Present: muestro, muestras, muestra, mostramos, mostráis, muestran
Other verbs like mostrar include almorzar (to eat lunch), contar (to tell),
costar (to cost), encontrar (to find), and recordar (to remember).
Jugar (u to ue), to play (a sport or game)
Present: juego, juegas, juega, jugamos, jugáis, juegan
Preterit: jugué, jugaste, jugó, jugamos, jugasteis, jugaron
-er Verbs
Defender (e to ie), to defend, to forbid
Present: defiendo, defiendes, defiende, defendemos, defendéis, defienden
Other verbs like defender include descender (to descend), entender
(to understand, to hear), perder (to lose), and querer (to want).
Volver (o to ue), to return
Present: vuelvo, vuelves, vuelve, volvemos, volvéis, vuelven
Another verb like volver is poder (to be able to, can).
-ir Verbs
Pedir (e to i), to ask for
Gerund: pidiendo
Present: pido, pides, pide, pedimos, pedís, piden
Preterit: pedí, pediste, pidió, pedimos, pedisteis, pidieron
Other verbs like pedir include impedir (to prevent), medir (to measure),
repetir (to repeat), and servir (to serve).
301
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 302
A P P E N D I X B
Sentir (e to ie, i), to feel
Gerund: sintiendo
Present: siento, sientes, siente, sentimos, sentís, sienten
Preterit: sentí, sentiste, sintió, sentimos, sentisteis, sintieron
Other verbs like sentir include advertir (to warn, to notify), consentir
(to consent), mentir (to lie), preferir (to prefer), and referir (to refer).
Dormir (o to ue, u), to sleep
Gerund: durmiendo
Present: duermo, duermes, duerme, dormimos, dormís, duermen
Preterit: dormí, dormiste, durmió, dormimos, dormisteis, durmieron
Another verb like dormir is morir (to die).
-uir Verbs (except -guir)
Incluir (i to y), to include
Gerund: incluyendo
Present: incluyo, incluyes, incluye, incluimos, incluís, incluyen
Preterit: incluí, incluiste, incluyó, incluimos, incluisteis, incluyeron
Other verbs like incluir include concluir (to conclude, to end), construir
(to construct), contribuir (to contribute), destruir (to destroy), and
sustituir (to substitue).
-eer Verbs
Leer (e to y), to read
Gerund: leyendo
Preterit: leí, leíste, leyó, leímos, leísteis, leyeron
Other verbs like leer include creer (to believe), poseer (to possess),
and proveer (to provide).
-iar Verbs
Enviar (i to í), to send
Present: envío, envías, envía, enviamos, enviáis, envían
Other verbs like enviar include confiar + en (to confide in), guiar
(to guide), and variar (to vary).
302
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 303
V E R B G L O S S A R Y
-uar Verbs
Actuar (u to Å›), to act
Present: actÅ›o, actÅ›as, actÅ›a, actuamos, actuáis, actÅ›an
Another verb like actuar is continuar (to continue).
CONJUGATING SPELLING-CHANGE VERBS
-cer or -cir Verbs
Convencer (c to z), to convince
Present: convenzo, convences, convence, convencemos, convencéis,
convencen
Conocer (c to zc), to know
Present: conozco, conoces, conoce, conocemos, conocéis, conocen
Conducir (c to zc), to drive, conduct
Present: conduzco, conduces, conduce, conducemos, conducéis,
conducen
Preterit: conduje, condujiste, condujo, condujimos, condujisteis,
condujieron
-ger or -gir Verbs
Exigir (g to j), to demand
Present: exijo, exiges, exige, exigimos, exigís, exigen
Escoger (g to j), to choose
Present: escojo, escoges, escoge, escogemos, escogéis, escogen
-guir Verbs
Distinguir (gu to g), to distinguish
Present: distingo, distingues, distingue, distinguimos, distinguís,
distinguen
-car Verbs
Buscar (c to qu), to look for
Preterit: busqué, buscaste, buscó, buscamos, buscasteis, buscaron
-gar Verbs
Pagar (g to gu), to pay
Preterit: pagué, pagaste, pagó, pagamos, pagasteis, pagaron
303
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 304
A P P E N D I X B
-zar Verbs
Gozar (z to c), to enjoy
Preterit: gocé, gozaste, gozó, gozamos, gozasteis, gozaron
CONJUGATING IRREGULAR VERBS
Dar, to give
Present: doy, das, da, damos, dáis, dan
Preterit: di, diste, dio, dimos, disteis, dieron
Decir, to say
Gerund: diciendo Past participle: dicho
Present: digo dices dice decimos decís dicen
Preterit: dije dijiste dijó dijmos dijisteis dijeron
Future: diré dirás dirá diremos diréis dirán
Conditional: diría dirías diría diríamos diríais dirían
Estar, to be
Present: estoy, estás, está, estamos, estáis, están
Preterit: estuve, estuviste, estuvo, estuvimos, estuvisteis, estuvieron
Hacer, to make, to do
Past participle: hecho
Present: hago, haces, hace, hacemos, hacéis, hacen
Preterit: hice, hiciste, hizo, hicimos, hicisteis, hicieron
Future: haré, harás, hará, haremos, haréis, harán
Conditional: haría, harías, haría, haríamos, haríais, harían
Ir, to go
Gerund: yendo
Present: voy, vas, va, vamos, vais, van
Preterit: fui, fuiste, fue, fuimos, fuisteis, fueron
Conditional: iba, ibas, iba, íbamos, ibais, iban
Oír, to hear
Gerund: oyendo
Present: oigo, oyes,oye, oímos, oís, oyen
Preterit: oí, oíste, oyó, oímos, oísteis, oyeron
Poder (o to ue), to be able to, can
Gerund: pudiendo
Present: puedo, puedes, puede, podemos, podéis, pueden
Preterit: pude, pudiste, pudo, pudimos, pudisteis, pudieron
Future: podré, podrás, podrá, podremos, podréis, podrán
Conditional: podría, podrías, podría, podríamos, podríais, podrían
304
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 305
V E R B G L O S S A R Y
Poner, to put
Past participle: puesto
Present: pongo, pones, pone, ponemos, ponéis, ponen
Preterit: puse, pusiste, puso, pusimos, pusisteis, pusieron
Future: pondré, pondrás, pondrá, pondremos, pondréis, pondrán
Conditional: pondría, pondrías, pondría, pondríamos, pondríais,
pondrían
Querer, to want
Present: quiero, quieres, quiere, queremos, queréis, quieren
Preterit: quise, quisiste, quiso, quisimos, quisisteis, quisieron
Future: querré, querrás, querrá, querremos, querréis, querrán
Conditional: querría, querrías, querría, querríamos, querríais, querrían
Saber, to know
Present: sé, sabes, sabe, sabemos, sabéis, saben
Preterit: supe, supiste, supo, supimos, supisteis, supieron
Future: sabré, sabrás, sabrá, sabremos, sabréis, sabrán
Conditional: sabría, sabrías, sabría, sabríamos, sabríais, sabrían
Salir, to go out, to leave
Present: salgo, sales, sale, salimos, saléis, salen
Future: saldré, saldrás, saldrá, saldremos, saldréis, saldrán
Conditional: saldría, saldrías, saldría, saldríamos, saldríais, saldrían
Ser, to be
Past participle: sido
Present: soy, eres, es, somos, sois, son
Preterit: fui, fuiste, fue, fuimos, fuisteis, fueron
Imperfect: era, eras, era, éramos, erais, eran
Tener, to have
Present: tengo, tienes, tiene, tenemos, tenéis, tienen
Preterit: tuve, tuviste, tuvo, tuvimos, tuvisteis, tuvieron
Future: tendré, tendrás, tendrá, tendremos, tendréis, tendrán
Conditional: tendría, tendrías, tendría, tendríamos, tendríais, tendrían
Traer, to bring
Past participle: traído
Present: traigo, traes, trae, traemos, traéis, traen
Preterit: traje, trajiste, trajo, trajimos, trajisteis, trajeron
305
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 306
A P P E N D I X B
Venir, to come
Gerund: viniendo
Present: vengo, vienes, viene, venimos, venís, vienen
Preterit: vine, viniste, vino, vinimos, vinisteis, vinieron
Future: vendré, vendrás, vendrá, vendremos, vendréis, vendrán
Conditional: vendría, vendrías, vendría, vendríamos, vendríais, vendrían
Ver, to see
Past participle: visto
Present: veo, ves, ve, vemos, veis, ven
Preterit: vi, viste, vio, vimos, visteis, vieron
Imperfect: veía, veías, veía, veíamos, veíais, veían
306
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 307
Index
A for stress, 3
A, á (vowel), pronunciation of, 3 tilde, 3
A (to, for), 98 when changing masculine nouns to
with indirect object pronouns, 179 80 feminine, 20
before infinitives, 274 when making nouns plural, 21
personal, 179 Acceptance, expressing, 103
in questions and answers, 159 60 Accidents, traffic, 259
A él/ellos, 183 Accounts files, 270
A ella/ellas, 183 Acquaintances
A la/las, 115 16 making, 82 93
A Ud./Uds., 183 questioning new, 150 51
Abbreviations Active voice, 260
for ordinal numbers, 111 Activities
for usted and ustedes, 28 leisure, 174 75
Abierto, 114 outdoor, 188 89
Abrir (to open) Actuar (to act), 38
conditional mood of, 63 Acute accent, 2 3
conjugation of, 33 34 Adjectives
future tense of, 61 adverbs vs., 77 78
Absolute superlative, 207 8 antonyms of, 202 3
Accent marks, 2 3 comparison of, 200 203
acute, 2 3 demonstrative, 16, 71, 176
for attaching pronouns to infinitives, descriptive, 71
183 different meanings of, 74
for demonstrative pronouns, 176 forming feminine of, 68 70
diaeresis, 3 forming plural of, 70 71
307
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 308
I N D E X
Adjectives, continued Antecedents, 217, 219
interrogative, 145 46 Anticipation, subjunctive after conjunc-
of nationality, 70 tions for, 214
near perfect cognates of, 23 Antonyms, 202 3
as noun markers, 12, 16 Appetizers, 224
perfect cognates of, 22 Appliances, 120
position of, 71 74, 249 Aquel (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
possessive, 71, 91 93 Aquella (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
of quality, 71 Aquellas (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
of quantity, 72, 73, 222 Aquello (demonstrative pronoun), 177
relative, 220 Aquellos (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
ser and estar with, 74 76 -ar verbs
shortened forms of, 72 74 conditional mood of, 63
żAdónde?, answering questions with, 161 conjugation of, 29 32
Adverbial phrases, 77, 99 future tense of, 60 61
Adverbs, 77 80 gerunds from, 44
adjectives vs., 77 78 imperfect of, 53 54
comparison of, 203 5 past participles of, 52 53
with demonstrative adjectives, 16 preterit of, 48
forming, 77 regular, 300
interrogative, 146 47, 160 shoe verbs, 35 36
position of, 80 stem-changing, 126, 301
of quantity, 222 subjunctive of, 125
showing location, 16 Articles
Affirmative answers, 154 definite, 12 15, 87 88, 92, 177, 249
Affirmative commands, 135 36 indefinite, 12, 15
accents for, 183 as noun markers, 12 15
object pronouns with, 182 Asking questions. See Questions
reflexive pronouns with, 139 Assistance. See Help, seeking
Age, expressing, 110 Attractions, 174 75
Agradecer (to thank), 39 Automobiles. See Cars
Airports, 254 55
Alterations, clothing, 246 47
Amás, 155 B
Animals Babies, supplies for, 237
in hotels and restaurants, 212 Banking, 262 64
names of, 198 Bars, 224
Answering questions, 154 64. See also Basement, term for, 110
Questions Bathroom facilities, 213
affirmatively, 154 Beverages, 229
 How long? , 241 42 Body. See Parts of the body
for information, 158 62 Buscar (to look for), 100
with interrogative adverbs, 160 Business needs, 270 74. See also Money
negatively, 154 58 computers, 271 73
pero vs. sino in, 158 faxes, 271
on the phone, 162 64 photocopies, 270 71
prepositions in, 162 stationery, 270
308
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 309
I N D E X
C near perfect, 23 24
C (consonant), pronunciation of, 6 perfect, 22 23
Caer (to fall), 39 Colors, 248 49
Cafés, 224 Commands, 134 39
Calendars, 111 affirmative, 135 36, 183
Camera shop, seeking help at, 169 70 familiar, 135 36
-car verbs irregular, 136 39
preterit of, 49 negative, 135 36
spelling changes with, 303 polite, 134 35
Cardinal numbers, 108 10 with reflexive verbs, 139
for days, 113 third person, 214
for ordinals after ten, 110 Commas (in numbers), 108
Cars, 256 59 Communication, lack of, 151 52
accidents with, 259 żCómo? (how), answering questions
exterior and interior of, 257 58 with, 160
and measuring distances, 258 Comparatives, 199, 200
problems with, 258 59 of adjectives, 200 203
renting, 256 of adverbs, 203 5
Centigrade, converting Fahrenheit and, expressions of, 208
190 of nouns, 205 6
-cer verbs, spelling changes with, 38, Comparison(s)
303 of adjectives, 200 203
Cerrado, 114 of adverbs, 203 5
Certainty, expressions of, 192 94 of equality, 206 7
Ch (consonant), pronunciation of, 5 of inequality, 199 206
Chores, 121 of nouns, 205 6
Cien, 73 of verbs, 206
Ciento, 73, 109 Complaints, 142
-cir verbs, spelling changes with, 38, Compound tenses, reflexive verbs in,
303 86 87
Classroom expressions, 198 99 Compounds
Clothing, 244 51 of ciento, 109
alterations of, 246 47 of irregular verbs, 62
articles of, 244 45 of verbs in preterit, 51
color preferences for, 248 49 Computers, 271 73
definite article with, 92 Con (with), 274 75
dry cleaning services for, 168 Con permiso, 152
fabrics for, 250 Con + noun, 77
getting measured for, 251 Concession, conjunctions expressing,
patterns of, 250 215
problems with, 247 48 Condiments, 228 29
purchasing, 251 Conditional mood, 63 64, 194
repairs of, 168 Condition(s)
sales on, 251 conjunctions expressing, 215
sizes of, 245 46 contrary-to-fact, 194
Cognates, 22 25 physical, 149
false friends vs., 24 Conducir (to drive, conduct, or lead), 39
309
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 310
I N D E X
Conjugation, 29 Decimals, 108
of -ar verbs, 29 32 Decir (to say, tell), 41, 304
of -er verbs, 32 33 Definite articles
of -ir verbs, 33 34 with clothing or body part terms, 92
of irregular verbs, 304 6 as demonstrative pronouns, 177
of irregular yo verbs, 38 39 to express preferred color, 249
of regular verbs, 29 34, 300 301 with geographical names, 87 88
of spelling-change verbs, 38 39, 303 4 neuter, 14 15
of stem-changing verbs, 301 3 as noun markers, 13 15
with two verbs in succession, 44 omitting, 14
when larger verb form contains plural, 12
irregular verb, 42 singular, 12
Conjunctions, 214 17 Demonstrative adjectives, 71
Conocer (to know), 39 demonstrative pronouns vs., 176
Consonants as noun markers, 16
in diphthongs, 4 5 plural, 12
pronunciation of, 5 9 singular, 12
Contact lenses, 169 Demonstrative pronouns, 175 78
Continents, 89 accent marks for, 176
Contrary-to-fact conditions, 194 definite articles as, 177
Contribuir (to contribute), 37 demonstrative adjectives, 176
Cooking terms, 228 gender of, 176
Countries, 87 89 neuter forms of, 177
Crecer (to grow), 39 number of, 176
żCuál(es)?, 147 49, 158 60 Denial, expressions of, 192
żCuándo? (when), 160 Dependent clauses
żCuánto(a)(s)? (how much, many), 145, relative pronouns in, 217
147, 148, 160 tense of subjunctive in, 194
Cuyo(-a, -os, -as) (whose), 220 Descriptive adjectives, 71
Desde, questions containing, 43
Desear (to want), 96
D Desserts, 230
Dar (to give) Diaeresis, 3
conjugation of, 304 Dietary restrictions, 231 32
idiomatic expressions using, 39 40 Diphthongs, pronunciation of, 4 5
preterit of, 51 Direct object pronouns, 177, 179
with una caminata, 175 to extend invitations, 183 84
Dates, 111 14 placement of, 182
Days of the week, 13 14, 111 Direct objects, 179, 180
De (of, from, than), 91, 98 Direction(s)
in comparisons, 204 6 asking questions for, 149 50
before infinitives, 274 giving and receiving, 139 40
in questions and answers, 159 60 high-frequency verbs for, 136 37
De + definite article, 202 and means of transportation, 137 38
De + noun, 237 38 prepositions showing, 138 39
De + verb, 238 Disbelief, expressions of, 192
żDe dónde?, 161 Distance
Deber (to have to), 122 23 demonstrative adjectives indicating, 16
310
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 311
I N D E X
with demonstrative pronouns, 176 77 -er verbs
measuring, 258 conditional mood of, 63
Doctor s visits, 240 42 conjugation of, 32 33
Doler (to hurt), 239 future tense of, 61
żDónde?, 160 61 gerunds from, 44
Dormir (to sleep), 37 imperfect of, 53 54
Double object pronouns, 182 83 nosotros/vosotros endings for, 34
Doubt past participles of, 52 53
expressions of, 192 93 preterit of, 48
impersonal expressions of, 192 93 regular, 300
subjunctive after conjunctions for, 214 shoe verbs, 35 36
Dressing rooms, 247 stem-changing, 126, 301
Drinks, 229 subjunctive of, 125
Dry cleaners, seeking help at, 168 Es (it is), 115
Dry measures, 222 Esa (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
-ducir verbs, 51 Esas (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
Ese (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
Eso (demonstrative pronoun), 177
E Esos (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
E, é (vowel), pronunciation of, 3 4 Esperar (to wait for), 100
E-, words beginning with, 25 żEstá bien?, 144
Eating establishments, 224, 230 32 Esta (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
-eer verbs, stem-changing, 302 Estar (to be)
Eggs, 228 with adjectives, 74 76
El cual, 219 conjugation of, 41, 304
El (definite article), 12, 114 idiomatic expressions using, 41
El que, 219, 220 Estas (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
Ellas (pronoun), 28 Este (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
Emotions, 184 85 Esto (demonstrative pronoun), 177
impersonal expressions of, 192 93 Estos (demonstrative adjective), 12, 16
positive, 183 84 Etiquette, restaurant, 231
subjunctive after superlative for, 208 Events, 174 75
En (in, by, inside, within), 98, 100 Exclamations, 213
to answer żDónde? questions, 160 61
to express preferred color, 249
before infinitives, 274 F
with seasons and months, 112 Fabrics, 250
Encantado, 83 Fahrenheit, converting Centigrade and,
Encontrar (to meet, find), 36 190
Encouragement, offering, 131, 141 False friends, 24
Entertainment Familiar commands, 135 36
leisure activities, 174 75 Family, 90 91
outdoor activities, 188 89 Fax services, 271
Enviar (to send), 38 Fear, expressing, 216
Equality, comparisons of, 206 7 Feelings
Equipment positive, 183 84
repair of, 169 subjunctive used with, 184 85, 208
for sports, 189 Feminine, making ordinal numbers, 110
311
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 312
I N D E X
Feminine adjectives, 68 70 of cardinal numbers, 109
Feminine nouns, 17 20 of comparative and superlative adjec-
endings for, 13, 19 tives, 202
near perfect cognates of, 24 of days, months, and seasons, 111
perfect cognates of, 23 of demonstrative pronouns, 176
Files, business, 270 for groups of mixed-gender nouns, 21
Films, 175 76 of nouns, 12
Finances. See Money of ordinal numbers, 110, 111
First floor, term for, 110 Geographical names, 14, 87 89
Fish, 226 -ger verbs, spelling changes with, 38,
Floor levels, terms for, 110 303
Flying standby, 255 Gerunds, 44 45
Food, 222 32 irregular, 45
appetizers, 224 object pronouns with, 182
cooking terms for, 228 reflexive verbs with, 87
desserts, 230 -gir verbs, spelling changes with, 38, 303
and dietary restrictions, 231 32 Glasses, 169
and eating establishments, 224 Good-byes, 82 83
eggs, 228 Gran, 73
fruits, 227 Grande, 73
main meals, 225 26 Greetings, 82 83
nuts, 227 Ground floor, term for, 110
portions of, 223 -guir verbs, spelling changes with, 39,
quantities of, 222 303
and restaurant dining, 230 32 Gustar (to please, to like), 180, 181
salad, 226
seasonings, 228 29
soups, 225 H
Food stores, 121 H (consonant), pronunciation of, 6
Former, 177 78 Haber (to have)
Fowl, 225 26 future perfect of, 62 63
Fruits, 227 imperfect of, 54
Furniture, 120 past participles of, 52
Future perfect tense, 62 63 perfect conditional of, 64
Future tense, 60 62 present tense of, 51
of irregular verbs, 61 62 preterit of, 53
of regular verbs, 60 61 Hablar (to speak)
uses of, 62 conditional mood of, 63
conjugation of, 29 30
future tense of, 60 61
G Hace + que, 43
G (consonant), pronunciation of, 6 Hacer (to make, do)
Game (poultry), 225 26 conjugation of, 304
-gar verbs idiomatic expressions using, 40
preterit of, 49 and infinitives, 251
spelling changes with, 303 Hair salon, seeking help at, 167 68
Gender, 17 20 Hay que + infinitive (to be necessary to),
of adjectives, 68 70 124, 149
312
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 313
I N D E X
Hay (there is/are or is/are there?), 149 Indifference, expressing, 104, 191
Health problems, 239 40 Indirect object pronouns, 178 81
Help, seeking, 166 71. See also Medical Indirect objects, 179
needs form for you, 174
at the camera shop, 169 70 placement of, 182 83
at the dry cleaner s, 168 verbs taking, 180 81
general questions for, 166 Inequality, comparisons of, 199 206
at the hair salon, 167 68 Infinitives, 29
at the jeweler s, 170 after conjunctions, 216 17
at the optician s, 169 comparing, 206
place names in, 166 following prepositions, 274 75
at the post office, 166 67 and hacer, 251
for repairs, 168 69 negating, 155
for special services and needs, 171 object pronouns with, 182
Herbs, 228 29 reflexive verbs with, 87
Home. See House and home of shoe verbs, 35
Hotel accommodations and amenities, with two verbs in succession, 44
212 13 used as nouns, 14
House and home, 120, 121 Information questions
 How long? , 241 42 answering, 158 62
Hypothetical situations, 194 asking, 145 49
Injuries, 240
Inns, 224
I Interrogative adjectives, 145 46
I, í (vowel), pronunciation of, 4 Interrogative adverbs, 146 47, 160
-iar verbs Interrogative pronouns, 147 49
in present subjunctive, 127 Intonation (in asking questions), 144
shoe verbs, 37 38 Introductory conversations, 82 93
stem-changing, 302 discussing origins in, 87 89
Idioms, 39, 40, 140 41 family member references in, 90 91
for age, 110 greetings and good-byes in, 82 83
definition of, 141 questions about nationality in,
reflexive verbs in, 85 89 90
tener ganas de for, 96 reflexive verbs used in, 83 87
using estar, 41 showing possession in, 91 93
Illness, 239 41 Inversion
Imperfect subjunctive, 129 30, 194 in asking questions, 144 45
Imperfect tense, 53 57 following interrogative adverbs, 146
Impersonal expressions, subjunctive Invitations
after, 192 94 accepting, 103, 183 84
Indecision, 104 declining, 191
Indefinite articles direct object pronoun with, 183 84
as noun markers, 15 extending, 97, 102 3, 183
plural, 12 indecision and indifference with,
singular, 12 104
Indicative, 192 94 indifference to, 191
after superlative (to state a fact), 209 refusing, 103 4
conjunctions using, 216 verbs for, 96 97
313
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 314
I N D E X
Ir (to go), 45 Las (definite article), 12
conjugation of, 41, 304 Las que, 219
imperfect of, 54 Latter, 177 78
irregular present tense of, 60 Le, 183
preterit of, 51 Leer (to read)
Ir + a + definite article, 175 conditional mood of, 63
Ir + a + infinitive, 60 future tense of, 61
-ir verbs Leisure activities, 174 75. See also
conditional mood of, 63 Outdoor activities
conjugation of, 33 34 Les, 183
future tense of, 61 Limits, adjectives imposing, 71
gerunds from, 44 Liquid measures, 222
imperfect of, 53 54 Ll (consonant), pronunciation of, 5, 7
nosotros/vosotros endings for, 34 Lo (definite article), 14 15, 178, 250
past participles of, 52 53 Lo + adjective (or adverb) + que (how),
preterit of, 48 15
regular, 300 301 Lo cual, 220
shoe verbs, 36 37 Lo que (what/that which), 220
stem-changing, 50, 127, 301 2 Location
stem-changing gerunds from, 44 adverbs showing, 16
subjunctive of, 125 prepositions showing, 138 39
Irregular commands, 136 39 Los (definite article), 12
Irregular verbs Los que, 219
commands with, 135
conjugation of, 304 6
future tense of, 61 62 M
imperfect of, 54 Main floor, term for, 110
past participles of, 52 53 Main meals, 225 26
present tense of, 39 42 Mandar + hacer, 251
in preterit, 50 51 Más, 213
in subjunctive, 127 Masculine adjectives, 68 70
in yo form only, 39 40, 124 26 Masculine nouns, 17 20
endings for, 13, 19
near perfect cognates of, 23 24
J perfect cognates of, 23
J (consonant), pronunciation of, 7 Materials, clothing, 250
Jeweler s, seeking help at, 170 Mayor, placement of, 202
Jugar (to play), 36 Me, 178
Jugar (ue) a + definite article, 175 Meals, selecting, 225 26
Juices, 229 Measurement(s)
for clothing, 251
of distances, 258
L dry and liquid, 222, 223
La (definite article), 12 Meat, 225
La que, 219 Medical needs, 236 42
Languages, definite article with names and body parts, 238
of, 13 doctor s visits, 240 42
314
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 315
I N D E X
health problems, 239 40 Negation
at the pharmacy, 236 37 of doubt, 192
Medications, 236 expressing, 215
Mejor, placement of, 202 question inversions for, 145
Menor, placement of, 202 Negative answers, 154 56
Menos, 115 Negative commands, 135 36
Merecer (to deserve), 39 Negative expressions, 156 58
Metric system conversion chart, 245, Negative opinions, 191
246 Neuter forms
Millón, 109 10 of definite articles, 14 15
Mirar, 175 of demonstrative pronouns, 177
Money of el que, 220
banking terms and expressions, lo as, 250
262 64 New acquaintances, questioning, 150 51
stock market terms, 264 65 Ni . . . ni construction, 155
Months of the year, 111, 112 Ninguno (not any), 156
Moods żNo es verdad?, 144
conditional, 63 64 No (not), 104 5
imperfect subjunctive, 129 30 in negative answers, 154 56
perfect conditional, 64 with reflexive verbs, 105
perfect subjunctive, 130 31 Nos, 178
pluperfect subjunctive, 130 31 Nosotras (pronoun), 28
present subjunctive, 124 29 Noun markers, 12 16
subjunctive, 124 adjectives as, 12, 16
Movies, 175 76 articles as, 12 15
definite articles as, 13 15
demonstrative adjectives as, 16
N indefinite articles as, 15
Ń (consonant), pronunciation of, 3, 5, 7 plural, 12
Nada, 155 singular, 12
Nadie, 155 Nouns, 12 25
Names in apposition, 14
of animals, 198 comparison of, 205 6
of appliances, 120 definite article with, 13
of continents, 89 feminine, 17 20
of countries, 87 89 gender endings for, 19 20
of furniture, 120 gender of, 12
geographical, 14, 87 88 gender-changing singular, 18 19
of places, 100, 166 gender-obvious, 17 18
Nationality, 70, 89 90 making plurals of, 20 22
Near future, expressing, 60 masculine, 17 20
Near perfect cognates, 23 24 near perfect cognates of, 23 24
of adjectives, 23 and noun markers, 12
of feminine nouns, 24 number of, 12
of masculine nouns, 23 24 perfect cognates of, 23
Necessity, expressing, 127 28 plural, 12
Need, expressing, 127 28 of quantity, 223
315
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 316
I N D E X
Nouns, continued P
referring to groups of people, 22 Paella, 226
singular, 12 Para (for, to), 100, 147
subject, 28 Para + noun, 237 38
in superlative sentences, 202 Para + verb, 238
Number (singular or plural) żPara qué?, 147
of comparative and superlative adjec- Participles
tives, 202 past, 52 53
of demonstrative pronouns, 176 perfect, 266
of nouns, 12 present, 183, 265 66
of pronouns, 28 Parts of the body, 13, 92, 238
Numbers, 71 Passive voice, 86, 260
cardinal, 108 10, 113 Past participles
ordinal, 110 11 of irregular verbs, 52 53
writing, 108 of regular verbs, 52
writing date in, 113 Past tense (preterit)
Numerals, 14, 108 forming, 48 51
Nunca, 155 imperfect vs., 54 57
Nuts, 227 Pastimes, 174 75
Patterns, fabric, 250
Pedir (to ask for), 100
O Pensar (to think), 35
O, ó (vowel), pronunciation of, 4 Peor, placement of, 202
Object pronouns, 178 Perdón, 152
direct, 177, 179 Perdóneme, 152
double, 182 83 Perfect cognates, 22 23
indirect, 178 81 of adjectives, 22
position of, 182 83 of feminine nouns, 23
Objects of prepositions of masculine nouns, 23
que as, 218 Perfect conditional mood, 64
quién as, 218 19 Perfect participles, 266
Obligations, expressing, 123 24 Perfect subjunctive, 130 31, 194
Ofrecer (to offer), 39 Periods (in numbers), 108
Oír (to hear), 41, 304 Pero (but, however), 158
Opinions Person (of pronouns), 28
exclamations for, 213 Personal a, 179
expressions of, 192 93 Personal hygiene items, 236 37
negative, 191 Persuasion, 131, 141, 192 93
subjunctive after superlative for, Pharmacies, 236 37
208 Phone conversations, 162 64
Opposites, 202 3 Photocopying services, 270 71
Optician, seeking help from, 169 Photographs, 169 70
Ordinal numbers, 110 11 Physical challenges, seeking help with, 171
Os, 178 Physical conditions, hay with, 149
Outdoor activities, 188 89. See also Place names, 100, 166
Leisure activities continents, 89
Outdoor eating stands, 224 countries, 87 89
316
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 317
I N D E X
Pluperfect subjunctive, 130 31, 194 Present perfect tense, 51 53
Pluperfect tense, 54 Present progressive tense, 44 45
Plurals Present subjunctive, 124 29
of adjectives, 70 71 in dependent clauses, 194
with affirmative commands, 135 spelling changes in, 126
noun markers, 12 Present tense, 29 44
of nouns, 12, 13, 20 22 of irregular verbs, 39 42
of pronouns, 28 of regular verbs, 29 39
of reflexive verbs, 86 uses of, 43 44
Poder (to be able to, can), 45, 96, 304 Preterit. See Past tense
Polite commands, 134 35 Preterit perfect tense, 53
Poner (to put) Prices
conjugation of, 305 asking, 150
irregular yo form of, 39 clothing, 251
Por Primero, 111
meanings of, 98 99 Probability
for sending letters or packages, 167 deber de + infinitive for, 123
żPor qué? (why), 147, 161 in the past, 64
Porque (because), 147 in the present, 62
Positive comparisons, 199 in the recent past, 63
of adjectives, 200 203 subjunctive in expressions of, 192
of adverbs, 203 5 Producir (to produce), 39
Positive feelings, 183 84 Programs, television, 175 76
Possession, 91 93 Pronouns, 28
Possessive adjectives, 71, 91 93 accents for, 183
Possessive pronouns, 93 demonstrative, 175 78
Post office, seeking help at, 166 67 direct object, 177, 179
Preferir (to prefer), 36 double object, 182 83
Prepositional modifiers, 237 indirect object, 178 81
Prepositional pronouns, 101 2 interrogative, 147 49
Prepositions, 87, 97 100 neuter form of, 177
+ qué, 148 object, 178, 182 83
+ quién, 148 placement of, 182
with indirect object pronouns, 179 80 plural, 28
before infinitives, 274 75 possessive, 93
with interrogative adverbs, 147 prepositional, 101 2
as modifiers, 237 reflexive, 83 83, 86 87, 139, 178
in negative expressions, 156 relative, 217 20
objects of, 218 19 singular, 28
preceding interrogative adjectives, subject, 28
146 Pronunciation, 2 9
in questions and answers, 162 accents for, 2 3
showing location and direction, of consonants, 5 9
138 39 of diphthongs, 4 5
to, for, and from, 181 82 stress in, 2
Prescriptions, 236 of vowels, 3 4
Present participles, 183, 265 66 Proposals, making, 134
317
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 318
I N D E X
Public announcements, time expressions R
in, 117 R (consonant), pronunciation of, 8
Pubs, 224 Reciprocal action, 86
Purpose Reconocer (to recognize), 39
conjunctions expressing, 214 15 Reducir (to reduce), 39
subjunctive after conjunctions for, 214 Reflexive pronouns, 83 83, 86 87, 178
placement of, 182
with reflexive verbs, 139
Q Reflexive verbs
Q (consonant), pronunciation of, 7 choosing correct, 85 86
Quality, adjectives emphasizing, 71 commands with, 139
Quantity in compound tenses, 86 87
adjectives of, 72, 73, 222 with infinitives and gerunds, 87
adverbs of, 222 in introductory conversations,
measures of, 222 83 87
nouns of, 223 no with, 105
Que (that, which, who, whom, than), 218 question inversions with, 145
in comparisons, 203 5 with subjunctive, 185
as object of preposition, 218 Refusal, expressing, 103 4
with subjunctive, 128 Regionalisms, 22
żQué? (which, what), 145, 148 Regular verbs
answering, 161 62 -ar verbs, 29 32
answering questions with, 158 60 conjugation of, 29 34
Qué + preposition, 148 -er verbs, 32 33
Querer (to wish, want), 35, 96, 305 future tense of, 60 61
Questions imperfect of, 53 54
about dates, 114 -ir verbs, 33 34
about prices, 150 past participles of, 52
about something unknown, 177 polite commands with, 134 35
about time, 114 17 present tense of, 29 39
answering. See Answering questions preterit of, 48
asked of new acquaintances, 150 51 shoe verbs, 35
for clarifying answers, 151 52 subjunctive of, 125
containing desde, 43 Relationship, expressions of, 93 94
containing hace + que, 43 Relative adjectives, 220
to get information, 145 49 Relative clauses, 217
for giving and receiving directions, Relative pronouns, 217 20
139 40, 149 50 el cual, 219
for help in stores, 122 el que, 219
 How long? , 241 42 lo que (lo cual), 220
intonation in, 144 que, 218
inversion in, 144 45 quién, 218 19
prepositions in answers and, 162 Renting cars, 256
when seeking help, 166 Repairs, 168 69
yes/no, 144 45 Restaurants, 224, 230 32
Quién (whom), 218 19 animals in, 212
Quién + preposition, 148 and dietary restrictions, 231 32
żQuién (es)? (who, whom), 147, 148, 161 etiquette for, 231
318
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 319
I N D E X
problems in, 232 with verbs, 303 4. See also
table settings in, 230 Shoe verbs
Rice, 226 Spices, 228 29
Rooms, hotel, 212 13 Sports, 188 89
Standby, flying, 255
Stationery supplies, 270
S Stem-changing verbs. See also Shoe verbs
Saber (to know a fact, to know how to) conjugation of, 301 3
conjugation of, 305 gerunds from, 44 45
irregular yo form of, 39 in present subjunctive, 126 27
Salad, 226 in preterit, 50
Sales, clothing, 251 Stock market, 264 65
Salir (to go out, to leave) Stores
conjugation of, 305 departments in, 245
irregular yo form of, 39 getting help in, 122
San, 74 types of, 121
Santo, 74 Stress
School expressions and terms, 198 99 accent marks for, 3
Se, 178, 183 in pronunciation, 2
Seafood, 226 when making nouns plural, 21
Seasonings, food, 228 29 Subject(s)
Seasons, 14, 111, 112 of commands, 134
Seguir (to follow or continue), 39 names of academic, 199
Seńora, 83 nouns as, 28
Seńorita, 83 pronouns as, 28, 135
Sentirse (ie) (to feel), 84, 241 in question inversions, 145
Ser (to be) with subjunctive, 129
with adjectives, 74 76 verb forms with, 29
conjugation of, 41, 305 Subjunctive
imperfect of, 54 after conjunctions, 214 17
preterit of, 51 after impersonal expressions,
Servir (to serve), 37 192 94
Shoe repairs, 168 after superlatives, 208 9
Shoe sizes, 246 avoiding, 129
Shoe verbs, 35 38 conditions for using, 124
Sí, 101 conjunctions using, 216
Si clause, 194 to express emotions and feelings,
Singular 184 85
noun markers for, 12 in expressing doubt, denial, disbelief,
of nouns, 12 and probability, 192
of pronouns, 28 imperfect, 129 30, 194
Sino (but), 158 perfect, 130 31, 194
Sizes, clothing, 245 46 pluperfect, 130 31, 194
Son, 115 present, 124 29, 194
Soups, 225 reflexive verbs with, 185
Special needs, seeking help for, 171 of regular verbs, 125
Spelling changes in relative clauses, 217
in present subjunctive, 126 sequence of tenses of, 194
319
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 320
I N D E X
Subjunctive, continued preterit perfect, 53
in third person commands, 214 of the subjunctive, 194
verbs irregular in, 127 Tercero, 111
Suggestions, making, 174 Third person commands, 214
Superlative(s), 199 200 Tilde, 3
absolute, 207 8 Time
of adjectives, 200 203 conjunctions expressing, 214
of adverbs, 203 5 of day, definite article with, 13
expressions of, 208 telling, 114 17. See also Tenses
of nouns, 205 6 Titles (of rank or profession), 13
subjunctive after, 208 9  To forms. See Infinitives
Traducir (to translate), 39
Traer (to bring)
T conjugation of, 305
Table settings, 230 irregular yo form of, 39
Tan, 213 Traffic accidents, 259
Tan + adjective or adverb + como Traffic lights, 258
(as . . . as), 206 Train travel, 256
Tanto(-a, -os, -as) + noun + como (as Transportation, 137 38
much/many . . . as), 206 7 Travel
Tapas bars, 224 by airplane, 254 55
Te, 178 by car, 256 59
Telephone conversations, 162 64 hotel accommodations and amenities,
Television, 175 76 212 13
Telling time, 114 17 by train, 256
Temperature, 190 TÅ› (pronoun), 28
Tener (to have)
conjugation of, 42, 96, 305
to express health problems, 239 U
idioms using, 42 U, Å› (vowel), pronunciation of, 4
and personal a, 179 -uar verbs
Tener ganas de (to feel like), 96 in present subjunctive, 127
Tener que, 123 24 shoe verbs, 37 38
Tengo . . . ańos, 110 stem-changing, 303
Tenses. See also Moods; specific tenses Ud. (usted), 28
compound, reflexive verbs in, Uds. (ustedes), 28
86 87 -uir verbs
conditional, 194 preterit of, 48
future, 60 62 shoe verbs, 37
future perfect, 62 63 stem-changing, 302
imperfect, 53 57 Un (indefinite article), 12, 109
pluperfect, 54 Una (indefinite article), 12, 109
present, 29 44 Unas (indefinite article), 12
present perfect, 51 53 Uncertainty
present progressive, 44 45 expressions of, 192
preterit, 48 51, 54 57 subjunctive after conjunctions for, 214
320
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 321
I N D E X
Unknowns, asking about, 177 Voices, passive and active, 86, 260
Uno (indefinite article), 12, 109 Volver (to return, go back), 36
Unos (indefinite article), 12 Vosotras (pronoun), 28
Usted (Ud.), 28 Vosotros (pronoun), 28
Ustedes (Uds.), 28 Vowels
in diphthongs, 4 5
pronunciation of, 3 4
V
V (consonant), pronunciation of, 8
Vegetables, 226 27 W
Venir (to come), 43, 306 W (consonant), pronunciation of, 6
Ver (to see) Wanting, 128
conjugation of, 306 Weather, 149, 190 91
imperfect of, 54 Wines, 229
irregular yo form of, 39 Wishing, 128
preterit of, 51 Wonder
Verbs. See also Infinitives in the past, 64
for certain activities, 175 in the present, 62
for commands, 136 37
comparison of, 206
conjugation of, 29, 300 306 X
for invitations, 96 97 X (consonant), pronunciation of, 8
irregular, 304 6
irregular in subjunctive, 127
irregular in yo form only, 124 26 Y
moods of. See Moods Y (and)
with nouns referring to groups, 22 in expressions of time, 115
object pronouns and agreement of, in numbers, 109
179 Years, 113
perfect participles of, 266 Yes, answering, 154
as present participles, 266 Yes/no questions, asking, 144 45
present participles with, 265 66 Yo (pronoun), 28
reflexive, 83 87  You re welcome, 103
regular, 300 301
shoe verbs, 35 38
spelling-change, 303 4 Z
stem-changing, 301 3 Z (consonant), pronunciation of, 9
taking direct objects, 180 -zar verbs
taking indirect objects, 180 81 preterit of, 49
tenses of. See Tenses spelling changes with, 304
of wishing and wanting, 128
321
26 (283-322) back matter 8/1/03 10:41 AM Page 322
About the Author
Gail Stein has an M.A. in French literature from New York University
and has taught French and Spanish in New York City public junior and
senior high schools for more than thirty-three years. She has authored
numerous text and trade books in both languages. Mrs. Stein has also
assisted in a revision project of the French curriculum for the New York
City Board of Education and has served as an adjunct professor to St.
John s University in its Early Admission Extension Program. She has
given presentations and demonstration lessons at numerous foreign lan-
guage conferences and has had her lessons videotaped by the New York
City Board of Education for national distribution. Mrs. Stein has been
recognized in the 2000 and 2002 editions of Who s Who Among
America s Teachers.
Copyright 2004 by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use.


Wyszukiwarka

Podobne podstrony:
15 ways to improve oral communication in business englishid234
countdown to 2000
Cypress Hill Born to get busy
Linux Sound HOWTO, czyli Dźwięk w Linuxie Jak To Zrobić In
Solutions to Problems in Sakurai s Quantum Mechanics P Saltsidis, B Brinne
Possibility to delete In Member Details, [Hack] TTClassic Beta4
Green?y I Dont Want To?ll In Love
A Million Ways To Die In The West 2014 READNFO HDRip XviD
Mcgraw Hill Handbook Of Small Electric Motors 2001 (Toc)
10 Things Not to say to a Woman in an Argument
MISTAKES TO AVOID IN YOUR CV
How to complain in English
Introduction to LabVIEW 8 in 6 Hours CW

więcej podobnych podstron